Contents

BMW 525xi Sedan 5 Series 2008 Owner's Manual PDF

1 of 288
1 of 288

Summary of Content for BMW 525xi Sedan 5 Series 2008 Owner's Manual PDF

The Ultimate Driving Machine

Owner's Manual for Vehicle

528i 535i 550i

528xi 535xi

Owner's Manual for Vehicle Congratulations, and thank you for choosing a BMW.

Thorough familiarity with your vehicle will provide you with enhanced control and security when you drive it. We therefore have this request:

Please take the time to read this Owner's Manual and familiarize yourself with the information that we have compiled for you before starting off in your new vehicle. It contains important data and instructions intended to assist you in gaining maximum use and satisfaction from your BMW's unique range of technical fea- tures. The manual also contains information on maintenance designed to enhance operating safety and contribute to main- taining the value of your BMW throughout an extended service life.

This manual is supplemented by a Service and Warranty Informa- tion Booklet for US models or a Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models.

We wish you an enjoyable driving experience.

BMW AG

2007 Bayerische Motoren Werke Aktiengesellschaft Munich, Germany Reprinting, including excerpts, only with the written consent of BMW AG, Munich. Order No. 01 41 0 014 240 US English VIII/07, 07 09 500 Printed in Germany Printed on environmentally friendly paper, bleached without chlorine, suitable for recycling.

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Contents

The fastest way to find specific topics is to use the index, refer to page 264.

Using this Owner's Manual 4 Notes 7 Reporting safety defects

At a glance 10 Cockpit 16 iDrive 23 Voice command system

Controls 28 Opening and closing 45 Adjusting 56 Transporting children safely 61 Driving 78 Everything under control 90 Technology for comfort, convenience

and safety 108 Lamps 114 Climate 121 Practical interior accessories

Driving tips 134 Things to remember when driving

Navigation 142 Starting navigation system 144 Destination entry 156 Destination guidance 165 What to do if

Entertainment 168 On/off and tone 172 Radio 179 Satellite radio 182 CD player and CD changer 188 AUX-In connection 189 USB/audio interface

Communications 194 Telephoning 209 BMW Assist

Mobility 218 Refueling 220 Wheels and tires 230 Under the hood 235 Maintenance 237 Replacing components 247 Giving and receiving assistance

Reference 254 Technical data 259 Short commands of voice command

system 264 Everything from A to Z

N o

te s

4

Notes

Using this Owner's Manual We have made every effort to ensure that you are able to find what you need in this Owner's Manual as quickly as possible. The fastest way to find specific topics is to refer to the detailed index at the back of the manual. If you wish to gain an initial overview of your vehicle, you will find this in the first chapter.

Should you sell your BMW some day, please remember to hand over the Owner's Manual as well; it is an important component of your vehicle.

Additional sources of information Should you have any other questions, your BMW center will be happy to advise you.

You can find information on BMW, e.g. on tech- nology, on the Internet at www.bmwusa.com.

Symbols used Indicates precautions that must be fol- lowed precisely in order to avoid the pos-

sibility of personal injury and serious damage to the vehicle.<

Indicates information that will assist you in gaining the optimum benefit from your

vehicle and enable you to care more effectively for your vehicle.<

Refers to measures that can be taken to help protect the environment.<

< Marks the end of a specific item of informa- tion.

* Indicates special equipment, country-spe- cific equipment and optional extras, as well as equipment and functions not yet available at the time of printing.

"..." Identifies Control Display texts used to select individual functions.

{...} Verbal instructions to use with the voice command system.

{{...}} Identifies the answers generated by the voice command system.

Symbols on vehicle components Indicates that you should consult the rel- evant section of this Owner's Manual for

information on a particular part or assembly.

5

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

The individual vehicle When purchasing your BMW, you have decided in favor of a model with individualized equip- ment and features. This Owner's Manual describes the entire array of options and equip- ment available with a specific BMW model.

Please bear in mind that the manual may con- tain information on accessories and equipment that you have not specified for your own vehicle. Sections describing options and special equip- ment are marked by asterisks * to assist you in identifying possible differences between the descriptions in this manual and your own vehi- cle's equipment.

If equipment in your BMW is not described in this Owner's Manual, please refer to the accom- panying Supplementary Owner's Manuals.

Editorial notice BMW pursues a policy of continuous, ongoing development that is conceived to ensure that our vehicles continue to embody the highest quality and safety standards combined with advanced, state-of-the-art technology. For this reason, it is possible that the features described in this Owner's Manual could differ from those on your vehicle.

For your own safety

Maintenance and repairs Advanced technology, e.g. the use of modern materials and high-performance

electronics, requires specially adapted mainte- nance and repair methods. Therefore, have cor- responding work on your BMW performed only by your BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with cor- respondingly trained personnel. If this work is not carried out properly, there is a danger of subsequent damage and related safety haz- ards.<

N o

te s

6

Parts and accessories For your own safety, use genuine parts and accessories approved by BMW.

When you purchase accessories tested and approved by BMW and Genuine BMW Parts, you simultaneously acquire the assurance that they have been thoroughly tested by BMW to ensure optimum performance when installed on your vehicle. BMW warrants these parts to be free from defects in material and workmanship. BMW will not accept any liability for damage resulting from installation of parts and accesso- ries not approved by BMW. BMW cannot test every product made by other manufacturers to verify if it can be used on a BMW safely and without risk to either the vehi- cle, its operation or its occupants. Genuine BMW Parts, BMW Accessories and other products approved by BMW, together with professional advice on using these items, are available from all BMW centers. Installation and operation of non-BMW approved accessories such as alarms, radios, amplifiers, radar detectors, wheels, suspension components, brake dust shields, telephones, including operation of any mobile phone from within the vehicle without using an externally mounted antenna, or transceiver equipment such as CBs, walkie-talkies, ham radios or the like may cause extensive damage to the vehicle, compromise its safety, interfere with the vehi- cle's electrical system, or affect the validity of the BMW Limited Warranty. See your BMW center for additional information.<

Maintenance, replacement, or repair of the emission control devices and sys-

tems may be performed by any automotive repair establishment or individual using any cer- tified automotive part.<

California Proposition 65 Warning California law requires us to issue the following warning:

Engine exhaust and a wide variety of automobile components and parts,

including components found in the interior fur- nishings in a vehicle, contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects and reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. Battery posts, terminals and related accesso- ries contain lead and lead compounds. Wash your hands after handling. Used engine oil contains chemicals that have caused cancer in laboratory animals. Always protect your skin by washing thoroughly with soap and water.<

7

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Service and warranty We recommend that you read this publication thoroughly.

Your BMW is covered by the following warran- ties:

> New Vehicle Limited Warranty

> Rust Perforation Limited Warranty

> Federal Emissions System Defect Warranty

> Federal Emissions Performance Warranty

> California Emission Control System Limited Warranty

Detailed information about these warranties is listed in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models or in the Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models.

Reporting safety defects

For US customers The following applies only to vehicles owned and operated in the US.

If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, NHTSA, in addition to notifying BMW of North America, LLC, P.O. Box 1227, Westwood, New Jersey 07675-1227, Telephone 1-800-831- 1117.

If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or BMW of North America, LLC.

To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Adminis- trator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov

For Canadian customers Canadian customers who wish to report a safety-related defect to Transport Canada, Defect Investigations and Recalls, may call 1-800-333-0510 toll-free from anywhere in Canada or 1-613-993-9851 from the Ottawa region and from other countries, or contact Transport Canada by mail at: Transport Canada, ASFAD, Place de Ville, Tower C, 330 Sparks Street, Ottawa, ON, K1A 0N5. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.tc.gc.ca

At a glance This overview of buttons, switches and displays is intended to familiarize you with your vehicle's

operating environment. The section will also assist you in becoming acquainted with the

control concepts and options available for operating the various systems.

C o

ck p

it

10

Cockpit

Around the steering wheel: controls and displays

1 Rear window safety switch 41

2 Sedan: sun blind* for rear window 122

3 Opening and closing windows 40

4 Adjusting exterior mirrors 53 Automatic curb monitor* 53

5 Folding exterior mirrors in and out* 53

6 Turn signals 67

High beams, headlamp flasher 110

High-beam assistant* 110

Roadside parking lamps 110

Check Control 83

Computer 79

A t

a g

la n

ce

11

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

7 Buttons on steering wheel

8 Instrument cluster 12

11 Ignition lock 61

12 Horn, entire surface

15 Releasing hood 230

Mobile phone* 194:

> Press: accepting and ending call, starting dialing* for selected phone number and redialing if no phone number is selected

> Press and hold: redialing

Volume

Activating/deactivating voice command system* 23

Changing radio station 172 Selecting music track 183 Scrolling in phone book and in lists with stored phone numbers

Individually programmable* 54

Individually programmable* 54

Leaving lane warning* 106

9 Windshield wipers 68

Rain sensor 68

Sports Wagon: rear window wiper 69

10 Starting/stopping engine and Switching ignition on/off 61

13 Steering wheel heater* 54

Steering wheel adjustment 54

14 Cruise control* 69

Active cruise control 70

16 Opening luggage compartment lid/ tailgate 33, 35

17 Head-Up Display* 102

BMW Night Vision* 104

18 Parking lamp 108 Daytime running lamps* 109 Low beams 108 Welcome lamps 108

Automatic headlamp control* 108 Daytime running lamps* 109 Welcome lamps 108 Adaptive Head Light* 110 High-beam assistant* 110

19 Instrument lighting 112

Fog lamps* 112

C o

ck p

it

12

Instrument cluster

1 Indicator lamps for turn signals

2 Speedometer

3 Indicator and warning lamps 13

4 Displays for

> Active cruise control* 70

> Leaving lane warning* 106

5 Tachometer 78

6 Energy Control 79

7 Display for

> Clock/date 78

> Outside temperature 78

> Indicator and warning lamps 83

> Speed of cruise control* 69

> Desired speed for active cruise control* 70

8 Display for

> Odometer and trip odometer 78

> Computer 79

> Date and remaining travel distance for service requirements 81

> Automatic transmission with Steptronic* 63

> Sport automatic transmission* 66

> HDC Hill Descent Control* 93

> High-beam assistant* 110

> Check Control message present 83

9 Fuel gauge 79

10 Resetting trip odometer 78

A t

a g

la n

ce

13

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Indicator and warning lamps

The concept

The indicator and warning lamps can light up in different combinations and colors.

Some lamps are tested for proper function by briefly lighting up during starting of the engine or when the ignition is switched on.

Explanatory text messages

Text messages at the bottom edge of the Control Display explain the meaning of the displayed indicator and warning lamps.

Additional information, e.g. on the cause of a malfunction and on the corresponding need to take action can be displayed via the Check Con- trol, refer to page 83.

In urgent cases, this information will be shown as soon as the corresponding lamp comes on.

Indicator lamps without text messages The following indicator lamps signal particular functions:

High beams/headlamp flasher 110

Fog lamps* 112

Handbrake applied 63

Handbrake applied for Canadian models

Lamp flashes: DSC or DTC controls the drive and braking forces for maintaining vehicle stability 92

DTC Dynamic Traction Control 93

Engine malfunction with deteriorating emissions levels 236

C o

ck p

it

14

Around the center console: controls and displays

A t

a g

la n

ce

15

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

1 Microphone for hands-free mode for telephone* and for voice command system* 23

2 Reading lamps 113

3 SOS: initiatingan emergency request 247

4 Interior lamps 112

5 Glass sunroof*, electric 41

Panorama glass sunroof 43

6 Passenger airbag status lamp 101

7 Control Display 16 Displays for menu navigation

8 Hazard warning flashers

9 Central locking system 32

10 Automatic climate control 114

11 Changing

> radio station 168

> track 168

12 Ejecting

> navigation DVD* 142

> audio CD 168

13 Programmable memory/direct selection buttons 21

14 Drive for navigation DVDs* 142

15 Drive for audio CDs 168

16 Switching Entertainment sound output on/off and adjusting volume 168

18 Controller 16 Turn, press or move horizontally in four directions

19 Opening start menu on Control Display 17

Temperature setting, left/right 115

Automatic air distribution and volume 115

Cooling function 117

AUC Automatic recirculated-air control 117

Recirculated-air mode 117

Maximum cooling 117

Air volume 116

Defrosting windows and removing condensation 116

Rear window defroster 114

17 Heated seats* 51

Active seat ventilation* 52

Adjusting active backrest width* 47

Active seat* 52

PDC Park Distance Control* 90

DTC Dynamic Traction Control 92

Opening luggage compartment lid/ tailgate* 33, 35

iD ri

ve

16

iDrive

iDrive combines the functions of a large number of switches. This allows these functions to be operated from a central position. The following section provides an introduction to basic menu

navigation. The control of the individual func- tions is described in connection with the rele- vant equipment.

Controls

1 Control Display

2 button Opening start menu

3 Controller With the controller you can select menu items and make settings:

> move in four directions, arrows 4

> turn, arrow 5

> press, arrow 6

To avoid posing an unnecessary hazard due to inattention, both to your own vehi-

cle's occupants and to other road users: never attempt to use the controls or make entries unless traffic and road conditions allow.<

A t

a g

la n

ce

17

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Menu overview

Communication > Telephone* > BMW Assist* or TeleService*

Navigation or onboard information > Navigation system* > Onboard information, e.g. for displaying

the average fuel consumption

Entertainment > Radio

> CD player and CD changer* > AUX-In connection

> USB/audio interface*

Climate > Vent settings

> Automatic programs

> Seat heater distribution* > Parked car operation*

menu > Switching off Control Display

> Tone and display settings

> Settings for your vehicle, e.g. for the central locking system

> Display of maintenance intervals and dead- lines for legally mandated inspections

> Settings for telephone

Operating principle From radio readiness, refer to page 61, the fol- lowing message is shown on the Control Dis- play:

To hide the message: Press the controller. This displays the start menu.

The message is automatically hidden after approx. 10 seconds.

Start menu

You can call up all the functions of iDrive using five menu items.

Opening start menu Press the button.

To open the start menu from the menu:

Press the button twice.

iD ri

ve

18

Opening menu items of start menu

With the start menu you can open the menu items Communication, Navigation, Entertain- ment and Climate by moving the controller to the left, right, front or rear.

You can open the menu by pressing the con- troller.

Comfort opening of menu items Comfort opening offers you:

> Opening of a menu item of the start menu in the last display shown

> Direct changing between Communication, Navigation, Entertainment and Climate without pressing the button

To do so, move the controller in the corre- sponding direction and hold it for approx. 2 sec- onds.

Displays in menu

1 Each menu is divided into fields. The respective active field is highlighted.

2 A symbol indicates the last selected menu item of the start menu:

1 Menu items are usually grouped in horizon- tal or vertical lists.

2 In these lists, arrows indicate the possibility of accessing other menu items that are not currently visible.

3 Settings are displayed graphically or numerically.

Communication

Navigation or onboard information

Entertainment

Climate

menu

A t

a g

la n

ce

19

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Operating principle at a glance Basic operation via iDrive is described in this view.

You can view the individual steps under Settings on Control Display, Setting time, refer to page 86.

1 Selecting menu item:

> Turn the controller; the highlight moves

> Menu items shown in white can be selected by highlighting

2 Activating menu item:

> Press the controller

> New menu items are displayed or the function is carried out

3 Selecting menu item: refer to 1

4 Changing between fields:

> Briefly move the controller left, right, forward or back

> Release controller

> Active field appears lighter

5 Adjusting settings:

> Turn controller

> Graphic display, numerical value or text displays can be changed

> Confirmation by changing field

iD ri

ve

20

Status information

1 Display for:

> Entertainment: Radio, CD

> Telephone* in "Communication": Name of linked mobile phone, network search or no network

> "BMW Assist"*: Existing voice connection with a service from BMW Assist

2 Entertainment sound output off

3 Station that transmits traffic information is received*:

"TI": Reception of traffic information for the nav- igation systemis possible and activated

4 Display for:

> New entries present in "Missed calls"* > Roaming active

5 Telephoning* is possible if the mobile phone is paired in the vehicle

Reception strength of mobile phone network, dependent on mobile phone

6 Time

Other displays: The status information is temporarily hidden when there are Check Control instructions or inputs via the voice command system*.

Assistance window*

Additional information appears in the assis- tance window:

> The computer or the trip computer* > The arrow or map view with a navigation

system* > The current position

Selecting display 1. Move the controller to the right to change to

the assistance window and press the con- troller.

2. Select a menu item.

3. Press the controller.

A t

a g

la n

ce

21

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Switching assistance window off/on 1. Move the controller to the right to change to

the assistance window and press the con- troller.

2. Select "Assist. window off" and press the controller.

To switch on, change to the assistance window and press the controller.

Switching Control Display off/on 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Display off" and press the control- ler.

To switch on, press the controller.

Programmable memory/ direct selection buttons You can save and run certain functions of iDrive on the programmable memory/direct selection buttons:

> Destinations of navigation

> Telephone, phone numbers

> Entertainment:

> radio station

> CD

> CD compartment of CD changer* > AUX

The assignment of the programmable memory/ direct selection buttons is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Saving function

Destinations of navigation 1. Select navigation destination, e.g. in the

destination list or the address book.

2. Press the ... button longer than 2 seconds.

Special features:

> With the destination guidance system and the map view started, the current destina- tion is stored.

> During destination entry via a map, the coordinates at the cursor are stored, not the current destination.

Telephone, phone numbers 1. Enter the phone number or select it in a list

of the stored phone numbers, e.g. of the A-Z list.

2. Press the ... button longer than 2 seconds.

If a name is assigned to the phone number, the name will also be stored.

iD ri

ve

22

Entertainment In the Entertainment menu, the sound source currently heard, e.g. a radio station, is stored, regardless of the selection on the Control Dis- play.

1. Select the desired function, e.g. radio sta- tion or CD.

2. Press the ... button longer than 2 seconds.

If the vehicle is equipped with two drives, the current track is stored for CDs with

compressed audio files.<

Run function Press the ... button.

When selecting a phone number, the connec- tion is also established, or the destination guid- ance is started when a navigation destination is selected.

Displaying button assignment You can display the assignment of the buttons by touching them with your finger. Please do not wear gloves when doing so. Touching with an object, e.g. a pen, does not function.

Displaying short info Touch the ... button.

The assignment of the buttons is displayed.

Destination of navigation system

Entertainment source

Telephone, phone number

Not assigned

Displaying detailed information Touch the ... button longer.

Deleting button assignments 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Select "Programmable Memory Keys" and press the controller.

6. Select "Delete assignment of all memory keys" and press the controller.

7. Acknowledge with "Yes".

A t

a g

la n

ce

23

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Voice command system

The concept The voice command system allows you to con- trol operation of various vehicle systems with- out taking your hands off the steering wheel.

Individual menu items on the Control Display can be spoken as commands. This frees you of having to use the controller.

The voice command system transforms your oral commands into control signals for the selected systems and provides support in the form of instructions or questions.

The voice command system uses a special microphone located in the area of the interior rearview mirror, refer to page 14.

Precondition Via iDrive, set the language that applies for the voice command system in order to enable iden- tification of the spoken commands. To set the language of iDrive, refer to page 88.

Symbols in Owner's Manual

Voice commands

Activating voice command system 1. Press the button.

This symbol on the Control Display and an acoustic signal tell you that the voice command system can respond to com- mands.

2. Say the command. The command is displayed on the Control Display.

This symbol is shown on the Control Display when you can input additional commands.

*

{...} Say the specified commands word for word. {{...}} Indicates responses of the voice command system.

V o

ic e

co m

m an

d s

ys te

m

24

If no other commands are possible, then oper- ate the equipment via iDrive.

Terminating or canceling voice command system Press the button on the steering wheel or

Commands

Having possible commands read aloud You can have the system read aloud the possi- ble commands related to the selected menu item on the Control Display. To have the system list the possible com- mands:

For example, if you have selected "CD", the system will read aloud the possible commands for operating the CD player and the CD changer*.

Opening help

Using alternative commands There are often a number of commands to run a function, e.g.:

Running functions directly with short commands With short commands you can run certain func- tions directly, regardless of which menu item is selected, refer to page 259.

Opening start menu

Example: selecting a track 1. Switch on Entertainment sound output if

necessary.

2. Press the button on the steering wheel.

5. Press the button on the steering wheel.

{Cancel}

{Options}

{Help}

{Radio on} or {Turn radio on}

{Main menu}

3. {Entertainment} The system says: {{Entertainment}}

4. {CD} The system says: {{CD on}}

6. Select track, e.g.: {Track 1} The system says: {{Track 1}}

A t

a g

la n

ce

25

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Notes The mobile phone can also be operated with voice commands, refer to

page 205.<

For voice commands, bear the following in mind:

> Say the commands and numbers smoothly and at normal volume, avoiding excessive emphasis and pauses. This also applies to spelling when entering the destination.

> Always issue commands in the language of the voice command system.

> When selecting a radio station, use the common pronunciation of the station name.

> For entries in the voice-activated phone book, only use names in the language of the voice command system and do not use abbreviations.

> Keep the doors, windows and glass sun- roof* or panorama glass sunroof* closed to prevent interference from ambient noise.

> Avoid making other noise in the vehicle while speaking.

Controls This chapter is intended to provide you with

information for complete control of your vehicle. Its extensive array of features and accessories,

both for driving and for your own safety, comfort and convenience, are described here.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

28

Opening and closing

Keys/remote control

1 Remote control with integrated key

2 Spare key

3 Adapter for spare key, in glove compart- ment

Remote control with integrated key Each remote control contains a battery which is charged in the ignition lock while driving. Drive a longer distance with each remote control at least twice a year to keep the battery charged. For comfort access*, the remote control con- tains a replaceable battery, refer to page 40.

Depending on which remote control is detected by the vehicle during unlocking, different set- tings are activated and executed in the vehicle, refer to Personal Profile, page 29.

Information on the required for maintenance is also stored in the remote control, refer to Ser- vice data in remote control, page 235.

Integrated key

Press button 1 to unlock the key.

The integrated key fits the following locks:

> Glove compartment, refer to page 123

> Sports Wagon: floor panel flap in cargo bay, refer to page 129

> Driver's door, refer to page 32

> Luggage compartment lid, refer to page 33.

New remote controls To obtain additional or replace lost keys, new remote controls with an integrated key are available at your BMW center.

Spare key Store the spare key in a safe place such as your wallet. This key is not intended for regular use.

The spare key and integrated key fit the same locks.

Adapter for spare key The adapter is required so that the vehicle can be started with the spare key or radio readiness can be switched on.

Remove the adapter from the holder in the glove compartment and slide the spare key into the adapter before use.

C o

n tr

o ls

29

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Personal Profile

The concept You can set a number of functions of your BMW individually according to your preferences. Personal Profile ensures that most of these set- tings are stored for the remote control currently in use without you having to do anything. When the vehicle is unlocked, the corresponding remote control is detected and the settings stored for it are called up and carried out.

This means that you will always find your BMW set to your own personal settings even if another person with his/her own remote control and settings has used the vehicle since the last time you drove it. The individual settings are stored for a maximum of four remote controls.

Personal Profile settings Details on the settings are provided on the specified pages.

> Behavior of the central locking system when unlocking vehicle, refer to page 30

> Automatic locking of the vehicle, refer to page 32

> Programming buttons* on steering wheel, refer to page 54

> Displays on Control Display:

> Brightness of the Control Display, refer to page 88

> Measuring units for consumption, route/ distances, temperature, and pressure, refer to page 88

> 12h/24h clock format, refer to page 87

> Date format, refer to page 87

> Language on Control Display, refer to page 88

> Lighting settings:

> Triple turn signal activation, refer to page 67

> Welcome lamps, refer to page 108

> Pathway lighting, refer to page 109

> Daytime running lamps*, refer to page 109

> High-beam assistant*, refer to page 110

> PDC Park Distance Control*: optical warn- ing, refer to page 90

> Head-Up Display*: selection and bright- ness of display, refer to page 102

> BMW Night Vision*: display settings, refer to page 105

> Automatic climate control: AUTO program and intensity, cooling function, and auto- matic recirculated air control/recirculated air mode, temperature, air distribution, tem- perature in the upper body region, refer to text starting on page 115

> Navigation system*: voice instructions for destination guidance, refer to page 142

In addition, the following, most recently selected settings are recalled during unlocking:

> Programmable memory/direct selection buttons: selecting stored functions, refer to page 21

> Positions of driver's seat, outside mirrors, and steering wheel*, refer to page 47

> Audio sources: volume and tone settings, refer to page 169

> Radio:

> Display of stored stations, refer to page 172

> Switching RDS Radio Data System on/ off*, refer to page 175

> Phone: volume setting, refer to pages 200, 206

Central locking system

The concept The central locking system is ready for opera- tion whenever the driver's door is closed.

The system simultaneously engages and releases the locks on the following:

> Doors

> Luggage compartment lid or tailgate and rear window

> Fuel filler door

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

30

Operating from outside > via the remote control

> via the door lock

> with comfort access* via the door handles

At the same time, the anti-theft system is also operated. It prevents the doors from being unlocked using the lock buttons or door han- dles. In addition, it the remote control is used, the welcome lamps, the interior lamps and the courtesy lamps* are switched on or off. The alarm systemis armed/disarmed at the same time. You can find more detailed information on the alarm systemon page 37.

Operating from inside Via the button for central locking, refer to page 32. The fuel filler door is not locked.

In the event of a sufficiently severe accident, the central locking system unlocks automatically. In addition, the hazard warning flashers and inte- rior lamps come on.

Opening and closing: Using remote control

Persons or animals left unattended in a parked vehicle can lock the doors from

the inside. Always take along the remote control when leaving the vehicle so that the vehicle can then be opened from the outside.<

Unlocking Press the button. The interior lamps, the courtesy lamps* of the doors and the welcome lamps are switched on.

You can set how the vehicle is unlocked. The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Door locks" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Central locking" and press the con- troller.

7. Select "Unlock button" and press the con- troller.

8. Select a menu item:

> "All doors" Pressing the button once unlocks the entire vehicle.

> "Driver's door only" Pressing the button once unlocks the driver's door and the fuel filler door. Pressing the button twice unlocks the entire vehicle.

9. Press the controller.

Comfort opening Press and hold the button. The windows and the glass sunroof* open.

Locking Press the button.

C o

n tr

o ls

31

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Do not lock the vehicle from the outside if persons are inside, as unlocking from the

inside is not possible without special knowl- edge.<

Switching on interior lamps With vehicle locked: Press the button. You can also use this function to locate your vehicle in parking garages etc.

Panic mode* You can trigger the alarm system in case of dan- ger:

Press the button for at least 3 seconds.

Switching off alarm: press any button.

Sedan: opening luggage compartment lid Press the button for approx. 1 second.

The luggage compartment lid opens, regard- less of whether it was previously locked or unlocked.

During opening, the luggage compart- ment lid pivots back and up. Make sure

that adequate clearance is available before opening. To prevent accidentally locking yourself out, never lay the remote control in the cargo bay. A previously locked luggage compartment lid is also locked again after closing.<

Sports Wagon: unlocking tailgate Press the button for approx. 1 second.

The tailgate will open slightly, regardless of whether it was previously locked or unlocked.

During opening, the tailgate pivots back and up. Make sure that adequate clear-

ance is available before opening. To prevent accidentally locking yourself out, never lay the remote control in the cargo bay. A previously locked tailgate is also locked again after closing. When opening the tailgate, the roll-up cover is raised.<

If pointed or sharp-edged objects could strike the rear window while driving, be

sure to provide protection around all edges. Failure to do so could result in damage to the heating conductors of the rear window.<

Confirmation signals You can activate or deactivate the confirmation signals.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Door locks" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Confirmation" and press the con- troller.

7. Select the desired signal.

8. Press the controller. The signal is activated.

Malfunction The remote control may malfunction due to local radio waves. Should the remote control fail to operate due to interference of this kind, unlock and lock the vehicle via the door lock using a key.

If it is no longer possible to lock the vehicle using the remote control, then the battery is discharged. Use this remote control during an extended drive; this will recharge the battery, refer to page 28.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

32

For US owners only The transmitter and receiver units comply with part 15 of the FCC/Federal Communication Commission regulations. Operation is gov- erned by the following:

FCC ID: LX8766S LX8766E LX8CAS LX8CAS2

Compliance statement: This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

> This device must not cause harmful inter- ference, and

> this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

Any unauthorized modifications or changes to these devices could void the

user's authority to operate this equipment.<

Using door lock Do not lock the vehicle from the outside if persons are inside, as unlocking from the

inside is not possible without special knowl- edge.<

When unlocking 1. Turning the key once unlocks the driver's

door and the fuel filler door.

2. Turning the key a second time unlocks the remaining doors and the luggage compart- ment lid/tailgate.

Convenient operation You also have the option of operating the win- dows and the glass sunroof* from the driver's door lock.

Turn and hold the key in the positions for unlocking or locking.

Watch during the closing process to be sure that no one is injured. Releasing the

key stops the operation.<

Manual operation In the event of an electrical malfunction, you can turn a key all the way to the right or left in the door lock to lock or unlock the driver's door.

Opening and closing: from inside

This button serves to unlock or lock doors and the luggage compartment lid or tailgate and rear window with the front doors closed, but does not activate the anti-theft system. The fuel filler door remains unlocked.

Automatic locking iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Door locks" is selected and press the controller.

C o

n tr

o ls

33

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

6. Select "Central locking" and press the con- troller.

7. Select a menu item:

> "Relock door if not opened" The central locking system locks again after a short time if no door has been opened.

> "Lock after driving" The central locking system locks the vehicle as soon as you start to drive.

8. Press the controller. The setting is selected.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Unlocking and opening > Either unlock the doors together with the

button for the central locking system and then pull the door handle above the armrest or

> pull on the door handle of each door twice: the first time unlocks the door, the second time opens it.

Locking > Use the central locking button to lock all of

the doors simultaneously, or

> press down the lock button of a door. To prevent you from being locked out, the open driver's door cannot be locked using the lock button.

Persons or animals left unattended in a parked vehicle can lock the doors from

the inside. Always take along the remote control when leaving the vehicle so that the vehicle can then be opened from the outside.<

Doors

Automatic soft closing* To close the doors, merely push them gently. The closing process will then be carried out automatically.

Make sure that the closing path of the doors is clear; otherwise injuries may

result.<

Luggage compartment lid/ tailgate

During opening, the luggage compart- ment lid/tailgate pivots back and up. Make

sure that adequate clearance is available before opening.<

Sedan

Opening from inside

Press button 1 or button 2*: the luggage com- partment lid opens unless it has been locked.

Opening from outside

Press the button on the luggage compartment lid or the button on the remote control for

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

34

approx. 1 second: the luggage compartment lid opens.

All keys, refer to page 28, fit the luggage-com- partment lid lock.

Locking separately Turn a key in the lock of the luggage compart- ment lid to the right past a resistance point and remove it in the horizontal position.

This locks the luggage compartment lid and disconnects it from the central locking system. If you then hand over the remote control without the integrated key, refer to page 28, no access is possible via the luggage compartment lid. This is an advantage when using valet parking, for example.

Unlocking again and opening manually Turn the key toward the left up to the stop: the luggage compartment lid opens.

If you use the lock to unlock the luggage compartment lid while the alarm system

is armed, the alarm will be triggered. You should therefore unlock the vehicle ahead of time. If the alarm is inadvertently triggered: switch off the alarm, refer to page 37.<

Closing Make sure that the closing path of the luggage compartment lid is clear, other-

wise injuries may result.<

The handle recesses on the interior trim of the luggage compartment lid make it easier to pull down.

Emergency release

Pull the lever in the cargo bay. The luggage compartment lid is unlocked.

Sports Wagon: opening and closing rear window Small items can be loaded and unloaded quickly when the rear window is opened sepa- rately.

Press the button: the rear window opens some- what. It can be swung upward.

Press the window closed to close.

When opening the rear window, the roll- up cover is raised.<

C o

n tr

o ls

35

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

If pointed or sharp-edged objects could strike the rear window while driving, be

sure to provide protection around all edges. Failure to do so could result in damage to the heating conductors of the rear window.<

Automatic roll-up cover* When opening the rear window, the roll-up cover is raised, and when the rear window is closed, it is lowered.

Make sure that the closing area of the roll- up cover is clear of obstructions, other-

wise the payload or the roll-up cover may be damaged.<

Details on the roll-up cover are provided on page 128.

Sports Wagon: tailgate

Opening from inside

Press button 1 or button 2*: the tailgate opens unless it has been locked.

Opening from outside

Press the button on the tailgate or the but- ton on the remote control for approx. 1 second: The tailgate opens somewhat. It can be swung upward.

When opening the tailgate, the roll-up cover is raised. Before closing the tail-

gate, press down the roll-up cover until it engages.<

Opening manually In case of an electrical malfunction:

1. From the cargo bay, press out the cover 1 on the tailgate with a screwdriver.

2. Press the locking bar 2 in the direction of the arrow.

3. Open the tailgate and press in the cover again.

The tailgate is locked again as soon as it is closed.

Closing Make sure that the closing path of the tail- gate is clear, otherwise injuries may

result.<

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

36

The handle recesses on the interior trim of the tailgate make it easier to pull down.

To close the tailgate, merely press it down gen- tly. The closing process will then be carried out automatically.

Sports Wagon: automatic tailgate operation*

Adjusting opening height You can adjust how far the tailgate is to open.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Door locks" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Tailgate" and press the controller.

7. Turn the controller. The adjustment is applied; the field can be changed.

Opening tailgate The tailgate opens automatically when you:

> Press the button on the outside of the tail- gate when the vehicle is unlocked.

> Press button 1 or button 2*.

> Press the button on the remote control for approx. 1 second.

During opening, the tailgate pivots back and up. Make sure that adequate clear-

ance is available before opening.<

Automatic roll-up cover When the tailgate or rear window are opened, the roll-up cover is raised, and when the tailgate and rear window are closed, it is lowered.

Make sure that the closing area of the roll- up cover is clear of obstructions, other-

wise the payload or the roll-up cover may be damaged.<

Details on the roll-up cover are provided on page 128.

C o

n tr

o ls

37

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Closing tailgate Make sure that the closing path of the tail- gate is clear, otherwise injuries may

result.<

The tailgate closes automatically when the but- ton on the inside of the tailgate is pressed.

To interrupt the opening or closing process:

> Press the button on the inside of the tail- gate.

> Press the button on the outside of the tail- gate.

Closing is not canceled when you put the vehicle into motion.<

Alarm system

The concept The vehicle alarm system responds:

> When a door, the hood or the luggage com- partment lid/tailgate or rear window are opened

> To movements in the vehicle: interior motion sensor, refer to page 38

> To changes in the vehicle's tilt if someone attempts to steal the wheels or tow the vehicle

> To interruptions in battery voltage

Unauthorized operations are briefly signaled by the alarm system:

> with an acoustic alarm

> by switching onthe hazard warning flashers

> by flashing the high beams

Arming and disarming alarm system When you lock or unlock the vehicle, either with the remote control or at the door lock, the alarm system is armed or disarmed at the same time.

The luggage compartment lid/tailgate can also be opened with the system armed with the button on the remote control, refer to page 33. When the luggage compartment lid/tailgate is closed, it is locked and monitored again.

Switching off alarm > Unlock the vehicle using the remote control,

refer to page 30.

> Insert the remote control all the way into the ignition lock.

Indicator lamp displays

> The indicator lamp under the interior rear- view mirror flashes continuously: the sys- tem is armed.

> The indicator lamp flashes after locking: doors, hood, luggage compartment lid/tail- gate or rear windoware not properly closed. Even if you do not close the alerted area, the system begins to monitor the remaining areas, and the indicator lamp flashes con- tinuously after approx. 10 seconds. How- ever, the interior motion sensor is not acti- vated.

> The indicator lamp goes out after unlocking: your vehicle has not been disturbed while you were away.

> The indicator lamp flashes after unlocking until the remote control is inserted into the ignition lock, however for a maximum of approx. 5 minutes: your vehicle has been disturbed while you were away.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

38

Tilt alarm sensor The tilt of the vehicle is monitored. The alarm system reacts, e.g. in case of an attempted wheel theft or towing.

Interior motion sensor In order for the interior motion sensor to func- tion properly, the windows and glass sunroof* must be completely closed.

Avoiding unintentional alarms The tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor may be switched off at the same time. This pre- vents unintentional alarms, e.g. in the following situations:

> In two-level garages

> When transporting on car-carrying trains, by sea or on a trailer

> When animals are to remain in the vehicle

Switching off tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor Press the button on the remote control again as soon as the vehicle is locked.

The indicator lamp lights up briefly and then flashes continuously. The tilt alarm sensor and the interior motion sensor are switched off until the next time the vehicle is unlocked and subse- quently locked again.

Comfort access* Comfort access allows you to access your vehi- cle without having to hold the remote control in your hand. It is sufficient to carry the remote control with you, e.g. in your jacket pocket. The vehicle automatically detects the associated remote control in the immediate vicinity or in the interior.

Comfort access supports the following func- tions:

> Unlocking/locking vehicle

> Comfort closing

> Opening luggage compartment lid/tailgate separately

> Sports Wagon: opening rear window sepa- rately

> Starting engine

Functional requirement > The vehicle or the luggage compartment

lid/tailgate can only be locked if the vehicle detects that the remote control you are car- rying is outside the vehicle.

> The next unlocking and locking cycle is not possible until after approx. 2 seconds.

> The engine can only be started if the vehicle detects that the remote control is located in the vehicle.

Comparison with ordinary remote control You can control the functions mentioned previ- ously with the comfort access or by pressing the buttons on the remote control. Therefore, please familiarize yourself with the information on opening and closing beginning on page 28 beforehand.

The special features when using comfort access are described in the following.

Should a short delay occur when opening or closing the windows or the glass sun-

roof, the system is checking whether a remote control is located in the vehicle. Please repeat opening or closing if necessary.<

Unlocking

Grasp a door handle fully, refer to arrow 1, but do not touch the surfaces, arrow 2 or 3 when doing so. This corresponds to pressing the button.

C o

n tr

o ls

39

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Locking > On the driver's door, touch the highlighted

surface, arrow 2, with a finger for approx. 1 second, but do not grasp the door handle.

> On the remaining doors, touch the high- lighted surface, arrow 3, with the back of your hand for approx. 1 second, but do not grasp the door handle.

This corresponds to pressing the but- ton.

Please make sure that the ignition and all electronic systems/consumers are

switched off before locking to save the bat- tery.<

Comfort closing Hold a finger or the back of your hand against the surface, arrow 2 or 3, but do not grasp the door handle while doing so.

The windows and the glass sunroof* are closed.

Watch during the closing process to be sure that no one is injured. Removing the

hand from the door handle stops the closing process immediately.<

Opening luggage compartment lid/ tailgate separately Press the button on the luggage compartment lid/tailgate. This corresponds to pressing the

button.

If a remote control accidentally left in the cargo bay is detected in the locked vehi-

cle after closing the luggage compartment lid/ tailgate or the rear window, the lid or rear win- dow opens again. The hazard warning flashers flash and a signal* sounds.<

Sports Wagon: opening rear window separately Press the button on the rear window, refer to page 34.

Switching on radio readiness By pressing the Start/Stop button, you switch on the radio readiness, refer to page 61.

When doing so, do not depress the brake or clutch pedal, otherwise the engine will

start immediately.<

Starting engine You can start the engine or switch on the igni- tion if a remote control is located in the interior of the vehicle. It need not be inserted in the igni- tion lock, refer to page 61.

If you take the remote control with you when leaving the vehicle with the engine running, a warning lamp lights up. In addition, a message appears on the Control Display. As long as no remote control is detected, it is only possible to restart the engine within approx. 10 seconds after it is switched off.

Switching off engine with automatic and sport automatic transmission The engine can only be switched off in trans- mission position P, refer to page 62. To switch off the engine in transmission posi- tion N, the remote control must be inserted in the ignition lock.

Before driving into a car wash with automatic and sport automatic transmission 1. Insert remote control into ignition lock.

2. Depress brake pedal.

3. Engage transmission position N.

4. Switch off the engine.

The vehicle can roll.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

40

Malfunction The comfort access function may malfunction due to local radio waves. Then open or close the vehicle with the buttons on the remote control or with a key. To start the engine following this, insert the remote control in the ignition lock.

When unlocking or locking/comfort closing do not simultaneously grasp the door handle and touch the surfaces, arrow 2 or 3. Otherwise, you may limit the function.

Replacing battery If the battery of the remote control is dead, a message will appear in the Control Display.

1. Remove integrated key from remote con- trol, refer to page 28.

2. Remove cover.

3. Lay in new battery with positive side facing upward.

4. Press cover closed.

Return used battery to a recycling collec- tion point or to your BMW center.<

Windows To prevent injuries, exercise care when closing the windows and keep them in

your field of vision until they are shut. Always take along the remote control when you leave the vehicle, otherwise children could, for example, operate the windows and injure them- selves.<

Opening, closing

> Press switch to resistance point: The window continues to open as long as you keep the switch pressed.

> Press switch beyond resistance point: The window opens automatically. Pressing the switch again stops the opening move- ment.

You can close the windows in the same manner by pulling the switch.

Separate switches for the rear windows are located in the rear.

For information on using the convenient opera- tion at the door lock or with the remote control, refer to page 30 or 32.

For information on comfort closing with comfort access, refer to page 39.

After switching off ignition You can still operate the windows with the remote control removed or the ignition switched off for approx. 1 minute, as long as neither of the front doors has been opened.

C o

n tr

o ls

41

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Pinch protection system If the closing force exceeds a specific value as a window closes, the closing action is interrupted and the window reopens slightly.

Despite the pinch protection system, inspect the window's travel path prior to

closing it, as the safety system might fail to detect certain kinds of obstructions, such as thin objects, and the window would continue closing. Do not install any accessories in the range of movement of the windows, otherwise the pinch protection system will be impaired.<

Closing without pinch protection system In case of danger from outside or if, for example, ice on the window prevents normal closing, pro- ceed as follows:

1. Pull the switch beyond the resistance point and hold. The pinch protection system is limited and the window opens slightly if the closing force exceeds a certain value.

2. Pull the switch beyond the resistance point and hold again within approx. 4 seconds. The window closes without the pinch pro- tection system.

Safety switch

With the safety switch, you can prevent the rear windows from being opened or closed via the switches in the rear passenger area, by chil- dren, for example. The LED lights up when this safety feature is activated.

Always press the safety switch when chil- dren ride in the rear, otherwise uncon-

trolled closing of the windows could lead to injuries.<

Glass sunroof*, electric The glass sunroof is ready for operation with the ignition switched on, refer to page 61.

To prevent injuries, exercise care when closing the glass sunroof and keep it in

your field of vision until it is closed. Always take along the remote control when you leave the vehicle, otherwise children could, for example, operate the roof and injure them- selves.<

Raising Press the switch. The closed glass sunroof is raised and the slid- ing visor opens slightly.

Do not use force to close the sliding visor with the glass sunroof in its raised posi-

tion, otherwise the mechanism will be dam- aged.<

Opening, closing > Slide the switch back to the resistance

point. The glass sunroof and the sliding visor open together for as long as you hold the switch in this position.

> Briefly press the switch back beyond the resistance point. The glass sunroof and the sliding visor open automatically. Briefly pressing the switch stops the motion.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

42

In a similar manner, the glass sunroof closes when you slide the switch forward. The sliding visor remains open and can be closed by hand.

For information on using the convenient opera- tion at the door lock or with the remote control, refer to page 30 or 32.

For information on comfort closing with comfort access, refer to page 39.

Opening and closing automatically Briefly press the switch beyond the resistance point.

The following movements are also automatic:

> Press the switch with the sunroof open: the sunroof is raised all the way.

> When the sunroof is raised, briefly press the switch in the opening direction: the sunroof is opened all the way.

Briefly pressing the switch stops the motion.

Pinch protection system If the glass sunroof encounters resistance when closing from roughly the center of the roof opening or when closing from the raised posi- tion, the closing action is interrupted and the glass sunroof reopens a short way.

Despite the pinch protection system, inspect the sunroof's travel path prior to

closing it, as the safety system might fail to detect certain kinds of obstructions, such as very thin objects, and the sunroof would con- tinue closing.<

Closing without pinch protection system In case of danger from outside, slide the switch forward beyond the resistance point and hold. The roof closes without the pinch protection system.

Following interruptions in electrical power supply After a power loss, the sunroof may only respond to the raise command. Then have the system initialized. BMW recommends having this work done by your BMW center.

Moving manually* In the event of an electrical malfunction, you can move the glass sunroof manually.

1. Fold the cover panel down, if necessary using a screwdriver from the onboard tool kit, refer to page 237.

2. Insert the Allen wrench supplied with the onboard tool kit, refer to page 237, into the opening provided. Move the glass sunroof in the desired direction. The arrow below indicates the rotation direction for closing.

C o

n tr

o ls

43

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Sports Wagon: Panorama glass sunroof The panorama glass sunroof is ready for opera- tion with the ignition switched on, refer to page 61.

To prevent injuries, exercise care when closing the panorama glass sunroof and

keep it in your field of vision until it is closed. Always take along the remote control when you leave the vehicle, otherwise children could, for example, operate the roof and injure them- selves.<

Raising Press the switch. The closed sunroof is raised and the sliding visor opens slightly.

Do not use force to close the sliding visor with the glass sunroof in its raised posi-

tion, otherwise the mechanism will be dam- aged.<

Opening, closing

Sliding visor You can move the sliding visor independently with the sunroof closed or raised.

> Slide the switch back to the resistance point. The sliding visor opens as long as you keep the switch in this position.

> Briefly press the switch back beyond the resistance point. The sliding visor will open automatically. Briefly pressing the switch stops the motion.

You can close the sliding visor in a similar man- ner by sliding the switch forwards.

Panorama glass sunroof With the sliding visor open, proceed as described under Sliding visor.

For information on using the convenient opera- tion at the door lock or with the remote control, refer to page 30 or 32.

For information on comfort closing with comfort access, refer to page 39.

Opening and closing sunroof and sliding visor together Briefly press the switch beyond the resistance point twice consecutively.

Briefly pressing the switch stops the motion.

Comfort modes > Press the switch twice with the sunroof

open: The sunroof is raised.

> When the sunroof is raised, briefly press the switch twice in the opening direction: The sunroof is opened all the way.

Comfort position The sunroof is not completely open in the com- fort position. This reduces the wind noises in the interior.

Each time the panorama glass sunroof is com- pletely opened or closed, it stops in the comfort position. If desired, continue the motion follow- ing this with the switch.

Pinch protection system If the panorama glass sunroof or sliding visor encounter resistance when closing from roughly one third of the sunroof opening or when closing from the raised position, the clos- ing action is interrupted and the panorama glass sunroof and sliding visor reopen a little.

Despite the pinch protection system, inspect the sunroof's travel path prior to

closing it, as the safety system might fail to detect certain kinds of obstructions, such as

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

44

very thin objects, and the sunroof would con- tinue closing.<

Closing without pinch protection system In case of danger from outside, slide the switch forward beyond the resistance point and hold. The roof closes without the pinch protection system.

Following interruptions in electrical power supply After a power loss, the sunroof may only respond to the raise command. Then have the system initialized. BMW recommends having this work done by your BMW center.

Moving manually* In the event of an electrical malfunction, you can move the sunroof manually.

1. Fold back the cover, using the screwdriver from the toolkit at the points indicated if necessary, refer to page 237.

2. Remove the Allen key from the mounting next to the toolkit and insert it in the open- ing provided. Move the sunroof in the desired direction. The arrow below indi- cates the rotation direction for closing.

C o

n tr

o ls

45

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Adjusting

Sitting safely The ideal sitting position can make a vital con- tribution to relaxed, fatigue-free driving. In the interaction with the safety belts, the head restraints and the airbags, the sitting position plays an important role in an accident. To ensure that the safety systems operate with optimal efficiency, we strongly urge you to observe the instructions contained in the fol- lowing section.

For additional information on transporting chil- dren safely, refer to page 56.

Airbags Always maintain an adequate distance between yourself and the airbags. Always

hold the steering wheel by its rim with hands at the 9 o'clock and 3 o'clock positions, to mini- mize the risk of injuries to your hands and arms in the event of airbag deployment. No one and nothing is to come between the air- bags and the seat occupant. Do not use the cover of the front airbag on the front passenger side as a storage area. Make sure that the front passenger is sitting correctly and does not rest feet or legs on the instrument panel, otherwise leg injuries can occur if the front airbags are triggered. Make sure that occupants do not rest their head on the side or head airbags, otherwise injuries can occur if the airbags are triggered.<

Even if you adhere to all the instructions, inju- ries resulting from contact with airbags cannot be fully excluded, depending on the circum- stances. The ignition and inflation noise may provoke a mild hearing loss in extremely sensi- tive individuals. This effect is usually only tem- porary.

For airbag locations and additional information on airbags, refer to page 100.

Head restraints A correctly adjusted head restraint reduces the risk of spinal injury in the event of an accident.

Adjust the head restraint so that its center is approx. at ear level. Otherwise there is

increased danger of injury in the event of an accident.<

Head restraints, refer to page 49.

Safety belts Before every drive, make sure that safety belts are being worn at all of the occupied seats. Air- bags complement the safety belt as an addi- tional safety device, but they do not represent a substitute.

Your vehicle is provided with five seats, which are all equipped with a safety belt.

Never allow more than one person to wear a single safety belt. Never allow

infants or small children to ride in a passenger's lap. Make sure that the belt lies low around the hips in the lap area and does not press on the abdomen. The safety belt must not lie across the neck, rub against sharp edges, be routed over solid or breakable objects or be pinched. Wear the safety belt without twisting, snugly across the lap and shoulders, as close to the body as possible. Otherwise the belt can slip over the hips in the lap area in a frontal impact and injure the abdomen. Avoid wearing clothing that prevents the belt from fitting properly and pull the belt in the upper body area periodically to readjust the tension, in order to avoid a reduction in the restraint of the safety belt. Sports Wagon: if the center safety belt in the rear is used, the larger backrest half must be locked, refer to page 128, otherwise the middle safety belt has no restraining action.<

Safety belts, refer to page 50.

A d

ju st

in g

46

Seats

Note before adjusting Never attempt to adjust your seat while the vehicle is moving. The seat could

respond with unexpected movement, and the ensuing loss of vehicle control could lead to an accident. Also on the passenger side, do not incline the backrest too far to the rear while the vehicle is being driven, otherwise there is a danger in the event of an accident of sliding under the safety belt, eliminating the protection normally pro- vided by the belt.<

Please follow the instructions on damage to safety belts provided on page 51 and the infor- mation on the active front head restraintson page 49.

Adjusting seat To ensure that the safety systems con- tinue to provide optimized protection,

please observe the adjustment instructions on page 45.<

1 Longitudinal direction

2 Height

3 Angle

4 Backrest

Adjusting comfort seat* In this seat, you can also adjust:

1 Backrest width

2 Shoulder support

3 Thigh support

4 Lumbar support*

Shoulder support the adjustable upper backrest also supports the back in the shoulder region. This provides a relaxed driving position and helps relieve stress on the shoulder muscles.

C o

n tr

o ls

47

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Lumbar support*

You can also adjust the contour of the backrest to obtain additional support in the lumbar region.

The upper hips and spinal column receive sup- plementary support to help you maintain a relaxed, upright sitting position.

> Increase or decrease curvature: press front or rear section of switch.

> Shift curvature up or down: press upper or lowers section of switch.

Adjusting active backrest width* First set a comfortable backrest width, see above. Based on the backrest width set, the lat- eral support is automatically adapted to the cur- rent driving situation.

The adaptation of the backrest width and the speed of the adjustment vary depending on the program. You can select from among three pro- grams from comfort to sport.

Button with three LEDs

Press button once per program:

> "Comfort": one LED

> "Normal": two LEDs

> "Sport": three LEDs

To deactivate: press button longer.

Button with one LED

Press the button repeatedly until the desired program is shown on the Control Display. The LED in the button lights up.

To deactivate: press button longer.

Easy entry/exit* To facilitate entry and exit, the backrest width temporarily opens all the way.

Seat, mirror and steering wheel memory*

You can store and request two different posi- tions for the driver's seat and passenger seat*, exterior rearview mirrors, and steering wheel.

A d

ju st

in g

48

The adjustment of the lumbar support is not stored in the memory.

Storing 1. Switch on radio readiness or ignition, refer

to page 61.

2. Set the desired seat, exterior mirror and steering wheel positions.

3. Press the button: The LED in the button lights up.

4. Press the desired memory button 1 or 2: The LED goes out.

Requesting Do not request a position from the mem- ory while the vehicle is moving. There is a

risk of accident from unexpected movement of the seat or steering wheel.<

Comfort mode 1. Open the driver's door after unlocking or

switch on radio readiness.

2. Briefly press the desired memory button 1 or 2.

The system cancels the adjustment procedure when you briefly press one of the seat adjust- ment switches or one of the memory buttons.

Safety feature 1. Close the driver's door and switch the igni-

tion on or off.

2. Press the desired memory button 1 or 2 and maintain pressure until the adjustment process has been completed.

If the button was pressed inadvertently: press the button again; the LED goes out.

Requesting with remote control The last positions of the driver's seat, the exte- rior rearview mirrors, and steering wheel are stored for the remote control currently in use.

You can choose when the position is requested:

> Request when unlocking vehicle

> Request when opening driver's door

When using this feature, always make sure that the footwell behind the driver's

seat is empty and unobstructed. Failure to do so could cause injury to persons or damage to objects behind the seat as a result of a rearward movement of the seat.<

The system cancels the adjustment procedure when you briefly press one of the seat adjust- ment switches or one of the memory buttons.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Door locks" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Central locking" and press the con- troller.

7. Select "Last seat pos." and press the con- troller.

8. Select "After unlocking" or "After door opened".

9. Press the controller.

C o

n tr

o ls

49

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

To cancel the request: Select "Deactivated" and press the controller.

Head restraints A correctly adjusted head restraint reduces the risk of spinal injury in the event of an accident.

Adjust the head restraint so that its center is approx. at ear level. Otherwise there is

increased danger of injury in the event of an accident. Only remove the head restraints if no one will be sitting on the seat in question. Rein- stall the head restraints before transporting passengers, as otherwise the head restraint cannot provide its protective function.<

Active front head restraints In the event of a rear-end collision of sufficient severity, the active head restraint reduces the distance to the head.

Do not use seat covers or head restraint covers that could impede the proper

functioning of the active head restraint. Other- wise, there is no assurance that the active head restraint will perform its protective function and it is not possible to take advantage of its injury- reducing potential in the event of a rear-end collision. Have the active head restraints reset after they are triggered in a rear-end collision. Only have this work carried out by a BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained per- sonnel. Otherwise, this safety equipment will not function properly.<

Please contact a BMW center if you wish to have the front head restraints removed

and installed.<

Front seats: height adjustment

Front seats: adjusting distance to the back of the head

> Forward: pull up.

> Back: push the button and slide the head- rest cushion toward the rear.

Do not place any objects behind the headrest cushion. Otherwise, you can

impair the proper function of the head restraint.<

Comfort seat* You can adjust the distance to the back of the head with the shoulder support, refer to page 46.

A d

ju st

in g

50

Adjusting side extensions

You can fold the side extensions on the head restraint forward for increased lateral support in the resting position.

Rear seats: height adjustment

> To raise: pull up.

> To lower: press the button, arrow 1,and push the head restraint downward.

Removing 1. Pull the head restraint upward to the stop.

2. Press the button, arrow 1,and pull the head restraint all the way out.

Safety belts To ensure that the safety systems con- tinue to provide optimized protection,

please observe the adjustment instructions on page 45.<

Before every drive, make sure that safety belts are being worn at all of the occupied seats. Air- bags complement the safety belt as an addi- tional safety device, but they do not represent a substitute.

Fastening Make sure you hear the latch plate engage in the belt buckle.

Safety belt reminder for driver's seat and passenger seat*

The indicator lamp lights up and a sig- nal sounds. A message also appears on the Control Display. Please check

whether the safety belt is correctly positioned.

The safety belt reminder is operative at speeds above approx. 5 mph/8 km/h. It can also be acti- vated if objects are placed on the passenger seat.

Releasing 1. Grasp the belt firmly.

2. Press the red button in the buckle.

3. Guide the belt into its reel.

The shoulder strap's anchorage point will be correct for adult seat occupants of every build if the seat is correctly adjusted, refer to page 46.

The two rear safety belt buckles integrated into the rear seat are for passengers sitting on the left and right. The belt buckle embossed with

C o

n tr

o ls

51

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

the word CENTER is intended exclusively for use by passengers riding in the center position.

Damage to safety belts When subjected to strain due to an acci- dent or in the event of damage, replace

the safety belts, the belt tensioners, and any child restraint systems and have the belt anchor points checked. Only have this work carried out at a BMW center or at a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with cor- respondingly trained personnel. Otherwise cor- rect operation of this safety equipment is not guaranteed.<

Seat heating*

Front The appearance and arrangement of the but- tons may vary depending on the equipment.

1 Seat heating, three LEDs

2 Seat heating, one LED

3 Seat heating with active seat ventilation* Press the respective button once per tempera- ture level. The temperature level is shown on the Control Display with buttons 2 and 3.

The maximum temperature is supplied when three LEDs are lit.

The temperature is reduced and if need be, the heating is switched off in order to reduce the load on the battery. The LEDs remain lit.

To switch off: press button longer.

Temperature distribution without active seat ventilation The heat output can be distributed variously in the seat cushion and the backrest.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

3. Select "Seat heater distribution" and press the controller.

4. Move the controller to the left or right to select "Driver" or "Passenger".

5. Turn the controller to adjust the distribu- tion. The setting is applied.

Temperature distribution with active seat ventilation The heat output can be distributed variously in the seat cushion and the backrest.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

A d

ju st

in g

52

3. Select "Driver's seat climate" or "Passen- ger's seat climate" and press the controller.

Turn the controller to adjust the distribution. The setting is applied.

Rear

Operation similar to front seat heating; two tem- perature levels, without temperature distribu- tion.

Active seat ventilation* The appearance and arrangement of the but- tons may vary depending on the equipment.

1 Active seat ventilation

2 Active seat ventilation with seat heating

Press the respective button once per ventila- tion level. The ventilation level appears on the Control Display. The maximum level is supplied when three LEDs are lit.

The air quantity is reduced and if need be, the ventilation is switched off in order to reduce the load on the battery. The LEDs remain lit.

To switch off: press button longer.

The highest level is used for rapid cooling, e.g. when the vehicle has become heated

up. After a short time, the system is automati- cally switched down one level in order to pre- vent excessive cooling.<

Active seat*

The seat cushion is actively varied by alter- nately raising and lowering the right and left half of the seat cushion. This reduces muscular ten- sion and fatigue to help prevent lower back pain.

Press the button to switch on; the LED lights up.

The action of the system is reduced and if need be, switched off in order to reduce the load on the battery. The LED remains lit.

If you switch off the active seat, it can take up to 1 minute before the two halves of the seat cushion have returned to their initial position.

C o

n tr

o ls

53

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Mirrors

Exterior mirrors The mirror on the passenger's side is more curved than the driver's mirror.

Objects reflected in the mirror are closer than they appear. Do not estimate the distance of following traffic based on what you see in the mirrors, otherwise there is an increased acci- dent risk.<

1 Adjusting

2 Switching to the other mirror or to the automatic curb monitor

3 Folding mirrors in and out* Storing the mirror positions, refer to Seat, mir- ror and steering wheel memory on page 47.

Adjusting manually You can also adjust the mirrors manually by pressing against the outer edges of their mirror glass.

Folding mirrors in and out* Pressing button 3 allows you to fold mirrors in and out up to a speed of approx. 20 mph/ 30 km/h. This is advantageous, for example, in car washes, narrow streets or for bringing mir- rors that have been manually folded in back into the correct position. Mirrors that were folded in are folded out automatically at a speed of approx. 25 mph/40 km/h.

Before going through a car wash, fold the mirrors in manually, or with button 3, oth-

erwise they could be damaged, depending on the width of the car wash system.<

Automatic heating Below a certain outdoor temperature, both exterior mirrors are heated whenever the engine is running or the ignition is switched on.

Tilting down passenger-side exterior mirror automatic curb monitor*

Activating 1. Slide switch into the driver's side mirror

position, arrow 1.

2. Shift into reverse or move selector lever into position R. The mirror glass tilts downward somewhat on the passenger's side. This allows the driver to see the area immediately adjacent to the vehicle such as a curb when park- ing, etc.

Deactivating Slide switch into the passenger side mirror position, arrow 2.

Interior rearview mirror

To reduce the dazzle effect of following vehi- cles at night, turn the knob.

A d

ju st

in g

54

Interior and exterior mirrors, automatic dimming feature*

This feature is controlled by two photocells in the interior rearview mirror. One is integrated into the glass of the mirror, while the other is located at an offset position on the rear of the mirror housing.

For trouble-free operation, keep the photocells clean and do not cover the area between the interior rearview mirror and the windshield. Do not attach stickers of any kind to the windshield in front of the mirror, either.

Steering wheel

Adjusting Do not adjust the steering wheel while the vehicle is moving. There is a risk of acci-

dent as the result of unexpected movement.<

The steering wheel can be adjusted in four directions.

Storing steering wheel positions, refer to Seat, mirror and steering wheel memory on page 47.

Easy entry/exit* To facilitate entry and exit, the steering wheel temporarily moves into the uppermost position.

Steering wheel heating*

Press the button.

When the steering wheel heater is operating, the LED in the button lights up.

Programmable buttons* on steering wheel

You can program the buttons individually.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

C o

n tr

o ls

55

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Steering wheel buttons" and press the controller.

A list of different functions appears:

> "Navigation voice instructions" Voice instructions for the navigation system*

> "Air recirculation on / off" Permanently shutting off outside air, refer to AUC Automatic recirculated-air control on page 117

> "Mute on / off" Mutes the audio sources

> "Monitor on / off" Switches the Control Display on/off

> "Telephone list"* Display/hide phone book or last list of stored phone numbers

> "HDC on / off" Switches HDC Hill Descent Control* on/ off

> "Next entertainment source" Changes audio source

> "Night Vision on / off" Switches BMW Night Vision* on/off

5. Select the desired function and press the controller.

6. Select the button if necessary and press the controller.

You can operate the selected function using the corresponding button.

Operating function Press the corresponding button on the steering wheel.

If you have programmed "Navigation voice instructions" for one of the buttons:

> To switch voice instructions on/off: Press button longer.

> To repeat the last voice instruction: Press the button.

T ra

n sp

o rt

in g

c h

ild re

n s

af el

y

56

Transporting children safely

The right place for children Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, otherwise they could endanger

themselves and other persons, e.g. by opening the doors.<

Children always in the rear Accident research shows that the safest place for children is on the rear seat.

Children younger than 13 years of age or with a height under 5 ft/150 cm may only

be transported in the rear in child restraint sys- tems which correspond to the age, weight and height of the child. Otherwise there is an increased danger of injury in an accident.<

Children 13 years of age or older must wear a safety belt as soon as a suitable child restraint system can no longer be used due to their age, size and weight.

Exception for front passenger seat Should it ever be necessary to use a child restraint system on the front passenger

seat, the front and side airbags on the passen- ger side must first be deactivated. Otherwise, there is an increased risk of injury for the child if the airbags are triggered, even with a child restraint system.<

For more information on automatic deactivation of the front passenger airbags, refer to page 101.

Installing child restraint systems

Observe the child restraint system manu- facturer's instructions for selection,

installation and use of the child restraint sys- tems. Otherwise the degree of protection may be reduced.<

Backrest width* on front passenger seat

Open the backrest width setting of the front passenger seat all the way. After

mounting the child's seat, deactivate the active backrest width adjustment and do not call up any memory position. Otherwise this limits the stability of the child's seat on the front passen- ger seat.<

1. After unlocking the vehicle, sit on the front passenger seat and close the door to call up the memory position.

2. Completely open the backrest width adjust- ment, refer to page 46.

3. Deactivate active backrest width adjust- ment, refer to page 47.

4. Install child's seat.

Child seat security

All rear safety belts and the safety belt for the front passenger can be locked against pulling out to secure child restraint systems.

C o

n tr

o ls

57

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Locking safety belt 1. Secure the child restraint system with the

belt.

2. Pull out the belt webbing completely.

3. Allow the belt webbing to be pulled in and pull taut against the child restraint system. The safety belt is locked.

Unlocking safety belt 1. Open the belt buckle.

2. Remove the child restraint system.

3. Allow the belt webbing to be pulled in com- pletely.

LATCH child restraint fixing system LATCH: Lower Anchor and Tethers for CHil- dren.

Follow the system manufacturer's instructions on installation and use of

LATCH child restraint systems in order not to impair their protective function.<

Before attaching the LATCH child's seat, pull the belt away from the region of the child restraint fixing system.

Make sure that the LATCH mounts have properly clicked into place and that the

child restraint system is resting snugly against the backrest. Otherwise, the protective action may be impeded.<

Sedan: rear seats

The anchor points for the LATCH anchors are located at the positions indicated by arrows in the gap between the seat and the backrest.

Sedan: rear seats with through-loading system*

The anchor points for the LATCH anchors are located behind the indicated protective caps. Remove the cover caps before mounting the child's seat.

Sports Wagon: rear seats

The anchor points for the LATCH anchors are located behind the indicated protective caps and are covered again after the child's seat is removed.

Child restraint system with tether strap Only use the tether-strap mounting points to secure child restraint systems,

otherwise the mounting points could be dam- aged.<

T ra

n sp

o rt

in g

c h

ild re

n s

af el

y

58

Sedan

There are three additional mounting points for child restraint systems with a tether strap, refer to arrows. Fold the corresponding mounting point upward before using.

Sports Wagon

Three additional mounting points for child restraint systems with a tether strap are pro- vided under covers in the cargo bay floor, refer to arrows. Remove the corresponding covers before use.

Placement of tether strap Make sure that the upper retaining strap is not routed over sharp edges and does

not twist on its way to the upper mounting point; otherwise, the belt may not properly secure the child restraint system in the event of an acci- dent.<

Outer rear seat, Sedan

Outer rear seats, Sports Wagon

1 Direction of travel

2 Head restraints

3 Hook of upper retaining strap

4 Mounting point

5 Rear window shelf/luggage compartment floor

6 Backrest

7 Upper retaining strap of child restraint sys- tem

C o

n tr

o ls

59

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Fold upward or remove covers before using the mounting points.

1. Slide the head restraint upward.

2. Thread the upper retaining strap between the head restraint supports.

3. Sports Wagon: thread the retaining strap between the backrest and the roll-up cover. Make sure that the rear backrest is locked in position.

4. Attach the retaining strap hook to the mounting point.

5. Slide the head restraint into the bottom position.

6. Pull the retaining strap taut.

Center rear seat 1. Fold the center armrest somewhat toward

the front.

2. Guide retaining strap through the opening.

3. Fold back the center armrest.

4. Sports Wagon: thread the retaining strap between the backrest and the roll-up cover. Make sure that the rear backrest is locked in position.

5. Attach the retaining strap hook to the mounting point.

6. Pull the retaining strap taut.

On trips

If the vehicle is equipped with rear side airbags, make sure that children do not

lean out of the child's seat towards the door panels. Otherwise injuries can be caused if the side airbags are triggered.<

Child-safety locks for rear doors

Slide down the safety lever on the rear doors: the door can now be opened from the outside only.

T ra

n sp

o rt

in g

c h

ild re

n s

af el

y

60

Safety switch for power windows Always press the safety switch for the power windows, refer to page 41, when children are riding in the rear of the vehicle.

C o

n tr

o ls

61

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Driving

Ignition lock

Inserting remote control into ignition lock

Insert the remote control as far as possible into the ignition lock.

Radio readiness switches on. Some electronic systems/consumers are ready for operation.

Comfort access* With comfort access, only insert the remote control into the ignition lock in exceptional cases, refer to page 38.

Removing remote control from ignition lock

Do not pull the remote control out of the ignition lock using force, as otherwise

damage may result.<

Before removing the remote control, first press it in as far as possible to release the locking device.

The ignition is switched off if it was still switched on.

Automatic and sport automatic transmission The remote control can only be removed when transmission position P is selected: interlock.

Start/Stop button

Pressing the Start/Stop button switches the radio readiness or the ignition on and off.

The engine is started when you press the Start/Stop button and depress the clutch

if the car has manual transmission or the brake if the car has automatic transmission.<

Radio readiness Some electronic systems/consumers are ready for operation. The time and outside tempera- ture are displayed in the instrument cluster.

Radio readiness is switched off:

> when the remote control is removed from the ignition lock

> with comfort access* by touching the sur- face on the door handle, refer to Locking on page 39

Ignition on All electronic systems/consumers are ready for operation. The odometer and the trip odometer are displayed in the instrument cluster, refer to page 78.

Please switch off the ignition and the electronic systems/consumers which are

not required when the engine is not running to save the battery.<

D ri

vi n

g

62

Radio readiness and ignition switched off All indicator and warning lamps in the instru- ment cluster go out.

Starting engine Do not run the engine in closed rooms, otherwise the inhalation of toxic exhaust

gases can cause unconsciousness and death. The exhaust gases contain carbon monoxide, an odorless and colorless, but highly toxic gas. Never leave an unattended vehicle with the engine running, as such a vehicle represents a potential safety hazard. Before leaving the vehicle with the engine run- ning, select the idling position, or shift the trans- mission into position P and firmly apply the handbrake, otherwise the vehicle can begin to roll.<

Avoid frequent starting in quick succes- sion or repeated starting attempts in

which the engine does not start. Otherwise, the fuel is not burned or inadequately burned and there is a danger of overheating and damaging the catalytic converter.<

Do not allow the engine to warm up by leaving it running while the vehicle remains stationary. Instead, begin to drive at a moderate engine speed.

Manual transmission Remote control in ignition lock or with comfort access in vehicle, refer to page 38.

1. Depress brake pedal.

2. Depress the clutch pedal and shift into idling position.

3. Press the Start/Stop button.

Automatic and sport automatic transmission* Remote control in ignition lock or with comfort access in vehicle, refer to page 38.

1. Depress brake pedal.

2. Press the Start/Stop button.

Switching off engine When leaving the vehicle, always take the remote control with you.

When parking, firmly apply the handbrake, as otherwise the vehicle could roll.<

Manual transmission 1. Press the Start/Stop button with the vehicle

stopped.

2. Shift into first gear or reverse.

3. Firmly apply the handbrake.

4. Remove the remote control from the igni- tion lock, refer to page 61.

Automatic and sport automatic transmission* 1. Shift transmission into position P with the

vehicle stopped.

2. Press the Start/Stop button.

3. Firmly apply the handbrake.

4. Remove the remote control from the igni- tion lock, refer to page 61.

Before driving into a car wash The vehicle can roll if you proceed according to the following steps:

1. With comfort access: insert the remote con- trol into the ignition lock.

2. Depress brake pedal.

3. Shift into transmission position N.

4. Switch off the engine.

Transmission position P will be engaged:

> automatically after approx. 30 minutes

C o

n tr

o ls

63

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

> if you remove the remote control from the ignition lock

Handbrake The handbrake is primarily intended to prevent the vehicle from rolling while parked; it brakes the rear wheels.

Indicator lamp The indicator lamp lights up, and a sig- nal also sounds when starting off. The handbrake is applied.

Indicator lamp for Canadian models.

Applying The lever locks in position automatically.

Releasing

Pull slightly upwards, press the button and lower the lever.

If exceptional circumstances should make it necessary to apply the handbrake

while the vehicle is in motion, do not pull it too firmly. In doing so, continuously press the but- ton of the handbrake lever. Otherwise, too firm an application of the handbrake can lock up the rear wheels and cause the rear of the car to swerve.<

To prevent corrosion and one-sided brak- ing action, occasionally apply the hand-

brake lightly when the vehicle is slowly coming to a stop if the traffic conditions are suitable. The brake lamps do not light up when the hand- brake is applied.<

Manual transmission

While shifting in the 5th/6th gear lane, press the gearshift lever toward the right,

otherwise accidental shifting into the 3rd or 4th gear could result in engine damage.<

Reverse gear Select only when the vehicle is stationary. When pressing the gearshift lever to the left, overcome some resistance.

Automatic transmission with Steptronic* In addition to fully automatic operation, you can also manually shift with the Steptronic, refer to page 64.

Transmission positions P R N D M/S +

Displays in instrument cluster

P R N D DS S1* to S6* M1 to M6

The transmission position is indicated, and in the manual mode, the gear currently engaged.

D ri

vi n

g

64

Engaging transmission position > Do not leave the transmission position P

until the engine is running: interlock.

> With the vehicle stationary, depress the brake pedal before shifting out of P or N; otherwise the shift command will not be executed: shiftlock.

To prevent the vehicle from creeping after you select a driving position,

maintain pressure on the brake pedal until you are ready to start.<

Engaging N, D, R

Briefly press the selector lever in the desired direction, beyond a resistance point if neces- sary. Press button 1 simultaneously out of P or into R.

The engaged transmission position is also dis- played on the selector lever.

The selector lever immediately returns to the center position when released.

Engaging P

Press button P.

R Reverse Select only when the vehicle is stationary.

P Park Select only when the vehicle is stationary. The rear wheels are locked.

P is engaged automatically as soon as you switch off the engine unless N is

engaged and with comfort access the remote control is inserted in the ignition lock, refer to Before driving into a car wash, page 62.<

N Neutral Can, for example, be engaged in automatic car washes. The vehicle can roll.

N remains engaged even after the engine is switched off whenever you leave the

remote control in the ignition lock. This function is useful, for example, in automatic car washes, refer to page 62<

D Drive, automatic position Position for normal vehicle operation. All for- ward gears are available.

Kick-down Kick-down enables you to achieve maximum performance. Press the accelerator pedal beyond the increased resistance at full throttle.

Sport program and manual mode M/S

Press selector lever toward the left from trans- mission position D: The sport program is activated, and DS is dis- played in the instrument cluster; with the sport automatic transmission* also S1 to S6. This position is recommended for a performance- oriented driving style.

C o

n tr

o ls

65

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

When the selector lever is pressed forward or back, the manual mode is activated and the Steptronic shifts the gear. The instrument clus- ter shows M1 through M6.

Upshifts and downshifts are only carried out at a suitable engine and vehicle speed, e.g. a down- shift is not carried out at excessively high engine speeds. The selected gear is briefly dis- played in the instrument cluster, followed by the current gear.

To resume automatic mode, press the selector lever to the right.

Manually unlocking and locking transmission lock In case of a power failure, e.g. when the battery is drained or disconnected, or an electrical fault, manually release the transmission lock, as oth- erwise the rear wheels are blocked and the vehicle cannot be towed.

Only manually release the transmission lock for towing and firmly apply the handbrake before- hand so that the vehicle cannot roll. Reengage the transmission lock after parking the vehicle at its destination.

Unlocking 1. Reach into the trim-piece opening, arrow 1,

and firmly pull the trim piece upward, arrow 2.

2. Remove cover over the opening, refer to 3.

3. Insert a screwdriver from the onboard tool kit, refer to page 237, into the opening, arrow 1.

4. Pull the screwdriver toward the rear until it is heard to engage, arrow 2, and leave it inserted in the opening. The transmission lock is released.

Releasing on sport automatic transmission* 1. Unclip the sleeve of the selector lever.

2. Pull the sleeve over the selector lever.

3. Reach into the trim-piece opening, arrow 1, and firmly pull the trim piece upward, arrow 2.

4. Remove cover over the opening, refer to 5.

D ri

vi n

g

66

5. Insert a screwdriver from the onboard tool kit, refer to page 237, into the opening, arrow 1.

6. Pull the screwdriver toward the rear until it is heard to engage, arrow 2, and leave it inserted in the opening. The transmission lock is released.

Locking 1. Pull out the screwdriver upward.

The transmission lock is locked again.

2. Reinstall the cover and the trim piece.

Information on jump starting and towing from page 248.

Sport automatic transmission* You can also shift manually with two shift pad- dles on the steering wheel.

You can also choose between two driving pro- grams: Normal or Sport, refer to Dynamic Driv- ing Control.

Shift paddles on steering wheel The shift paddles allow you to shift gears quickly, as both hands can remain on the steer- ing wheel.

> When you use the shift paddles on the steering wheel to shift gears in automatic mode, the gearshift system switches into the manual mode.

> If you do not shift with the shift paddles and do not accelerate for a certain time, the sys- tem switches into the automatic mode again when the selector lever is in D.

> To shift up: pull one of the shift paddles.

> To shift down: press one of the shift pad- dles.

Dynamic Driving Control The Dynamic Driving Control makes it possible for your BMW to react in an even more perfor- mance-oriented manner at the push of a button:

> The speed range of the engine is optimally utilized.

> Gearshifts are faster.

> The engine responds more spontaneously to accelerator pedal movements.

> The steering will operate in an even sportier mode.

> In the automatic mode, the 6th gear is not engaged.

C o

n tr

o ls

67

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Activating system

Press the SPORT button. The LED in the button lights up and SPORT is displayed in the instrument cluster.

Deactivating system > Press the SPORT button again

> Engage reverse gear

> Switch off engine

The LED in the button and SPORT in the instru- ment cluster go out.

Turn signals/ headlamp flasher

1 High beams

2 Headlamp flasher

3 Turn signals

Using turn signals Press the lever beyond the resistance point.

To turn off manually, press the lever to the resistance point.

Atypically rapid flashing of the indicator lamp indicates that a turn signal bulb

needs to be replaced.<

Signaling briefly Press lever to resistance point and hold for as long as you wish to signal.

Triple turn signal activation Press the lever to the resistance point; the turn signal flashes three times.

You can activate or deactivate this function.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Lighting" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Triple turn signal" and press the controller.

Triple turn signaling is activated.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

D ri

vi n

g

68

Wiper system

1 Switching on wipers

2 Switching off wipers or brief wipe

3 Activating/deactivating rain sensor

4 Cleaning windshield, headlamps and BMW Night Vision camera*

5 Adjusting rain sensorsensitivity level

Switching on wipers Pull the lever upward, arrow 1.

The lever automatically returns to its initial posi- tion when released.

Normal wiper speed Press once. The system reverts to operation in the intermit- tent mode when the vehicle is stationary.

Fast wiper speed Press twice or press beyond the resistance point. The system reverts to normal speed when the vehicle is stationary.

Rain sensor The wiper operation is controlled automatically as a function of the rain intensity. The rain sen- sor is located on the windshield, directly in front of the interior rearview mirror.

Activating rain sensor

Press the button, arrow 3. The LED in the but- ton lights up.

Adjusting rain sensor sensitivity level Turn the knurled wheel 5.

Deactivating rain sensor Press the button again, arrow 3. The LED goes out.

Deactivate the rain sensor when passing through an automatic car wash. Failure to

do so could result in damage caused by undes- ired wiper activation.<

Cleaning windshield, headlamps* and BMW Night Vision camera* Pull the lever, arrow 4.

The system sprays washer fluid against the windshield and activates the wipers for a brief period.

With the vehicle lighting switched on, the head- lamps and the BMW Night Vision camera are also cleaned simultaneously at suitable inter- vals.

Do not use the washing mechanisms if there is any danger that the fluid will

freeze on the windshield. If you do so, your vision could be obscured. To avoid freezing, use a washer fluid antifreeze, refer to Washer fluid. Do not use washing mechanisms when the washer fluid reservoir is empty, otherwise you will damage the washer pump.<

C o

n tr

o ls

69

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Windshield washer nozzles Both windshield washer nozzles are automati- cally heated with the engine running or the igni- tion switched on.

Sports Wagon: Rear window wiper

1 Intermittent mode. When reverse gear is engaged, continuous operation is switched on automatically

2 Cleaning the rear window

Do not use washing mechanisms when the washer fluid reservoir is empty, other-

wise you will damage the washer pump.<

Washer fluid Washer fluid antifreeze is flammable. For this reason, keep it away from ignition

sources and store only in the closed original container out of reach of children. Otherwise, there is the danger of bodily injury. Always observe the instructions for use provided on the containers.<

Filler neck for washer fluid Only add washer fluid with the engine cooled down to exclude contact with hot

engine components. Otherwise there is a dan- ger of fire and to personal safety if the fluid is spilled.<

All washer nozzles are supplied from one reser- voir.

Fill with water and if required with a washer antifreeze, according to manufacturer's recom- mendations.

In order to maintain the mixture ratio, mix the washer fluid before filling.<

Capacity Sedan: Approx. 3.2 US quarts/3 liters, with headlamp washer system* approx. 5.3 US quarts/5 liters.

Sports Wagon: approx. 5.3 US quarts/5 liters.

Cruise control*

The concept The cruise control is available for use at speeds of approx. 20 mph/30 km/h and higher. The vehicle stores and maintains the speed that you set using the lever mounted on the steering col- umn. To maintain the specified speed, the sys- tem brakes if the engine braking effect is not sufficient on a downhill grade. Speed can drop on uphill grades if the engine output is insuffi- cient.

Do not use the cruise control under driv- ing conditions that do not permit a con-

stant speed, e.g. when driving on winding roads, in heavy traffic or in poor road conditions such as snow, rain, ice, and loose road surface. Otherwise you could loose control of the vehi- cle and cause an accident.<

D ri

vi n

g

70

One lever for all functions

1 Maintaining, storing and increasing speed

2 Maintaining speed, storing speed, and decelerating

3 Interrupting and deactivating system

4 Resuming stored speed

Maintaining, storing and increasing speed Press lever to resistance point, arrow 1: The speed currently being driven is maintained and stored. The display 1 in the speedometer, see below, indicates this regulated speed. Every time you press the lever, the vehicle's speed increases by roughly 1 mph/1 km/h.

Press lever to resistance point for a longer time: The vehicle accelerates without pressure on the accelerator pedal. The system maintains and stores your current speed as soon as you release the lever.

Maintaining speed, storing speed, and decelerating Pull the lever, arrow 2: Functions are the same as 1; the speed is reduced.

Interrupting system Press the lever up or down, arrow 3: the display 1 in the speedometer changes color.

In addition, the system is automatically inter- rupted:

> when braking

> when you clutch, shift very slowly and when you engage the idling or the N position of the automatic transmission

> when DTC is activated or DSC is deacti- vated

> when the DSC comes on

> when you brake with the handbrake

Resuming stored speed Press button 4: The stored speed is resumed and maintained.

Deactivating system > Press the lever up or down twice, arrow 3

> Switch off the ignition

The speed stored in the memory is deleted.

Displays in instrument cluster

1 Stored speed

2 Selected speed is displayed briefly

Active cruise control* With active cruise control you can select a desired speed which is then automatically maintained when driving on open roadways and is varied to maintain a selected distance setting to slower moving vehicles ahead.

Active cruise control represents a technological advance over the familiar cruise control and is a welcome relief from the constant adjustment of speed that can accompany driving in traffic on freeways or other high-speed thoroughfares. Especially on longer trips and in traffic conges- tion, the system can reduce fatigue and tension, while increasing your enjoyment of driving. Please use it safely and responsibly.

C o

n tr

o ls

71

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

In addition to holding a steady cruising speed, if you encounter slower vehicles ahead, active cruise control will, within limits, adjust your vehicle's speed automatically so that you can flow with the traffic without having to make con- stant adjustments. If, for example, while cruis- ing at the selected speed, you begin to approach a slower vehicle ahead of you in the same lane, the system will reduce your vehicle's speed to the same as that of the vehicle ahead to maintain your selected distance setting. You can vary the following distance, which will vary with speed. Based on your selected distance setting, the system automatically decreases the throttle setting and lightly applies the brakes if necessary. In addition, if the vehicle ahead of you slows to a complete stop, the system can follow this action within the given scope and can also accelerate from a complete stop if the vehicle ahead of you drives off again shortly thereafter. During braking, your vehicle brake lamps will automatically illuminate to alert a fol- lowing driver to take action. In addition, it may be necessary for your vehicle to downshift the automatic transmission to maintain the dis- tance setting selected. As soon as the road in front of you has no moving vehicles, the system will accelerate to your desired speed. This set speed is also maintained on downhill grades, however the vehicle speed can drop below the set speed when driving uphill if the engine out- put is not sufficient.

Active cruise control cannot detect stop signs, red lights, or any object that is

stopped or is blocking the road. Active cruise control is not and must not be used as a collision avoidance/warning system. Since this active cruise control system is a new technology and operates differently from con- ventional cruise control systems which you may be accustomed to, it is necessary that you read all of the pages relating to this system before use. Carefully read and observe the information on the system limitations beginning on page 75 to obtain a good command of the system and its range of applications.<

Brake pedal feel When the system brakes and you also depress the brake pedal, a somewhat different braking feel results.

Professional* navigation system If a navigation DVD is in the drive, refer to page 142, within limits the system adjusts the accelerating and braking behavior of the vehicle to the road you are driving on.

To ensure that the system is informed of the current course of the road, always use

the latest navigation DVD if possible.<

When the vehicle position is unknown, e.g. when you leave the map area, this influence of the navigation system is not available.

Applications Please try the system first during sparse traffic and clear road conditions so that you can get used to the system. After you have experience and understand the system, only then use it during normal traffic.

As with conventional cruise control systems, active cruise control in no way reduces or sub- stitutes for the driver's own personal experi- ence, responsibility, alertness and awareness in adjusting speed, braking or otherwise control- ling the vehicle. The driver should decide when to use the system on the basis of road, traffic, visibility, and weather conditions. Active cruise control is intended for use on highway-type roadways where traffic is moving relatively smoothly as well as in slow-moving traffic. Do not use the system in city driving; in complex driving situations; heavy traffic such as during rush hour; on curvy, winding roads, slippery roads or roads with sharp curves such as high- way off-ramps; during inclement weather such as snow, strong rain or fog; or when entering interchanges, service/parking areas or toll booths. It is also important to regulate your vehicle's speed and distance setting within applicable legal limits. Always be ready to take action or apply the brakes if necessary, espe- cially when the system is actively following a vehicle in front of you. Otherwise, driving condi-

D ri

vi n

g

72

tions can result which lead to a violation of the law or elevated risk of an accident.

The minimum initial activation speed is 20 mph/ 30 km/h, and the maximum speed is 110 mph/ 180 km/h. However, you can also activate the system while stopped, refer to While stopped, page 73.

One lever for all functions

1 Storing and increasing desired speed

2 Storing and reducing desired speed

3 Interrupting, refer to page 73, or deactivating system, refer to page 74

4 Activating stored desired speed and dis- tance, refer to page 73, or driving off, refer to While stopped, page 73

5 Selecting distance to vehicle driving ahead, refer to page 72.

Storing current speed Tap the lever, arrow 1, or briefly pull it, arrow 2.

The system stores the current vehicle speed. It is indicated on the speedometer and briefly in the instrument cluster.

Increasing desired speed Press or tap the lever to the resistance point or beyond, arrow 1, until the desired speed is dis- played. The speed then displayed is stored and achieved on a clear road.

> Each time the lever is tapped to the resis- tance point, the desired speed is increased by approx. 1 mph/1 km/h.

> Each time the lever is tapped beyond the resistance point, the desired speed increases to the next fives place of the mph speedometer display or the next tens place of the km/h speedometer display.

Reducing desired speed Pull the lever, arrow 2, until the desired speed is displayed.

These functions are operated in the same man- ner as increasing your desired speed.

Selecting distance

> Briefly press rocker switch downward: Increase distance.

> Briefly press rocker switch upward: Reduce distance.

C o

n tr

o ls

73

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

The selected distance is displayed in the instru- ment cluster.

Use good judgment to select the appro- priate following distance, given road con-

ditions, traffic, applicable laws and State driving recommendations for safe following distance. Otherwise, a violation of the law or risk of an accident could result.<

Interrupting cruise control

Press the lever upward or downward, and with the vehicle stopped also depress the brake pedal. The marking in the speedometer changes color and the distance indicator goes out.

In addition, the system is automatically inter- rupted:

> when you apply the vehicle brakes

> when you shift the transmission

> when DTC is activated or DSC is deacti- vated

> when DSC comes on

> when you apply the handbrake

> when you release the safety belt and open the driver's door with the vehicle stopped

> when the system does not recognize any objects for an extended period of time, e.g. on infrequently traveled roads without a shoulder or guard rails, or if the radar sensor is covered with dirt, refer to page 74

If the system is interrupted, then it is nec- essary for the driver to actively intervene

by braking and steering. Otherwise, there is a risk of an accident.<

Resuming stored desired speed and distance

While driving Press button 4. The displays appear in the instrument cluster.

While stopped Before leaving the vehicle with the engine running, engage position P of the auto-

matic transmission and apply the handbrake. Otherwise the vehicle can roll.<

If a detected vehicle in front of you brakes to a complete stop and your vehicle has also been braked to a complete stop by the system:

> If the vehicle in front of you drives off while the marking 1 for the desired speed in the speedometer is green, your vehicle will accelerate without you having to do any- thing.

> If the vehicle in front of you drives off while the marking 1 is orange, you briefly depress the accelerator pedal or press button 4. Rolling bars in the distance indicator 3 mean that the vehicle in front of you has driven off.

If you are stopped behind a vehicle with the brake pedal depressed and the system is inter- rupted or deactivated:

Distance 1, closest

Distance 2

Distance 3

Distance 4, furthest This distance is always set when you activate the system.

D ri

vi n

g

74

1. Press button 4 to activate a stored desired speed or select a desired speed with the lever, arrow 1 or arrow 2.

2. Release the brake pedal.

3. If the vehicle in front of you drives off, briefly depress the accelerator pedal or press button 4.

Deactivating system > Press the lever upward or downward twice

while driving.

> When stopped, do the same with the brake pedal depressed.

> Switch off the ignition.

The displays turn off, and the stored desired speed and distance are deleted.

Displays in instrument cluster

1 Stored desired speed

> Green: the system is active.

> Orange: the system is interrupted.

2 Lights up yellow: vehicle detected ahead Display also used for warnings, please read all information on warnings

3 Selected distance to vehicle ahead The indicator lights up as soon as the sys- tem is activated

The bars roll: the vehicle in front of you has driven off

4 Brief display of stored desired speed

If the display --- mph/--- km/h appears briefly, the conditions necessary for oper-

ation may currently not be met.<

Warning lamps

The indicator 2 continuously flashes yellow. The prerequisites for operating the system are no longer met, e.g. as a result of ABS or DSC interven-

tions. The system brakes until you actively take over.

The indicator 2 flashes red; a sig- nal sounds. The system indicates that you must brake and/or maneuver the vehicle yourself. The system can-

not automatically restore the distance to the vehicle driving ahead. However, this display cannot relieve the driver of the responsibility for adjusting the desired speed and driving style to the traffic conditions.

Radar sensors

1 Long-range sensor

2 Location of the short-range sensors behind the bumper

3 Location of the short-range sensors behind the bumper with the M sports package*

Heavy rain and also dirt, snow or ice can limit the detection of vehicles ahead. If needed, clean the radar sensor under the front bumper as well as the bumper area covering the short range sensors. When doing so, be particularly careful in removing layers of snow and ice. Do not apply adhesive labels etc. in the area of the short-range sensors.

If the sensor is not aligned properly, e.g. due to damage, the active cruise control cannot be activated.

C o

n tr

o ls

75

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

System limitations

As with conventional cruise control sys- tems, active cruise control in no way

diminishes or substitutes for the driver's own personal responsibility, alertness and aware- ness in adjusting speed, braking or otherwise controlling the vehicle. The driver should decide when to use the system on the basis of road, traffic, visibility, and weather conditions. Active cruise control is intended for use on highway-type roadways where traffic is moving relatively smoothly. Do not use this system in city driving; in complex driving situations; on curvy, winding roads, slippery roads or roads with sharp curves such as highway off-ramps; during inclement weather such as snow, strong rain or fog; or when entering interchanges, ser- vice/parking areas or toll booths. It is also important to regulate your vehicle's speed and distance setting within applicable legal limits. Always be ready to take action or apply the brakes if necessary, especially when the sys- tem is actively following a vehicle in front of you.<

Always remember that the range and abil- ity of the system do have physical limita-

tions. For example, the system may not detect vehicles driving ahead if they suddenly brake heavily in stop-and-go traffic during accelera- tion. The system will not apply the brakes or slow your vehicle when a very slow-moving vehicle, stopped vehicle or stationary object is in the lane ahead of you, for example when approaching a traffic light or parked vehicle or when a vehicle is stalled in your lane. Also, the system does not react to oncoming traffic, pedestrians or other types of potential traffic such as a rider on a horseback. It is also possible

that the system may not detect smaller moving objects such as motorcycles or bicycles. Be especially alert when encountering any of these situations as the system will neither automati- cally brake, nor provide a warning to you. Also, be aware that every decrease in the distance setting allows your vehicle to come closer to a vehicle in front of you and requires a heightened amount of alertness.<

The system cannot allow the vehicle to drive off automatically in situations that make driving off considerably more difficult, e.g. on steep uphill grades, with a heavy trailer or before raised areas in the road.

Near radio astronomy stations, the system radar is deactivated at speeds under 20 mph/ 30 km/h due to legal regulations.

Be certain to interrupt the system when you pull into an exit lane for a highway

offramp.<

Also, vehicles traveling in a staggered manner on a highway may cause a delay in the system's reaction to a vehicle in front of you or may cause the system to react to a vehicle that is actually in the lane next to yours. Always be ready to take action or apply the brakes if necessary.

In addition, the system is interrupted whenever the driver applies the vehicle

brakes, shifts the transmission from drive/D to neutral/N, or deactivates DSC. After any inter- ruption, the system will no longer automatically activate the vehicle brakes, which means the driver must intervene and resume manual brak- ing. You should then reactivate the system only when you are fully aware of the prior speed and distance settings.<

D ri

vi n

g

76

Active cruise control may brake when you reduce the stored desired speed; however, the driver must constantly monitor traffic and inter- vene if necessary.

When you switch off the engine or ignition, active cruise control is fully switched off, too, and any settings you have selected are can- celed.

Unexpected lane change

If a vehicle in front of you is behind a stopped vehicle and unexpectedly changes lanes, you must react yourself, as the system does not react to stopped vehicles.

Swerving vehicles

When a vehicle swerves out of adjacent lanes into your lane, the system does not detect the vehicle until it is completely in your lane.

When a vehicle ahead suddenly swerves into your lane, the system may not be able

to restore the selected distance automatically. This also applies to great differences in speed between your vehicle and vehicles ahead, e.g. when quickly approaching a truck. Once the system has established that a vehicle is indeed in front of you, it will indicate that you must brake and/or maneuver the vehicle yourself.

Take action yourself, otherwise there is a risk of an accident.<

Behavior in curves

If the selected desired speed for a curve is too high, the system reduces the speed within a curve. However, it cannot detect curves in advance. Therefore, select a suitable speed at the start of a curve.

Because of the limited range of the system, it is possible that in curves or on the peaks and val- leys of hilly roads, a vehicle ahead may be rec- ognized late, or not at all. Therefore, it is up to the driver to select a speed that is prudent in view of the curves and terrain of the roadway.

In approaching a curve, it is possible that active cruise control might react briefly to a vehicle in the adjacent lane. In addition, the system can sense if your vehicle is in a curve and may not accelerate. If your vehicle decelerates in either case, you can choose to overcome the deceler- ation by briefly pressing the accelerator pedal.

C o

n tr

o ls

77

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Driver interventions and your responsibility

Anytime the driver presses down on the accelerator pedal, any automatic braking

action by the system is interrupted and the dis- tance indicator turns off until the pedal is fully released. As soon as you fully release the accel- erator, the system will once again control your cruising speed and distance setting. While driv- ing with the system activated, resting your foot on the accelerator pedal will cause the system not to brake even if necessary. Be certain that floormats or other objects on the vehicle floor do not interfere with movement of the accelera- tor pedal.<

While active cruise control is capable of braking your vehicle automatically when

you approach a slower vehicle ahead, it is important to be aware that the ability of the sys- tem to apply the brakes is also limited, e.g. when you reduce your desired speed sharply. It uses only a portion of braking system capacity and does not utilize the full capacity of the vehi- cle braking system. Therefore, the system can- not decrease your speed due to large differ- ences in speed between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead. Example: when you approach a vehicle traveling at a much lower speed than your own speed such as approaching a toll booth or when a much slower vehicle cuts in front of you at close range.<

E ve

ry th

in g

u nd

er c

o n

tr o

l

78

Everything under control

Odometer, outside temperature display, clock

1 Time, outside temperature and date

2 Odometer and trip odometer

3 Press button:

> with ignition switched on, trip odometer is reset

> with ignition switched off, time, outside temperature, and odometer are briefly displayed.

From radio readiness the outside temperature and the time are displayed.

Date retrieval: Press CHECK button on turn signal lever, refer to page 84.

Time and date setting, refer to page 86.

You can set the unit of measure 7 or 6 on the Control Display, refer to Units of measure on page 88.

Outside temperature warning If the display drops to +377/+36, a signal sounds and a warning lamp lights up. A mes- sage appears on the Control Display. There is an increased danger of ice.

Even at temperatures above +377/ +36 ice can form. Therefore, drive care-

fully, e.g. on bridges and sections of road in the shade, otherwise there is an increased accident risk.<

Tachometer

Avoid engine speeds in the white-striped advance warning field, arrow 1, if possible.

Be sure to avoid engine speeds in the red warn- ing field, arrow 2. At high revs in this range, the flow of fuel is interrupted to protect the engine.

Coolant temperature Should the coolant, and with it the engine become too hot, a warning lamp lights up. In addition, a message appears on the Control Display.

Checking coolant level, refer to page 233.

C o

n tr

o ls

79

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Energy Control

Displays the current fuel consumption. This allows you to see whether your current driving style is conducive to fuel economy with mini- mum exhaust emissions.

Fuel gauge

Fuel tank capacity: approx. 18.5 US gal/ 70 liters, including the reserve capacity of approx. 2.1 US gal/8 liters. 550i: approx. 2.6 US gal/10 liters reserve capacity. You will find information on refueling on page 218.

If the tilt of the vehicle varies for a longer period, when you are driving in mountainous areas, for example, the indicator may fluctuate slightly.

Reserve After the reserve quantity has been reached, a message briefly appears on the Control Display; the remaining range is shown in the computer. Below a range of approx. 30 miles/50 km, the message remains on the Control Display.

Refuel as soon as possible once your cruising range falls below 30 miles/

50 km, otherwise engine functions are not ensured and damage can occur.<

Computer

Displays in instrument cluster

Press the button on the turn signal lever.

The following information is displayed in the specified order:

> Cruising range

> Average speed

> Average fuel consumption

> No information

Cruising range Displays the estimated cruising range available with the remaining fuel. The range is projected based on the driving style over the last 20 miles/ 30 km.

Refuel as soon as possible once your cruising range falls below 30 miles/

50 km, otherwise engine functions are not ensured and damage can occur.<

Average speed Periods with the vehicle parked and the engine switched off are not included in the calculations of average speed.

To reset average speed: press BC button on turn signal lever for approx. 2 seconds.

E ve

ry th

in g

u nd

er c

o n

tr o

l

80

Average fuel consumption The average fuel consumption is calculated for the time during which the engine is running.

To reset average fuel consumption: press BC button on turn signal lever for approx. 2 sec- onds.

For different routes You can display the average speed and average consumption for two different routes on the Control Display, refer to the following and to Trip computer*.

Displays on Control Display You can also call up the computer via iDrive. For operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the right to open "Navigation". Without navigation system*: Open "Car Data".

3. Select "Car Data" and press the controller.

4. Select "Onboard info" and press the con- troller.

> Estimated time of arrival at destination and remaining distance:

> Entering a distance manually in the com- puter, see below.

> Entering a destination in the navigation system*, refer to page 142.

> Cruising range

> Average speed

> Average fuel consumption

Resetting values You can reset the values for the average speed and average fuel consumption:

1. Select the respective menu item and press the controller.

2. To confirm your selection, press the con- troller again.

Entering a distance manually 1. Select "Distance to dest." and press the

controller.

2. Turn the controller to select the distance to your destination. If needed, hold it against a slight resistance to enter a larger differ- ence.

3. Press the controller to apply the setting.

The distance is automatically preset during the destination guidance of the navigation sys- tem*.

Trip computer* The trip computer is suitable, for example, for a vacation trip.

C o

n tr

o ls

81

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

1. Open the start menu.

2. Open "Navigation". Without navigation system*: Open "Car Data".

3. Select "Car Data" and press the controller.

4. Select "Trip computer" and press the con- troller.

> Departure time

> Driving time

> Distance traveled

> Average speed

> Average fuel consumption

Starting or stopping the trip computer, or reset- ting all values:

1. Select "Set" and press the controller.

2. Select the desired menu item.

3. Press the controller.

Display options You can display the computer or the trip com- puter in the assistance window.

1. Move the controller to the right to change to the assistance window and press the con- troller.

2. Select "Onboard info" or "Trip computer".

3. Press the controller.

Service requirements

The remaining driving distance and the date for the next maintenance are displayed briefly with the ignition switched on.

Your BMW Service Advisor can deter- mine your vehicle's current service

requirements by reading out the data stored in the remote control.<

Additional information You can select a display of more detailed infor- mation on the maintenance scope on the Con- trol Display. For operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Info sources" and press the control- ler.

4. Select "Service Info" and press the control- ler.

E ve

ry th

in g

u nd

er c

o n

tr o

l

82

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Service requirements" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Status" and press the controller.

The display shows a list of selected service and maintenance procedures, as well as legally mandated inspections.

You can request more detailed information on every entry.

Select the entry and press the controller.

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Symbols No service is currently required.

The deadline for service or a legally man- dated inspection is approaching. Please

arrange a service appointment.

The service deadline has already passed.

Entering deadlines for legally required inspections* Make sure the date on the Control Display is set correctly, refer to page 86, otherwise the effec- tiveness of CBS Condition Based Service is not ensured.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Info sources" and press the control- ler.

4. Select "Service Info" and press the control- ler.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Service requirements" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Status" and press the controller.

7. Select "State inspection" and press the controller.

8. Select "Set service date" and press the controller. The month is selected.

C o

n tr

o ls

83

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

9. Turn the controller to make the adjustment.

10. Press the controller to apply the setting. The year is selected.

11. Turn the controller to make the adjustment.

12. Press the controller to apply the setting. The date entry is stored.

To exit the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Check Control

The concept The Check Control monitors functions in the vehicle and issues a message if there is a mal- function in the monitored systems. This kind of Check Control message consists of indicator and warning lamps in the instrument cluster, and if necessary an acoustic signal and text messages at the bottom of the Control Display.

Indicator and warning lamps

The indicator and warning lamps can light up in different combinations and colors.

means that a Check Control message has been generated. The symbol continues to be visible even when the Check Control message disappears after a short time. The warning lamps and text messages are stored and can be displayed later, also refer to page 84.

Explanatory text messages

Text message at the bottom edge of the Con- trol Display explain the meaning of the dis- played indicator and warning lamps.

You can display additional information on most Check Control messages later, e.g. on the cause of the malfunction and on corresponding need for action, see below.

In urgent cases, this information will be shown as soon as the corresponding lamp comes on.

E ve

ry th

in g

u nd

er c

o n

tr o

l

84

Exit the displayed information: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Hiding Check Control messages

Press the CHECK button on turn signal lever.

Some Check Control messages are displayed until the malfunctions have been rectified. They cannot be hidden. If a number of malfunctions occur simultaneously, they are displayed in succession.

Other messages are automatically hidden after approx. 20 seconds, but remain stored.

Displaying stored Check Control messages 1. Press the button longer:

The first stored message is displayed.

2. Press the button: When the button is pressed again, a differ- ent message is displayed.

Displaying additional information later iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Info sources" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "Service Info" is selected and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Check Control messages" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select a text message and press the con- troller.

To exit the display: Select the arrow and press the controller.

C o

n tr

o ls

85

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Indication of malfunction urgency

Depending on your vehicle's equipment, the stored Check Control messages are also dis- played with the following symbols:

No malfunctions are present in the moni- tored systems.

Malfunctions are present in the moni- tored systems. Depending on the mal- function, supplementary information is shown on the Control Display.

The symbols also indicate the status of the ser- vice requirements display, refer to page 81.

Displays after completion of trip Malfunction reports generated during the trip are shown consecutively when you switch off the ignition.

Before the display disappears, you can display the messages once again. Press the CHECK button for approx. 2 seconds. If several mes- sages are present, you can continue to press the CHECK button to view them in succession.

The display goes out

> automatically after a brief period

> when you press the CHECK button again for approx. 2 seconds

Speed limit You can enter a speed and a Check Control message indicates when you have reached this speed. This enables you, for example, to receive warnings if you exceed a speed limit in an urban area. You are only warned of reaching this speed a second time if your vehicle speed falls below it again by at least 3 mph/5 km/h.

Displaying, setting or changing limit iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Open "Navigation". Without navigation system*: Open "Car Data".

3. Select "Car Data" and press the controller.

4. Select "Limit" and press the controller.

5. Select the speed value and press the con- troller.

6. Turn the controller to set the limit. If needed, hold it against a slight resistance to enter a larger difference.

7. Press the controller to apply the setting. The limit is automatically activated.

Applying your current speed as limit Select "Select current speed" and press the controller. The system adopts your current speed as the limit.

Activating limit Select "On" and press the controller.

Limit is automatically activated.

E ve

ry th

in g

u nd

er c

o n

tr o

l

86

Stopwatch iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Open "Navigation". Without navigation system*: Open "Car Data".

3. Select "Car Data" and press the controller.

4. Select "Stopwatch" and press the control- ler.

Starting, stopping or resetting > Select "Start" and press the controller.

The stopwatch starts at the displayed time.

> Select "Reset" and press the controller. The stopwatch is reset and it restarts if it was running beforehand.

> Select "Stop" and press the controller. This stops the timer.

Taking an intermediate time reading Select "Interim time" and press the controller. The interim time appears below the ongoing primary stopwatch count.

All of the other functions remain available even while the stopwatch is running. The

stopwatch continues operation in the back- ground.<

Settings on Control Display iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button once or twice until the start menu appears.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

Setting time 1. Turn the controller until "Time / Date" is

selected and press the controller.

C o

n tr

o ls

87

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

2. Move the controller once to the front if nec- essary to change to the first field from the top.

3. Turn the controller until "Time" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "Set time" is selected and press the controller.

Making settings 1. Turn the controller to set the hours and

press the controller.

2. Turn the controller to set the minutes and press the controller.

The changed time is stored.

Switching on hour signal* You will hear three tones just before the top of each hour.

Select "Hour memo" and press the controller. The hour signal is activated.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Setting 12h/24h format 1. Select "Time format" and press the control-

ler.

2. Select the desired format and press the controller.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Setting date 1. Select "Date" and press the controller.

2. Select "Set date" and press the controller. The first section of the date display is selected, in this case the month.

3. Turn the controller to make the adjustment.

4. Press the controller to apply the setting. The next setting is selected.

5. Make the remaining adjustments. After the last adjustment, the date is stored.

Setting date format 1. Select "Date format" and press the control-

ler.

2. Select the desired format and press the controller.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

E ve

ry th

in g

u nd

er c

o n

tr o

l

88

Brightness of Control Display The brightness is automatically adapted to the ambient lighting conditions. However, you can change the basic setting.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Display settings" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Brightness" is selected and press the controller.

6. If necessary, move the controller to the right to select "Display".

7. Turn the controller until the desired setting is selected.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Units of measure You can change the units of measure for con- sumption, distances, temperature and pres- sure.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Language / Units" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Units" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select the menu item to be set and press the controller.

7. Select the desired unit of measure and press the controller.

The settings are stored for the remote key cur- rently in use.

Language on Control Display iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Language / Units" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Languages" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Text language" and press the con- troller. You can change the language of the text displays.

7. Select and activate the desired language by pressing the controller.

C o

n tr

o ls

89

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Volume of warning tones* On vehicles equipped with a single drive, you can increase or decrease the volume of the warning tones, e.g. for the safety belt reminder, compared to the entertainment sound output. The warning tones have a specified minimum and maximum volume that cannot be dropped below or exceeded.

1. Select "Tone / Volume" and press the con- troller.

2. Select "Volume settings" and press the controller.

3. Change to the second field from the top if necessary. Select "Warning tones" and press the controller.

4. If necessary, change the field and turn the controller. The setting is applied.

T ec

hn o

lo g

y fo

r c o

m fo

rt , c

o n

ve n

ie n

ce a

nd s

af et

y

90

Technology for comfort, convenience and safety

PDC Park Distance Control*

The concept The PDC assists you when you are parking. Acoustic signals and an optical display* alert you to the approach of an object from behind your vehicle. To measure the distance, there are four ultrasonic sensors in each bumper. The range of these sensors is approx. 7 ft/2 m. However, an acoustic warning first sounds for the sensors at the front and at the two rear cor- ners at approx. 24 in/60 cm, and for the center rear sensors at approx. 5 ft/1.50 m.

PDC is a parking aid that can indicate objects when they are approached

slowly, as is usually the case when parking. Avoid approaching an object at high speed, oth- erwise the physical circumstances would mean that the system warning was too late.<

Automatic activation The system starts to operate approx. one sec- ond after you shift into reverse or move the selector lever into position R with the engine running or the ignition switched on.

Wait this short time before driving off.

Manual activation

Press the button, the LED lights up.

Manual deactivation Press the button again; the LED goes out.

Automatic deactivation After driving approx. 165 ft/50 m or at over approx. 20 mph/30 km/h, the system is switched off and the LED goes out. You can reactivate the system manually as needed.

Signal tones When nearing an object, the position is corre- spondingly indicated by an interval tone. Thus, an object detected to the left rear of the vehicle will be indicated by a signal tone from the left rear speaker, etc. As the distance between vehicle and object decreases, the intervals between the tones become shorter. If the dis- tance to the nearest object falls to below roughly 1 ft/30 cm, then a continuous tone sounds.

An intermittent tone is interrupted after approx. 3 seconds:

> if you remain in front of an object that was only detected by one of the corner sensors

> if you drive parallel to a wall

Malfunction The LED in the button flashes and a message appears on the Control Display. PDC is mal- functioning. Have the system checked.

To prevent this problem, keep the sensors clean and free of ice or snow in order to ensure that they will continue to operate effectively. Do not spray the sensors with high-pressure clean- ers for long periods and maintain a distance of at least 4 in/10 cm to them.

PDC with visual warning* You can also have the system show distances to objects on the Control Display. Objects that are farther away are already shown there before a signal tone sounds. The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

C o

n tr

o ls

91

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "Vehicle / Tires" is selected and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "PDC" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "PDC display on" and press the con- troller.

The PDC screen is activated.

The display appears on the Control Display as soon as PDC is activated.

System limits Even with PDC, final responsibility for estimating the distance between the

vehicle and any obstructions always remains with the driver. Even when sensors are pro- vided, there is a blind spot in which objects can no longer be detected. The system is also sub- ject to the physical limits that apply to all forms of ultrasonic measurement, such as those encountered with tow bars and trailer cou- plings, or thin and wedge-shaped objects etc.

Low objects already displayed, e.g. curbs, can also disappear from the detection area of the sensors again before or after a continuous tone already sounds. Higher, protruding objects, e.g. ledges, cannot be detected. For this reason, drive with care; otherwise, there is a danger of personal injury or property damage. Loud sources of sound, inside and outside the vehicle, could drown out the PDC signal tone.<

Driving stability control systems Your BMW is equipped with an extended array of systems designed to enhance and maintain vehicle stability under extreme conditions.

ABS Antilock Brake System ABS prevents locking of the wheels during braking. Safe steering response is maintained even during full braking. Active safety is thus increased.

The ABS is operational every time you start the engine. Braking safely refer to page 136.

CBC Cornering Brake Control When braking during curves or when braking during a lane change, driving stability and steer- ing response are improved further.

Electronic brake-force distribution The system controls the brake pressure in the rear wheels to ensure stable braking behavior.

Brake assistant When you apply the brakes rapidly, this system automatically produces the maximum braking force boost and thus helps to achieve the short- est possible braking distance during full brak- ing. This system exploits all of the benefits pro- vided by ABS.

Do not reduce the pressure on the brake pedal for the duration of the full braking.

T ec

hn o

lo g

y fo

r c o

m fo

rt , c

o n

ve n

ie n

ce a

nd s

af et

y

92

Adaptive brake assistant* In conjunction with the active cruise control with the stop-and-go function, the adaptive brake assistant ensures that the brake responds even more quickly during braking with the brake assistant.

DSC Dynamic Stability Control DSC prevents traction loss in the driving wheels when starting off and accelerating. The system also identifies unstable driving conditions, such as a loss of traction at the rear of the vehicle or sliding of the vehicle in its front wheels. In these cases, DSC helps the vehicle maintain a safe course within physical limits by reducing engine output and through braking actions in the indi- vidual wheels.

The laws of physics cannot be repealed, even with DSC. An appropriate driving

style always remains the responsibility of the driver. Therefore, do not restrict the additional safety margin with a risky driving style, as other- wise there is a risk of an accident.<

Deactivating DSC

Press the button until the DSC indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up, but not longer than approx. 10 seconds. DTC Dynamic Trac- tion Control and DSC are deactivated together. Stabilizing and drive output promoting actions are no longer executed. In addition, the stability promoting intervention of the active steering* is deactivated, refer to page 99.

A message appears on the Control Display. Please note any supplementary information that appears there.

To increase vehicle stability, activate DSC again as soon as possible.

Activating DSC Press the button; the indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.

For better control The indicator lamp flashes: DSC controls the drive forces and brake forces.

The indicator lamp lights up: DSC is deactivated.

DTC Dynamic Traction Control DTC is a version of DSC in which the drive out- put is optimized for particular road conditions, e.g. unplowed snow-covered roads. The sys- tem assures the maximal drive output, but with reduced driving stability. It is therefore neces- sary to drive with appropriate caution.

You may find it useful to briefly activate DTC under the following special circumstances:

> When driving on snowy inclines, in slush, or on unplowed, snow-covered road surfaces

> When rocking a stuck vehicle free or start- ing off in deep snow or on loose ground

> When driving with snow chains*

Activating DTC

Press the button briefly; the DTC indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.

C o

n tr

o ls

93

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

For better control The indicator lamp flashes: DTC controls the drive forces and brake forces.

The indicator lamp lights up: DTC is activated.

Deactivating DTC Press the button again; the DTC indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.

xDrive on 528xi, 535xi xDrive is the 4-wheel drive system of your BMW. The combined effects of xDrive and DSC further optimize the traction and dynamic driv- ing characteristics. The 4-wheel drive system xDrive variably distributes the drive torque to the front and rear axle depending on the driving situation and prevailing road conditions.

HDC Hill Descent Control on 528xi, 535xi

The concept HDC is a system for driving downhill in steep terrain. This system reduces vehicle speed on steep downhill gradients, thus allowing you to maintain even better control of your BMW under these conditions. The vehicle moves at approximately twice walking speed without active intervention from the driver.

HDC is available for activation at vehicle speeds below approx. 22 mph/35 km/h. When driving down steep hills with a speed below approx. 22 mph/35 km/h, the vehicle reduces speed automatically down to approximately double walking speed, approx. 7 mph/12 km/h, and then maintains this speed at a constant.

You can use the accelerator or brakes to vary this automatically controlled speed within a range extending from approx. 3 mph/5 km/h to 15 mph/25 km/h. You can specify a target speed within the same range by using the lever of the cruise control*.

Activating HDC You can activate HDC:

> with the programmable buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 54

> using iDrive

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "HDC" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "HDC on" and press the controller.

HDC is shown in the instrument cluster.

If the vehicle is automatically braked, a message is displayed on the Control Display for approx. 20 seconds.

Deactivating HDC When you use the programmable buttons on the steering wheel or via iDrive, the HDC display goes out.

HDC is automatically deactivated in the follow- ing situations:

> Above approx. 37 mph/60 km/h

> After switching off the ignition

Using HDC Manual transmission: Use HDC in low gears and reverse gear.

T ec

hn o

lo g

y fo

r c o

m fo

rt , c

o n

ve n

ie n

ce a

nd s

af et

y

94

Automatic transmission: You can use HDC in every drive position.

Displays in instrument cluster

1 Display for target speed

2 HDC display

Malfunction in driving-stability control systems

The warning lamp for the brake system lights up, together with the indicator lamps for ABS, DSC and Tire Pressure Monitor or Flat Tire Monitor. A mes- sage appears on the Control Display. The driving-stability control systems have failed. Conventional braking effi- ciency remains available without limita- tions. While you may continue, you should remember to proceed cau-

tiously and drive defensively while avoiding full brake applications. The Tire Pressure Monitor or the Flat Tire Monitor is also malfunctioning. Have the system checked as soon as possible.

Display of the previously described malfunction in Canadian models.

The DSC indicator lamp lights up. A message appears on the Control Dis- play. A malfunction has occurred in the

DSC and DTC. The stabilizing actions are no

longer available. The vehicle remains opera- tional. Have the system checked as soon as possible.

The brake system warning lamp lights up yellow. A message appears on the Control Display. The brake assistant is

defective. Have the system checked as soon as possible.

Display of the previously described malfunction in Canadian models.

Starting assistant The starting assistant enables you to start off conveniently on slopes. The handbrake is not required for this purpose.

1. Hold the vehicle with the footbrake.

2. Release the footbrake and drive off quickly.

The starting assistant holds the vehicle for approx. 2 seconds after releasing the

footbrake. After releasing the footbrake, begin to drive immediately; otherwise, the starting assistant no longer holds the vehicle after approx. 1 second and your vehicle will start to roll backward.<

Dynamic Drive*

The concept Dynamic Drive minimizes body roll and opti- mizes vehicle stability during cornering and evasive maneuvers.

Dynamic Drive is based on active stabilizers on the front and rear axles. Suspension compli- ance adapts to suit driving conditions, varying from performance-oriented during cornering to smooth and comfort-oriented when the vehicle is proceeding in a straight line. During vehicle operation, the system continuously runs through closed-loop control cycles lasting only fractions of a second.

The system assumes operational status each time you start the engine.

C o

n tr

o ls

95

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Sports Wagon: self-leveling suspension

Malfunction The warning lamp for self-leveling sus- pension lights up yellow and a message is shown on the Control Display. A mal-

function has occurred in the self-leveling sus- pension. Stop and check the vehicle. If it is con- siderably lower at the rear than at the front, and possibly also on one side rear left compared to rear right , go to the nearest BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained per- sonnel. Drive with appropriate caution in the meantime. The vehicle has reduced ground clearance and driving comfort may be notice- ably reduced. Even if the position of the vehicle is normal, go to the nearest BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained per- sonnel.

FTM Flat Tire Monitor*

The concept The Flat Tire Monitor detects a pressure loss in one tire by comparing the speeds of the individ- ual wheels during driving.

In the event of a pressure loss, there is a change in the rolling circumference and therefore the rotation speed of the corresponding wheel. The system detects this change and reports it as a flat tire.

Functional requirement In order to assure the reliable reporting of a flat tire, the system must be initialized for the cor- rect tire inflation pressure.

The initialization must be repeated after each time the tire inflation pressure is cor-

rected and after every tire or wheel change.<

System limits The Flat Tire Monitor cannot indicate sudden severe tire damage caused by outside factors and does not detect a natural, even pressure drop in all four tires.

In the following situations, the system could be delayed or malfunction:

> System has not been initialized

> Driving on snowy or slippery road surface

> Sporty driving style: slip in the drive wheels, high lateral acceleration

> Driving with snow chains* When you are driving with the compact wheel* the Flat Tire Monitor is unable to function.

Initializing system The initialization finishes during driving, which can be interrupted at any time.

When driving resumes, the initialization is con- tinued automatically. Do not initialize the sys- tem when driving with snow chains* or com- pact wheel*.<

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

T ec

hn o

lo g

y fo

r c o

m fo

rt , c

o n

ve n

ie n

ce a

nd s

af et

y

96

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "FTM" is selected and press the controller.

6. Start the engine, but do not start driving.

7. Select "Reset" and press the controller.

8. Select "Yes" and press the controller.

9. Start to drive. "resetting FTM " is displayed.

The initialization finishes during driving.

Indication of a flat tire The warning lamp lights up red. A mes- sage appears on the Control Display. In addition, an acoustic signal sounds.

There is a flat tire or extensive inflation pressure loss.

1. Reduce speed and stop the vehicle care- fully. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneuvers.

2. Identify damaged tire.

If identification is not possible, con- tact a BMW center.<

3. Replace the damaged wheel, refer to Changing wheels on page 242.

Run-flat tires* 1. Cautiously reduce speed to below 50 mph/

80 km/h. Avoid severe braking and steering maneuvers and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.

If the vehicle is not equipped with run- flat tires, refer to page 227, do not

continue driving. Continuing to drive with a flat tire could cause severe accidents.<

2. At the next opportunity, check the air pres- sure in all four tires.

If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Flat Tire Monitor

may not have been initialized. The system must then be initialized.<

3. In the event of complete tire pressure loss, 0 psi/0 kPa, you can estimate the possible distance for continued driving on the basis of the following guide values:

> With a light load: 1 to 2 persons without luggage: approx. 155 miles/250 km

> With a medium load: 2 persons, cargo bay full, or 4 persons without luggage: approx. 94 miles/150 km

> With a full load: 4 or more persons, cargo bay full: approx. 30 miles/50 km

Drive cautiously and do not exceed 50 mph/80 km/h or else you run the risk of

causing an accident. In the event of pressure loss, vehicle handling changes. This includes reduced tracking stability in braking, extended braking distance and altered natural steering characteristics. If unusual vibrations or loud noises occur while the vehicle is being driven, this can indicate final failure of the damaged tire. Reduce speed and stop at a suitable location as soon as possible, otherwise pieces of the tire could become detached and cause an accident. Do not con- tinue driving, but instead contact your BMW center.<

C o

n tr

o ls

97

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

TPM Tire Pressure Monitor*

The concept TPM checks the tire inflation pressure in the four mounted tires. The system reports when the tire inflation pressure has dropped consid- erably in one or several tires.

Functional requirement In order to assure the reliable reporting of a flat tire, the system must be reset at the correct tire inflation pressure.

Always use wheels with TPM electronics, oth- erwise fault-free operation of the system is not ensured.

Reset the system again after each correc- tion of the tire inflation pressure and after

every tire or wheel change.<

System limits TPM cannot announce sudden serious tire damage caused by external influences.

The system does not function properly if it has not been reset, e.g. a flat tire is reported despite correct tire inflation pressures.

The system is inactive and cannot display a flat tire if a wheel has been mounted without TPM electronics, e.g. a compact wheel, or if TPM is temporarily interfered with by other systems or devices which use the same radio frequency.

Status display on Control Display The tire and system status is indicated by the color of the tires.

TPM takes the fact that the tire pressure changes during driving into account. A correc- tion is only required if requested by TPM with the color.

Green The tire pressure matches the learned set state.

"TPM active" is displayed on the Control Dis- play.

One wheel is yellow Flat tire or a major drop in inflation pressure in the indicated tire. A message appears on the Control Display.

All wheels are yellow Flat tire or a major drop in inflation pressure in several tires. A message appears on the Control Display.

Gray The system cannot detect a flat tire.

Reasons for this can be:

> TPM is being reset

> Temporary interference due to systems or devices which use the same radio fre- quency

> Malfunction

Resetting system Reset the system again after each correc- tion of the tire inflation pressure and after

every tire or wheel change.<

Resetting finishes during driving, which can be interrupted at any time. When driving resumes, resetting is continued automatically. Do not reset the system when driving with a compact wheel*.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "TPM" is selected and press the controller.

T ec

hn o

lo g

y fo

r c o

m fo

rt , c

o n

ve n

ie n

ce a

nd s

af et

y

98

6. Start the engine, but do not start driving.

7. Select "Reset" and press the controller.

8. Select "Yes" and press the controller.

9. Start to drive. The tires are shown in gray and "Resetting TPM..." is displayed.

After a few minutes of driving, the set tire infla- tion pressures in the tires are applied as the set values to be monitored. Resetting finishes dur- ing driving. The tires are shown in green on the Control Display.

If a flat tire is detected during resetting and applying the tire inflation pressures,

all tires are shown in yellow on the Control Dis- play. The message "Tire low!" is displayed.<

Message with low tire inflation pressure

The warning lamp lights up yellow. A message appears on the Control Dis- play. In addition, an acoustic signal

sounds. There is a flat tire or extensive inflation pressure loss.

1. Reduce speed and stop the vehicle care- fully. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneuvers.

2. Check whether your vehicle is equipped with standard tires or run-flat tires.

You will recognize run-flat tires by a circular symbol containing the letters

RSC on the side of the tire, refer to page 227.<

Standard tires 1. If all four wheels are shown in yellow, iden-

tify the damaged tire on the vehicle.

2. Replace the damaged wheel or wheels, refer to Changing wheels on page 242.

In contrast to a compact wheel, a spare wheel is equipped with the necessary TPM electronics and also monitored after mounting and after resetting the system.

Have the tire replaced by a BMW center or a workshop informed on handling TPM which works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel.

Run-flat tires* 1. Cautiously reduce speed to below 50 mph/

80 km/h. Avoid severe braking and steering maneuvers and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.

If the vehicle is not equipped with run- flat tires, refer to page 227, do not

continue driving. Continuing to drive with a flat tire could cause severe accidents.<

2. In the event of complete tire pressure loss, 0 psi/0 kPa, you can estimate the possible distance for continued driving on the basis of the following guide values:

> With a light load: 1 to 2 persons without luggage: approx. 155 miles/250 km

> With a medium load: 2 persons, cargo bay full, or 4 persons without luggage: approx. 95 miles/150 km

> With a full load: 4 or more persons, cargo bay full: approx. 30 miles/50 km

C o

n tr

o ls

99

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Drive reservedly and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h. In the event of

pressure loss, vehicle handling changes. This includes reduced tracking stability in braking, extended braking distance and altered natural steering characteristics. If unusual vibrations or loud noises occur while the vehicle is being driven, this can indicate final failure of the damaged tire. Reduce speed and stop at a suitable location as soon as possible, otherwise pieces of the tire could become detached and cause an accident. Do not con- tinue driving, but instead contact your BMW center.<

Malfunction The yellow warning lamp flashes and then lights up continuously. The tires are shown in gray on the Control Dis-

play and a message is displayed. No flat tire can be detected.

A message like this is displayed in the following situations:

> In case of a malfunction; have the system checked.

> If a wheel is mounted without TPM elec- tronics

> If TPM is temporarily interfered with by other systems or devices which use the same radio frequency.

Declaration according to NHTSA/ FMVSS 138 Tire Pressure Monitoring Systems Each tire, including the spare, should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire infla- tion pressure label. If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires. As an added safety fea- ture, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system, TPMS, that illumi- nates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires are significantly under-

inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pres- sure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a signif- icantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Underinfla- tion also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if underinflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.

The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the sys- tem detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle startups as long as the malfunction exists. When the mal- function indicator lights up, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.

Active steering*

The concept The active steering is a system that actively var- ies the steering angle of the front wheels in rela- tion to the steering wheel movements.

When you are driving in the low road speed range, e.g. in a town or when parking, the steer- ing angle increases, i.e. the steering becomes very direct. In the higher speed range, on the other hand, the steering angle is reduced more and more. This improves the handling capability of your BMW over the entire speed range.

T ec

hn o

lo g

y fo

r c o

m fo

rt , c

o n

ve n

ie n

ce a

nd s

af et

y

100

In critical situations, the system can make tar- geted corrections to the steering angle pro- vided by the driver and thus stabilize the vehicle before the driver intervenes. This stabilizing intervention is simultaneously deactivated when DSC is switched off, refer to page 92.

Malfunction The warning lamp lights up yellow and a message is shown on the Control Display. The active steering is no

longer operational. At low speeds, greater steering wheel movements are required, whereas at higher speeds, the vehicle reacts more sensitively to steering wheel movements. The stability-promoting intervention can also be deactivated. Proceed cautiously and drive defensively. Have the system checked.

Brake force display

On the left: normal braking.

On the right: heavy braking.

Airbags

The following airbags are located under the marked covers:

1 Front airbags

2 Head airbags

3 Side airbags in front and rear

Protective action To ensure that the safety systems con- tinue to provide optimized protection,

please observe the adjustment instructions on page 45.<

The front airbags help protect the driver and front passenger by responding to frontal impacts in which safety belts alone cannot pro- vide adequate restraint. When needed, the head and side airbags help provide protection in

the event of side impact. The relevant side air- bag supports the side upper body area. The head air bag supports the head.

The airbags are deliberately not triggered in every impact situation, e.g. less severe acci- dents or rear-end collisions.

Do not apply adhesive materials to the cover panels of the airbags, cover them or

modify them in any other way. Do not attempt to remove the airbag restraint system from the vehicle. Do not modify or tamper with either the wiring or the individual components in the air- bag system. This category includes the uphol- stery in the center of the steering wheel, on the instrument panel, the doors and the roof pillars along with the sides of the headliner. Do not attempt to remove or dismantle the steering

C o

n tr

o ls

101

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

wheel. Do not touch the individual components immediately after the system has been trig- gered, because there is a danger of burns. In the event of malfunctions, deactivation, or triggering of the airbag restraint system, have the testing, repair, removal, and disposal of air- bag generators executed only by a BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel and has the required explosives licenses. Otherwise unprofessional attempts to service the system could lead to failure in an emergency or undesired airbag triggering, either of which could result in personal injury.<

Warnings and information on the airbags is also provided on the sun visors.

Automatic deactivation of front passenger airbags The occupation of the seat is detected by eval- uating the impression on the occupied seat sur- face of the front passenger seat. The front and side airbags on the front passenger side are activated or deactivated accordingly by the sys- tem.

The current status of the front passenger airbag, i.e. deactivated or activated, is

indicated by the indicator lamp over the interior rearview mirror, refer to Operating state of front passenger airbags in the following.<

Before transporting a child on the front passenger seat, observe the safety infor-

mation and handling instructions under Trans- porting children safely refer to page 56. The front and side airbags on the front passen- ger side can be deactivated for teenagers and adults in certain sitting positions; then the indi- cator lamp for the front passenger airbags lights up. In these cases, change the sitting position so that the front passenger airbags are acti- vated and the indicator lamp goes out. If the desired status cannot be produced by changing the sitting position, transport the correspond- ing person on the rear seat. Do not fit seat cov- ers, seat cushion padding, ball mats or other items onto the front passenger seat unless they are specifically recommended by BMW. Do not lay objects under the seat which could press

against the seat from below. Otherwise a cor- rect evaluation of the occupied seat surface cannot be ensured.<

Operating state of front passenger airbags

Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the arrangement of the switches and indicator lamps may differ somewhat.

The indicator lamp for the front passenger air- bags indicates the operating status of the front and side airbags on the front passenger side depending on the seat occupation. The indica- tor lamp shows whether the front passenger airbags are activated or deactivated.

> The indicator lamp lights up when a child in a child restraint system intended for the purpose is properly detected on the seat. The front and side airbags on the front pas- senger side are not activated.

Most child's seats are detected by the system. Especially the child's seats

required by the NHTSA at the time the vehicle is manufactured. After installing a child's seat, make sure that the indicator lamp for the front passenger airbags lights up. This indicates that the child's seat has been detected and the front passenger airbags are not activated.<

> The indicator lamp does not light up when, for example, a correctly seated person of sufficient height is detected on the seat. The front and side airbags on the front pas- senger side are activated.

> The indicator lamp does not light up when the seat is empty. However, the front and side airbags on the front passenger side are not activated.

T ec

hn o

lo g

y fo

r c o

m fo

rt , c

o n

ve n

ie n

ce a

nd s

af et

y

102

Operational readiness of airbag system

From radio readiness, refer to page 61, the warning lamp lights up briefly, indicating the operational readiness of the entire airbag sys- tem and the safety belt tensioners.

Airbag system malfunction > Warning lamp does not light up from radio

readiness.

> Warning lamp lights up continuously.

Have the airbag system checked immedi- ately in case of a malfunction, otherwise

there is a danger that the airbag system may not respond in the expected manner in an accident despite an impact of corresponding intensity.<

Head-Up Display*

The concept With the Head-Up Display important informa- tion is projected into the driver's field of view, e.g. navigation instructions. This enables you to take in this information without looking away from the road.

Switching on/off Press the button.

1 Navigation instructions

2 Display

> Cruise control

> Active cruise control

> Leaving lane warning

3 Speed

Selecting displays iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

C o

n tr

o ls

103

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

4. Select "Display settings" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Head-Up Display" is selected and press the controller.

6. Change into the second field from the top. Turn the controller until "Head-Up Display" is selected and press the controller.

7. Select desired information of Head-Up Dis- play.

8. Press the controller. The information appears in the Head-

Up Display.

The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Setting brightness The brightness of the display is automatically adapted to the ambient lighting conditions. However, you can change the basic setting. With the low beams switched on, the brightness can also be adjusted with the knurled wheel of the instrument lighting.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Display settings" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Head-Up Display" is selected and press the controller.

6. Change into the second field from the top. Turn the controller until "Brightness" is selected and press the controller.

7. Turn the controller until the desired setting is selected.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Notes The visibility of the displays in the Head-Up Dis- play is influenced by:

> Sunglasses with certain polarization filters

> Certain seating positions

> Objects on the cover of the Head-Up Dis- play

> Wet road surface and unfavorable lighting conditions

If the image is distorted, please have the basic setting checked at a BMW center.

Special windshield The windshield is part of the system. The shape of the windshield complies with the require- ments of the Head-Up Display to enable a pre- cise display. A film in the windshield prevents the double images from being displayed. Windshield replacement should be carried out by a BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with cor- respondingly trained personnel.

Care instructions You can find everything you need to know on this topic by consulting the separate Caring for your vehicle brochure.

T ec

hn o

lo g

y fo

r c o

m fo

rt , c

o n

ve n

ie n

ce a

nd s

af et

y

104

Only clean the cover of the Head-Up Dis- play with a soft, nonabrasive cloth or with

a display cleaning cloth; otherwise, you may damage it.<

BMW Night Vision*

The concept BMW Night Vision is a driver assistance system that is designed to provide enhanced vision for certain objects at night. This can be especially helpful for detecting people and larger animals. When objects are detected, the driver may be able to take appropriate action sooner. For example, the driver may identify and detect the presence of persons or animals in the road ahead or off to the sides and can be more alert, slow down or stop, blow the horn etc. The driver can decide which actions are appropriate and then react accordingly.

A certain area in front of the vehicle is viewed by an infrared camera and a generated image is shown on the Control Display. The resulting thermal image shows the relative heat radiation of the objects present in the camera's field of view. Warmer objects appear brighter and cooler objects appear darker. Contrast is dependent on the temperature difference between the objects and the background and on the amount of heat radiation of the object itself. As a result, it is quite possible that a per- son is not continually recognizable as a person in shape, since the thermal radiation can be affected by different clothing which blocks heat loss. Objects with little temperature difference to the surrounding area, or little heat radiation are less noticeable, for example in cold weather.

Any improvement in detection depends on many factors such as the object size and tem- perature compared to the surroundings, or other nearby objects, the visual recognition skills of the driver, weather conditions, and other factors.

Driving hints With the system active, periodically but briefly, glance at the thermal image on the Control Dis- play to notice objects that could be people or larger animals. The glance should be similar to glancing at the rear view mirror. Do not stare at the image for long periods while driving, as this will remove attention from the road. If you notice an object of interest ahead, be prepared to slow down or stop, blow the horn, or take other appropriate action.

System limits The system is designed to supplement but not replace forward vision through the windshield. The driver is responsible for safe driving at night. BMW Night Vision is not designed to be used as a continuous viewing window for driv- ing at night.

No system, no matter how sophisticated, can operate without limitations. BMW Night Vision operation is subject to physical and environ- mental limitations that will reduce the ability of the system to detect and display a clear thermal image. Some of the situations in which these limitations can occur are:

> on steep hilltops or depressions and in tight curves

> in tunnels, as the contrast is inherently low

> when the camera lens is dirty

C o

n tr

o ls

105

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

> in dense fog, heavy rain or snowfall

> when displaying very hot objects such as transformers, car exhausts etc.

> when the image briefly freezes during nor- mal system adjustment.

BMW Night Vision's potential benefits can be limited by the driving style of the

driver, the size and relative temperature of the detected objects, dirt or contamination on the camera lens, adverse weather like snow, rain or fog, and other factors not mentioned here. It will always be the driver's responsibility to drive at a speed and in a manner that recognizes potential hazards and adjust accordingly. BMW Night Vision is not a substitute or replace- ment for the driver's responsibility to adapt to visibility and traffic conditions. The forward view illuminated by the headlamps must always be the basis for making safe driving decisions, oth- erwise a safety risk will result.<

Activating BMW Night Vision 1. Turn the light switch to position 2 or 3, refer

to page 108.

2. With low beams switched on:

> Press the button. Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the location of the button may differ somewhat.

> Press one of the programmable buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 54.

The image will be displayed on the Control Dis- play after a few seconds. Depending on the last mode selected, either the normal or full screen image will be displayed.

Due to the system's need to adjust periodically, a still image is displayed at certain intervals for fractions of a second. This is normal and not an indication of a problem.

To prevent driving without headlamps, at a speed of more than approx. 3 mph/5 km/h and when dark, the thermal image on the Control Display is only shown when the low beams are on.

Deactivating BMW Night Vision > Press the button.

> Press the button on the steering wheel.

> Press the button.

> Via iDrive, refer to Selecting settings.

Selecting settings For iDrive details, refer to page 16.

1. Activate BMW Night Vision.

2. Press the controller to display the menu items.

T ec

hn o

lo g

y fo

r c o

m fo

rt , c

o n

ve n

ie n

ce a

nd s

af et

y

106

3. Select the menu item and press the control- ler:

> "Night Vision off": Deactivate BMW Night Vision.

> "Zoom": At higher speeds, the image is zoomed in.

> "Curve mode": Depending on the steering angle and other parameters, the image sections follows the course of the road to some degree.

> "Full screen": The image is shown on the entire Con- trol Display.

> "Contrast": The contrast of the screen can be adjusted.

> "Brightness": The brightness of the screen can be adjusted.

"Curve mode" can only be activated with the "Zoom" function switched on. With

"Full screen" activated, "Curve mode" and "Zoom" cannot be selected.<

The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.

To exit the menu: The image will automatically disappear after approx. 5 seconds.

Cleaning camera

The function of the camera may be affected by heavy rain and fog, dirt, snow or ice on the lens. When this occurs, the displayed image on the Control Display may become gray.

To minimize icing, the camera lens is automati- cally heated. However, it may be necessary to clean the camera lens manually under severe weather conditions. When doing so, cautiously remove any debris, ice or snow. To avoid dam- age to the lens, do not use sharp or abrasive instruments to clean ice, snow, or dirt off the lens.

When the windshield is cleaned with the head- lamps on, the camera lens area is automatically sprayed as well. Refer to page 68.

Leaving lane warning*

The concept This system warns you from a speed of approx. 40 mph/70 km/h when the vehicle is leaving the lane you are currently in on roads with lane limit lines. You feel this due to a slight vibration of the steering wheel. The system does not warn you if you signal before leaving the lane. It is best to use the system on well-developed roads and freeways.

Switching on/off

Press the button on the steering wheel.

> The two lines 1 indicate that the system is activated.

> The two arrows 2 mean that the system has detected one or two lane limit lines from a speed of approx. 40 mph/70 km/h and warns accordingly.

C o

n tr

o ls

107

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

If you activate the system below a speed of approx. 40 mph/70 km/h, a message will appear stating that the system is not active until this speed is reached.

A warning will be canceled:

> after approx. 3 seconds

> if you return to your lane

> if you brake heavily

> if you signal

System limits The leaving lane warning cannot serve as a substitute for your personal judgment in

determining the course of the road. If the system issues a warning, do not move the steering wheel with unnecessary severity, as otherwise you could loose control of the vehi- cle.<

The function of the system may be limited in the following example situations:

> in heavy fog, rain or snowfall

> with worn-away, poorly visible limit lines, or lines that run together or apart or are unclear, e.g. in road construction areas

> when limit lines are covered by snow, ice, dirt or a great deal of water

> in tight curves or on narrow roads

> when limit lines are not white

> when limit lines are covered by objects

> when driving up close behind a vehicle driv- ing ahead

> with bright counter light

> when the windshield is fogged up, dirty or covered with stickers, vignettes etc. in the area of the inside rearview mirror

L am

p s

108

Lamps

Parking lamps/low beams

0 Lights off and daytime running lamps* 1 Parking lamps and daytime running lamps* 2 Low beams and welcome lamps

3 Automatic headlamp control*, daytime run- ning lamps*, welcome lamps, Adaptive Head Light* and high-beam assistant*

If you open the driver's door with the ignition switched off, the exterior lighting is automati- cally switched off when the light switch is in position 0, 2 or 3.

Parking lamps In switch position 1, the front, rear and side vehicle lighting is switched on. You can use the parking lamps for parking.

The parking lamps drain the battery. Do not leave them switched on for long peri-

ods of time, otherwise it may no longer be pos- sible to start the engine. It is preferable to switch on the roadside parking lamps on one side, refer to page 110.<

Low beams The low beams light up when the light switch is in position 2 and the ignition is on.

Automatic headlamp control* In switch position 3, the system activates the low beams and switches them on or off in response to changes in ambient light condi- tions, for instance, in a tunnel, at dawn and dusk and in case of precipitation. Adaptive Head Light* is active. The LED next to the symbol lights up when the low beams are on. You can activate the daytime running lamps, refer to page 109. In the situations named above, the system then automatically switches over to the low beams.

A blue sky with the sun low on the horizon can cause the lights to be switched on.

The low beams remain switched on inde- pendent of the ambient lighting condi-

tions when you switch on the fog lamps*.<

The automatic headlamp control cannot serve as a substitute for your personal

judgment in determining when the lamps should be switched on in response to ambient lighting conditions. For example, the sensors cannot detect fog of hazy weather. To avoid safety risks, you should always switch on the low beams manually under these conditions.<

Welcome lamps If you leave the light switch in position 2 or 3 when parking the vehicle, then when you unlock the vehicle, the parking lamps and interior light- ing remain illuminated for a brief time.

Activating/deactivating welcome lamps iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

C o

n tr

o ls

109

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Lighting" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Welcome light" and press the con- troller.

The welcome lamps are switched on.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Pathway lighting When you activate the headlamp flasher after parking the vehicle and switching off the lamps, the low beams will come on for a brief period. You can set the duration or deactivate the func- tion via iDrive.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Lighting" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Pathway lighting" and press the controller.

7. Turn the controller to select the desired duration.

8. Press the controller to apply the setting.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Daytime running lamps* The daytime running lamps light up in position 0, 1 and 3. If the light switch remains in position 1,the parking lamps light up after the ignition is switched off.

Activating/deactivating daytime running lamps* iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Lighting" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Daytime running lamps" and press the controller.

The daytime running lamps are switched on.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

L am

p s

110

Adaptive Head Light*

The concept Adaptive Head Light is a variable headlamp control system that enables better illumination of the road surface. Depending on the steering angle and other parameters, the light from the headlamp follows the course of the road.

In tight curves at speeds up to approx. 45 mph/ 70 km/h, e.g. on mountainous roads or when negotiating curves, turning lamps are switched on that light up the inside area of the curve.

Activating Adaptive Head Light With the ignition switched on, turn the light switch into position 3, refer to page 108.

The turning lamps are automatically switched on depending on the steering angle or the use of turn signals.

To avoid blinding oncoming traffic, the Adaptive Head Light directs light towards the front pas- senger side when the vehicle is at a standstill. When driving in reverse, only the turning lamps are active and illuminate the outer area of curves.

High beams/ roadside parking lamps

1 High beams

2 Headlamp flasher

3 Roadside parking lamps

Roadside parking lamps, left or right* You also enjoy the option of lighting up just one side of your vehicle when parking:

Switching on After parking the vehicle, press the lever up or down beyond the resistance point, arrow 3.

The roadside parking lamps drain the bat- tery. Do not leave them switched on for

long periods of time, otherwise it may no longer be possible to start the engine.<

Switching off Briefly press the lever in the opposite direction up to the resistance point, arrow 3.

High-beam assistant*

The concept This system automatically switches the high beams on and off. A sensor on the front side of the inside rearview mirror controls the process. The assistant makes sure that the high beams are switched on whenever traffic conditions permit. This relieves you of the burden of con- stantly switching back and forth and simulta- neously provides you with the best possible vis- ibility. Naturally, you can intervene at any time to switch the high beams on and off as usual.

Activating system 1. Turn the light switch to position 3, refer to

page 108.

2. With the low beams switched on, briefly press the turn signal lever in the high-beam direction.

C o

n tr

o ls

111

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

The indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the high-beam assistant is activated. The system

automatically switches between high beams and low beams, reacting to oncoming traffic, vehicles ahead of you, and sufficiently lit areas, e.g. in built-up zones.

Manually switching between high beams and low beams If you wish or the situation requires, you can intervene at any time.

> If the high-beam assistant has switched on the high beams, but you wish to use the low beams, just switch on the low beams with the turn signal lever. This deactivates the high-beam assistant. In order to reactivate the system, briefly press the turn signal lever in the high-beam direction.

> If the high-beam assistant has switched on the low beams, but you wish to use the high beams, simply switch on the high beams as usual. This deactivates the system and it is up to you to switch back to low beams. In order to reactivate the system, briefly press the turn signal lever in the high-beam direction.

> When the low beams are on, use the head- lamp flasher as usual.

System limits The high-beam assistant is designed to maximize the amount of time that high

beams can be safely used and to quickly switch back to low beams when traffic approaches. The system cannot completely replace driver intervention when unusual conditions are encountered. For this reason, switch to low beams when circumstances so dictate. Failure to do so can pose a safety risk.<

Below are a few examples of situations in which the system may not react or may only function to a limited degree, requiring personal interven- tion:

> in extremely unfavorable weather condi- tions such as fog or heavy precipitation

> in sensing road users with poor inherent illumination such as pedestrians, cyclists, equestrians, horsedrawn vehicles, railroad or shipping traffic close to the road, and at deer crossings

> in tight curves, on steep crests or dips, with cross-traffic, or with partially hidden oncoming traffic on divided highways

> in poorly illuminated areas and in the pres- ence of highly reflective signs

> in the low speed range

> when the windshield is fogged up, dirty or covered with stickers, decals etc. in the area of the inside rearview mirror

> when the sensor is dirty. Clean the sensor on the front side of the inside rearview mir- ror with a cloth slightly moistened with glass cleaner

Moreover, no system can operate without limi- tations. High-beam assistant operation is sub- ject to conditions that may reduce the system's ability to recognize the difference between actual vehicle head lamps or tail lamps and, for example, highly reflective signs, markers, and streetlights. To be on the safe side, the system may periodically interpret these situations as conditions that require low beams. Below are some of the situations in which premature switching to low beams can occur:

> approaching large and/or highly reflective signs

> approaching certain lights, such as drive- way lighting and porch lights

> approaching certain traffic signals

> approaching large reflective markers

In these situations, the system may interpret the above conditions as a vehicle ahead requir- ing a switch to low beams. When the conditions return to normal, the system will reactivate the high beams.

The high-beam assistant cannot replace the driver's responsibility for complying with state laws on high-beam switching or for adapting to visibility and traffic conditions.

L am

p s

112

Switching off via iDrive iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Lighting" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "High-beam assistant" and press the controller.

High-beam assistant is switched off.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Fog lamps*

The parking lamps or low beams must be switched on for the fog lamps to operate. The green indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up whenever the fog lamps are on.

The fog lamps are switched off whenever the high beams are switched on.

If the automatic headlamp control is acti- vated, the low beams will come on auto-

matically when you switch on the fog lamps.<

Instrument lighting

You can control the lighting intensity by using the knurled wheel.

Interior lamps Control of the interior lamps, footwell lamps, door entry lighting, courtesy lamps* and the cargo bay lamps* is automatic.

With the courtesy lamps, LED lights are located in the door handles to illuminate the exterior area before the doors.

To protect the battery, all lamps in the vehicle are switched off approx. 15 min-

utes after radio readiness is switched off, refer to Start/Stop button on page 61.<

Switching interior lamps on and off manually

Press the button.

If the interior lamps, footwell lamps, door entry lighting and courtesy lamps are to remain

C o

n tr

o ls

113

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

switched off continually, press the button for approx. 3 seconds.

Reading lamps

Reading lamps are located in the front and rear adjacent to the interior lamps. Press the button to switch the lamps on and off.

C lim

at e

114

Climate

Automatic climate control

1 Air directed toward the windshield and side windows

2 Air for the upper body region, refer to Front ventilation on page 118

3 Air to footwell

4 Temperature, left side of passenger compartment

5 Manual air distribution, driver's side

6 Defrosting windows and removing condensation

7 Manual air volume, switching off automatic climate control, residual heat utilization

8 AUTO program

9 Switching cooling function on and off manually

10 Temperature, right side of passenger compartment

11 Manual air distribution, front passenger side

12 Maximum cooling

13 AUC Automatic recirculated-air control/ recirculated-air mode

14 LED for residual heat utilization and parked- car ventilation system

15 Rear window defroster

C o

n tr

o ls

115

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

16 Air grill for interior temperature sensor please keep clear and unobstructed

The current setting for air distribution is dis- played on the Control Display.

A congenial climate The AUTO program offers the optimum air dis- tribution and air volume for virtually all condi- tions, refer to AUTO program below. Now you only need to select an interior temperature pleasant to you.

The following sections contain more detailed information on the available setting options.

Most settings are stored for the remote control currently in use, also refer to Personal Profile settings on page 29.

AUTO program The AUTO program handles the adjustment of air volume and air distribution to the windshield and side windows, in the direction of the upper body and in the footwell.

It also adapts your instructions for the tempera- ture to outside influences throughout the year.

The cooling is switched on automatically with the AUTO program. At the same time, a con- densation sensor controls the program in such a way that window condensation is prevented as much as possible.

Intensity of AUTO program You can adjust the intensity of the AUTO pro- gram by repeatedly pressing the AUTO button. The respective current setting is briefly dis- played on the Control Display when the button is pressed.

You can also adjust the intensity of the AUTO program via iDrive.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

3. Select "Automatic programs" and press the controller.

4. Select the desired intensity and press the controller.

The marked intensity of the automatic program is switched on.

Temperature Set the desired temperature indi- vidually on the driver's and front passenger side.

The automatic climate control adjusts this temperature as quickly as possible at any time of year, if necessary with the maxi- mum cooling or heating capacity, and then keeps it constant.

When changing between different tem- perature settings in rapid succession, the

automatic climate control does not have suffi- cient time to adjust the set temperature.<

In the highest setting you activate the maximum heating output, regardless of the outside tem- perature.

Adjusting temperature in upper body region

1. Press the button to display the current set- ting on the Control Display.

C lim

at e

116

2. Select the field by moving the controller and turning the controller to adjust the temper- ature.

You can also adjust the temperature in the upper body region with iDrive.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Open "Climate".

3. Select "Vent settings" and press the con- troller.

4. Select the field by moving the controller and turning the controller to adjust the temper- ature.

Defrosting windows and removing condensation

Quickly remove ice and condensa- tion from the windshield and front side windows.

To do this, also switch on the cooling function.

Rear window defroster The rear window defroster switches off automatically after a while. Depending on the vehicle

equipment, upper wires are used as an antenna and are not part of the rear window defroster.

Air volume, manual You can adjust the air volume by turning. You can reactivate the automatic mode for the air volume with the AUTO button.

The air quantity is reduced and if need be, the ventilation is switched off in order to reduce the load on the battery. The display stays the same.

Manual air distribution You can route the air flowing out into the vehicle interior via various programs, separately for the driver's and passenger's side:

> Upper body region

> Upper body region and footwell

> Footwell

> Driver's side: windows and footwell

> Individual program

Selecting program Press the button repeatedly until the desired air distribution of the respective program is shown on the Control Display.

Adjusting air distribution individually individual program Your settings are stored in this program.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Open "Climate".

3. Select "Vent settings" and press the con- troller. The driver's and front passenger side can be adjusted separately with the fields on the right or left side.

4. Select the driver's or front passenger side if necessary. Move the controller to the right or left repeatedly until the driver's or front passen- ger side is selected.

5. Select the desired field by moving the con- troller.

C o

n tr

o ls

117

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

6. Turn the controller to adjust the air distribu- tion.

Driver's side:

1 Air directed toward the windshield and side windows

2 Air for the upper body

3 Air to footwell

Front passenger side:

4 Air for the upper body

5 Air to footwell

Pressing the AUTO button cancels the manual air distribution settings.<

The automatic mode for the air volume remains effective with manual air distribution.

Switching cooling function on and off The cooling function cools and dehumidifies the incoming air before also reheating it as

required, according to the temperature setting. This function is only available when the engine is running.

The cooling function helps to avoid condensa- tion on the window surfaces or to quickly remove them.

Depending on the weather, the windshield may fog over briefly when the engine is started.

The cooling function is switched on automati- cally with the AUTO program.

Maximum cooling Maximally cooled air is obtained as quickly as possible at an outside temperature above approx. 327/

06 and with the engine running.

At the lowest temperature, the automatic cli- mate control switches into recirculating air mode. The maximum air volume flows out of the vents for the upper body. Therefore, open these vents for maximum cooling.

AUC Automatic recirculated-air control/recirculated-air mode

You can respond to pollutants or unpleasant odors in the immediate environment by suspending the

supply of outside air. The system then recircu- lates the air currently within the vehicle. During AUC operation, a sensor detects pollutants in the outside air and controls the shut-off auto- matically.

By pressing the button repeatedly, you can request three operating modes:

> LED off: outside air flows in continuously.

> Right LED on, AUC mode: the system detects pollutants in the outside air and shuts off the supply as needed.

> Left LED on, recirculated-air mode: the supply of outside air is permanently shut off.

Should the windows fog up in the recircu- lated-air mode, press the AUTO button or

switch off the recirculated-air mode and increase the air volume if necessary. The recirculated-air mode should not be used over an extended period of time, as the air qual- ity inside the vehicle deteriorates continu- ously.<

Residual heat The heat stored in the engine is used to heat the passenger com- partment, e.g. while stopped at a school to pick up a child.

1. Switch off the engine.

2. Turn to the right, refer to arrow.

The function can be switched on when the fol- lowing conditions are met:

> up to 15 minutes after switching off the engine

> with engine at operating temperature

C lim

at e

118

> with sufficient battery voltage

> at an outside temperature below 777/ 256

From radio readiness the interior temperature, the air volume and the air distribution can be set.

Switching automatic climate control on and off

1. Turn to the left to minimum air volume.

2. After approx. 1 second, turn to the left again.

You switch on the system again by pressing any button of the automatic climate control.

Front ventilation

1 Knurled wheels to smoothly open and close vent outlets

2 Levers to change the vent outlet direction

Do not drop any foreign objects into the vent outlets, otherwise these could be

catapulted outwards and lead to injuries.<

Ventilation for cooling Adjust the vent outlets to direct the flow of cool air in your direction, for instance, if the interior has become too warm, etc.

Draft-free ventilation Set the vent outlets so that the air flows past you and is not directed straight at you.

Rear ventilation

1 Knurled wheel to smoothly open and close vent outlets

2 Knurled wheel to adjust the temperature:

> Turn toward blue: colder

> Turn toward red: warmer

3 Levers to change the vent outlet direction

Microfilter/activated-charcoal filter The microfilter removes dust and pollen from the incoming air. The activated-charcoal filter provides additional protection by filtering gas- eous pollutants from the outside air. Your BMW center replaces this combined filter as a stan- dard part of your scheduled maintenance.

Parked car ventilation

The concept The parked car ventilation blows air into the passenger compartment to lower interior tem- peratures.

It is ready to use in the parked car mode at any outside temperature.

You can set two different times for the system to start. The parked car ventilation can also be switched on and off directly. It remains switched on for 30 minutes.

Since the system uses a substantial amount of electrical current, you should refrain from acti- vating it twice in succession without allowing the battery to be recharged in normal operation between use.

C o

n tr

o ls

119

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

The air emerges through the upper body region vent outlets in the instrument panel. These vent outlets must be open for the system to operate.

The parked car ventilation is operated via iDrive.

Switching on and off directly iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

3. Select "Parked car operation" and press the controller.

4. Select "Automatic ventilation" and press the controller.

5. Select "Parked car ventilation" and press the controller.

The parked-car ventilation is switched on.

The symbol on the display of the automatic climate control flashes.

Preselecting activation times 1. Open the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the left to open "Cli- mate".

3. Select "Parked car operation" and press the controller.

4. Select "Activation time" and press the con- troller.

5. Move the controller to the left or right to select "Timer 1" or "Timer 2".

6. Select the time and press the controller. The first time setting is selected.

7. Turn the controller to make the adjustment.

8. Press the controller to apply the setting. The next setting is selected.

9. Make the remaining adjustments. After the last adjustment, the time is stored.

Activating activation time Move the controller to the left or right to select "Timer 1" or "Timer 2" and press the controller.

The activation time is activated.

The symbol on the display of the automatic climate control lights up.

C lim

at e

120

The symbol on the display of the automatic climate control flashes when the parked car ventilation has switched on.

The parked car ventilation is only avail- able for activation within the next

24 hours. Please reactivated it after this time.<

C o

n tr

o ls

121

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Practical interior accessories

Integrated universal remote control*

The concept The integrated universal remote control can replace as many as three hand-held transmit- ters for various remote-controlled accessories, such as garage and gate or lighting systems. The integrated universal remote control regis- ters and stores signals from the original hand- held transmitters.

The signal of an original hand-held transmitter can be programmed on one of the three mem- ory buttons 1. After this, the programmed memory button 1 will operate the system in question. The LED 2 flashes to confirm trans- mission of the signal.

Should you sell your vehicle one day, be sure to delete the stored programs beforehand for your safety, refer to page 122.

To prevent possible damage or injury, before programming or using the inte-

grated universal remote control, always inspect the immediate area to make certain that no peo- ple, animals or objects are within the travel range of the device. Also, comply with the safety precautions of the original hand-held transmitter.<

Checking compatibility If you see this symbol on the packaging or in the manual supplied with the orig- inal hand-held transmitter, it is safe to

assume that it is compatible with the integrated universal remote control.

If you have additional questions, please contact your BMW center or call:

1-800-355-3515. Information is also provided on the Internet at: www.bmwusa.com or www.homelink.com. HomeLink is a registered trademark of Johnson Controls, Inc.<

Programming

1 Memory buttons

2 LED

Fixed-code hand-held transmitters 1. Switch on ignition, refer to page 61.

2. When starting operation for the first time: Press the left and right-hand memory button 1 for approx. 20 seconds until the LED 2 flashes quickly. All stored programs are deleted.

3. Hold the original hand-held transmitter at a distance of approx. 4 in/10 cm to 12 in/ 30 cm from the memory buttons 1.

The required distance between the hand-held transmitter and the mem-

ory buttons 1 depends on the relevant sys- tem of the original hand-held transmitter used.<

4. Simultaneously press the transmit button on the original hand-held transmitter and the desired memory button 1 on the inte- grated universal remote control. The LED 2 flashes slowly at first. As soon as the LED 2 flashes rapidly, release both buttons. If the LED 2 does not flash rapidly after approx. 15 seconds, alter the distance and repeat the step.

5. To program other original hand-held trans- mitters, repeat steps 3 and 4.

The corresponding memory button 1 is now programmed with the signal of the original hand-held transmitter.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

122

You can operate the device when the engine is running or when the ignition is switched on.

If the device fails to function even after repeated programming, check whether

the original hand-held transmitter uses an alter- nating-code system. To do so, either read the instructions for the original hand-held transmit- ter or hold down the programmed memory button 1 of the integrated universal remote control. If the LED 2 on the integrated universal remote control flashes rapidly for a short time and then remains lit for approx. 2 seconds, this indicates that the original hand-held transmitter uses an alternating-code system. In the case of an alternating-code system, program the mem- ory buttons 1 as described at Alternating-code hand-held transmitters.<

Alternating-code hand-held transmitters To program the integrated universal remote control, consult the operating instructions for the equipment to be set. You will find informa- tion there on the possibilities for synchroniza- tion. When programming hand-held transmitters that employ an alternating code, please observe the following supplementary instructions:

Programming will be easier with the aid of a second person.<

1. Park your vehicle within the range of the remote-controlled device.

2. Program the integrated universal remote control as described above in the section Fixed-code hand-held transmitters.

3. Locate the button on the receiver of the device to be set, e.g. on the drive unit.

4. Press the button on the receiver of the device to be set. After step 4, you have approx. 30 seconds for step 5.

5. Press the programmed memory button 1 of the integrated universal remote control three times.

The corresponding memory button 1 is now programmed with the signal of the original hand-held transmitter.

If you have any additional questions, please contact your BMW center.<

Deleting all stored programs Press the left and right-hand memory button 1 for approx. 20 seconds until the LED 2 flashes quickly: All stored programs are deleted.

Individual programs cannot be deleted.

Rememorizing individual programs 1. Hold the original handheld remote control

approx. 10 to 30 cm away from the memory buttons 1.

The required distance between the hand-held transmitter and the mem-

ory buttons 1 depends on the relevant sys- tem of the original hand-held transmitter used.<

2. Press the desired memory button 1 of the integrated universal remote.

3. If the LED 2 flashes slowly after approx. 20 seconds, press the command button of the original hand-held transmitter. As soon as the LED 2 flashes rapidly, release both buttons. If the LED 2 does not flash rapidly after approx. 15 seconds, alter the distance and repeat the step.

Sun blinds*

Sun blind for rear window

Press the button on the driver's door.

C o

n tr

o ls

123

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Sun blinds for rear side windows Pull the loop of the roller sun blind and hook onto bracket.

Do not open the window with the roller sun blind deployed. Otherwise, there is a

risk of damage and injury at higher speeds.<

Glove compartment

Opening

Pull the handle. The light in the glove compart- ment switches on.

To prevent injury in the event of an acci- dent while the vehicle is being driven,

close the glove compartment immediately after use.<

Closing Raise the lid into the closed position.

Locking Lock with a key.

If you only hand over the remote control without the integrated key, e.g. for valet

parking, refer to page 28, the glove compart- ment cannot be unlocked.<

Rechargeable flashlight

The flashlight is located on the left side of the glove compartment. The flashlight can remain plugged in continu- ously. Pull the flashlight out of the socket when needed.

To avoid possibly damaging the lamp, always ensure that it is switched off

before inserting it in the socket.<

Center armrest, front The compartment in the center armrest is divided into two sections.

Opening cover

Press the button. The cover opens somewhat and can be folded upwards.

Depending on vehicle equipment, the upper section contains a compartment with a mat that can be removed for cleaning or a telephone cradle*.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

124

Opening upper compartment

Press button and fold cover upward.

Accessing lower compartment

Press the button at the front and fold the upper compartment or the telephone cradle upward.

Ventilating lower compartment* Push the slide in the lower compartment upward.

Depending on the automatic climate con- trol setting, the temperature inside the

ventilated compartment may be higher than in the rest of the interior. Should this be the case, push the slide downward to close off the venti- lation.<

Adjusting

Push the illustrated section of the center arm- rest into the desired position.

Connection for external audio device You can connect an external audio device such as a CD or MP3 player and play audio tracks over the vehicle's loudspeaker system:

> AUX-In connection, refer to page 188.

> USB/audio interface*, refer to page 189.

Storage compartments Storage compartments are located on the doors, in the front center console and in the rear. Storage nets are located on the backrests of the front seats, and a net* is provided in the front passenger footwell.

Do not stow hard or sharp-edged objects in the storage nets or the net, otherwise

there is an increased risk of injury in an acci- dent.<

Clothes hooks Clothes hooks are located near the grab han- dles in the rear.

When hanging clothing on the hooks, ensure that it will not obstruct the driver's

vision. Do not hang heavy objects on the hooks. If you do so, they could cause personal injury to occupants during braking or evasive maneu- vers.<

C o

n tr

o ls

125

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Cup holders Use lightweight, unbreakable containers and do not transport hot beverages. Oth-

erwise, there is an increased risk of injury in the event of an accident. Do not force containers that are too large into the cup holders, other- wise damage could result.<

Opening

Briefly press the button.

Closing Press the cover in the center and push in the cup holder.

Ashtray, front

Opening

Briefly press the center of the cover.

Emptying

Press the button, refer to arrow. The ashtray rises and can be removed.

Cigarette lighter, front

Press in the lighter with the engine running or the ignition switched on.

The lighter can be removed as soon as it pops back out.

Hold or touch the hot cigarette lighter by the knob only. Holding or touching it in

other areas could result in burns. Always take along the remote control when you leave the vehicle, otherwise children could, for example, use the lighter and burn themselves.<

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

126

Ashtray, rear

Emptying Press the entire cover down. The ashtray rises and can be removed.

Cigarette lighter, rear

Refer to Cigarette lighter, front.

Connecting electrical devices

Sockets With the engine running or the ignition switched on, the cigarette lighter socket can be used as a power outlet for hand flashlights, car vacuum cleaners, etc., with power ratings of up to approx. 200 W at 12 V. Avoid damaging the socket due to inserting plugs of different shapes or sizes. The same is true for all power outlets in the vehicle.

In front passenger footwell

Access to socket: Fold open the cover.

Sedan: In cargo bay

Access to socket: Fold open the cover.

Sports Wagon: In cargo bay

Access to socket: Fold open the cover.

C o

n tr

o ls

127

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

In the rear center console

Depending on the equipment, the sockets in the rear are covered with caps or equipped with a lighter. Refer to Cigarette lighter, front, page 125.

Access to socket: Remove respective cap or lighter.

Center armrest, rear

Storage tray: Pull the cover upward, arrow 1.

Access to cup holders: Press button 2 and open the cover.

Sedan: Through-loading system*

Opening 1. Open the buckle of the center safety belt in

the rear and insert the latch plate at the end of the belt into the fixture on the rear win- dow shelf.

2. Push the corresponding head restraint down as far as it will go, refer to page 50.

3. To release the rear backrest, pull the corre- sponding lever in the cargo bay.

4. The unlocked rear backrest moves forward slightly. Fold the backrest forward by the head restraint.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

128

Closing 1. Fold the rear backrest into the seating posi-

tion and engage.

When you return the seat to its upright position, make sure that the catch

engages properly. If it is not properly engaged, transported cargo could enter the vehicle dur- ing braking or evasive maneuvers and endanger the vehicle occupants.<

2. Release the latch plate from the bracket on the rear window shelf and insert it into the buckle of the center safety belt. Make sure the latch plate audibly engages.

The lashing eyes in the cargo bay provide you with a way to attach cargo-bay nets* or luggage straps for securing suitcases and luggage, refer to page 138.

Sports Wagon: cargo bay

Roll-up cover

Pull out the roll-up cover and hook it into the brackets.

Do not place heavy or hard objects on the roll-up cover. If you do so, they may pose

a danger to vehicle occupants during braking or evasive maneuvers. Do not allow the roll-up cover to snap back, oth- erwise it can be damaged.<

Manual roll-up cover When opening the tailgate or rear window, the roll-up cover is raised. Before closing the tail- gate and rear window, press down the roll-up cover until it engages.

Automatic roll-up cover* When the tailgate or rear window are opened, the roll-up cover is raised, and when the tailgate and rear window are closed, it is lowered.

Make sure that the closing area of the roll- up cover is clear of obstructions, other-

wise the payload or the roll-up cover may be damaged.<

Expanding cargo bay The rear backrest is divided. You can fold down both sides separately in order to expand the cargo bay.

Reach into the recess and pull toward the front.

When you fold back the backrest, be sure that the catch engages securely. The red

warning indicator disappears in the recess when the catch is engaged. If it is not properly engaged, transported cargo could enter the passenger compartment during braking or eva- sive maneuvers and endanger the vehicle occu- pants.<

To ensure that the safety systems con- tinue to provide optimized protection,

please observe the safety belt information on page 45.<

C o

n tr

o ls

129

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Partition net

Do not allow the partition net to snap back, otherwise there is a risk of injury

and the partition net may be damaged.<

With normal cargo bay Pull the partition net out of the case by the loop. Grasp the rod on both sides and insert it in the brackets, arrow 1. This is best carried out from the rear seat.

When you no longer require the partition net, grasp the rod on both sides and remove it from the brackets, arrow 2. Then slowly allow the partition net to glide into the case.

With an expanded cargo bay 1. Fold down both rear backrests, refer to

Expanding cargo bay.

2. Unlock the case on both sides with the but- tons, arrow 1.

3. Pull out the case downward, arrow 2; avoid tilting when doing so.

4. Push the case into the guides on the backs of the backrests.

5. Carefully pull out the partition net and insert it in the front brackets as described in With normal cargo bay. This is best carried out from the front seat.

To restore the original state, proceed in the reverse order. Finally, lay the case in the two side brackets and then press forward until it engages. The red warning indicator disappears in the recess when the catch is engaged. Check whether the case is properly locked in place by pulling it with a sudden movement.

Compartment in floor Automatic roll-up cover: the opened floor panel strikes against the roll-up cover in the end posi- tion. If necessary, unhook the roll-up cover at the rear before opening the floor panel.

To open, reach into the recess and swing up the handle.

The floor panel flap can be locked.

The partitions in the compartment can be rear- ranged.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

130

Folding up spare tire cover 1. Swing up the cover.

2. Detach the hook from the bracket and hook into the floor panel flap.

Before swinging down, return the hook to its original position.

Storage area package*

Retaining straps You can unhook the right-hand retaining strap, e.g. to open the side panel. To unhook at the rear end, pull downward; to hook in, press it into the opening. In addition, it can also be secured in the center. This makes it possible to secure objects of different sizes.

Hooks Two hooks can be used to secure smaller objects.

Press at bottom and fold out until they lock.

Compartments in floor

Front compartment: To open the flap, pull upward on the handle. To close the flap, press downward until it locks.

Rear compartment: To open, reach into the recess and swing up the handle. The rear flap can be locked.

Dividing up rear compartment

Fold out the partitions and press down.

Use the partition net, refer to page 129. Otherwise objects could be thrown

around and endanger occupants, e.g. during braking or evasive maneuvers.<

C o

n tr

o ls

131

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Ski bag* The ski bag is designed for safe, clean transport of up to 4 pairs of standard skis or up to 2 snow- boards.

With the ski bag you can stow skis with a length of up to 6.9 ft/2.10 m. When skis of 6.9 ft/2.10 m in length are loaded, the ski bag will tend to con- tract, reducing its overall capacity.

Loading 1. Fold down the center armrest, press the

button and open the cover.

2. Press the button again; the cover in the cargo bay opens. If you press the button firmly the first time, this also opens the cover in the cargo bay.

3. Extend the ski bag between the front seats and fill it. The zipper facilitates access to the stowed items and drying of the ski bag.

4. Insert the latch plate of the ski bag retaining strap into the center safety belt buckle that is marked CENTER.

Only stow clean skis in the ski bag. Wrap sharp edges to prevent damage.

Securing cargo

After loading, secure the ski bag and its con- tents. Tighten the retaining strap on the ten- sioning buckle for this purpose.

Secure the ski bag in this way. If you fail to do so, it could endanger vehicle occu-

pants during braking or evasive maneuvers.<

To store the ski bag, perform the above steps in reverse order.

Removing ski bag The ski bag can be completely removed, e.g. for faster drying or to allow you to put it to other uses.

1. Pull the handle forward and pull the ski bag up and out.

2. Close the cover in the cargo bay.

Your BMW center will be glad to provide you with more detailed information on the

various items of equipment.<

Driving tips This section is designed to provide you

with extra support by supplying information useful in dealing with specific driving

and operating conditions.

T h

in g

s to

re m

em b

er w

h en

d ri

vi n

g

134

Things to remember when driving

Break-in period Moving parts need breaking-in time to adjust to each other. To ensure that your vehicle contin- ues to provide optimized economy of operation throughout an extended service life, we request that you devote careful attention to the follow- ing section.

Engine and differential Always obey all official speed limits.

Up to 1,200 miles/2,000 km Drive at changing engine and driving speeds, however do not exceed 4,500 rpm or 100 mph/ 160 km/h.

Avoid full-throttle operation and use of the transmission's kick-down mode during these initial miles.

From 1,200 miles/2,000 km The engine and vehicle speed can gradually be increased.

Tires Due to technical factors associated with their manufacture, tires do not achieve their full trac- tion potential until after an initial break-in period. Therefore, drive reservedly during the first 200 miles/300 km.

Brake system Brakes require an initial break-in period of approx. 300 miles/500 km to achieve optimized contact and wear patterns between brake pads and rotors. Drive in a reserved manner during this break-in period.

Clutch The function of the clutch is only at its opti- mized level after a distance driven of approx. 300 miles/500 km. During this break-in period, engage the clutch gently.

Following part replacement Observe the break-in instructions again if com- ponents mentioned above must be replaced after subsequent driving operation.

Saving fuel The fuel consumption of your vehicle depends on various factors. Through a few simple steps, your driving style, and regular maintenance, you can have a positive influence on your fuel con- sumption and environmental impact.

Removing unnecessary cargo Additional weight increases fuel consumption.

Removing add-on parts after use Remove unneeded auxiliary mirrors, roof or rear luggage racks after use. Add-on parts attached to the vehicle impede the aerodynamics and increase the fuel consumption.

Closing windows and glass sunroof An open glass sunroof or open windows like- wise increase the drag coefficient and therefore the fuel consumption.

Checking tire inflation pressures regularly Check and correct the tire inflation pressure as needed at least twice a month and before long trips.

An insufficient tire inflation pressure increases the rolling resistance and thus increases the fuel consumption and tire wear.

Driving off immediately Do not allow the engine to warm up by leaving it running while the vehicle remains stationary. Instead, begin to drive at a moderate engine speed. This is the fastest way for the cold engine to reach its operating temperature.

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

135

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Thinking ahead when driving Avoid unnecessary acceleration and braking. To do so, maintain the appropriate distance from the vehicle in front of you. An anticipatory and smooth driving style reduces fuel con- sumption.

Avoiding high engine speeds Use 1st gear only for starting off. Accelerate rapidly in 2nd gear and above. Avoid high engine speeds in doing so and shift into the next gear early.

When you have reached the desired speed, shift into the highest possible gear and drive with the lowest possible engine speed while maintaining a constant a vehicle speed.

In general: driving at a low engine speed reduces fuel consumption and minimizes wear.

Taking advantage of coasting When approaching a red light, let off the gas and allow the vehicle to coast to a stop in the highest possible gear.

On steep roadways, let off the gas and allow the vehicle to roll in the appropriate gear.

The flow of fuel is interrupted when coasting.

Switching off engine during longer stops Switch off the engine at longer stops such as traffic signals, railroad crossings, or in traffic jams. Even having the engine switched off for approx. 4 seconds results in fuel savings.

Switching off functions currently not required Functions such as air conditioning, seat heat- ing, or rear window defrosting consume a lot of energy and require additional fuel. Their influ- ence is particularly pronounced in city traffic and stop & go operation. For this reason, it is a good idea to switch these functions off when they are not really needed.

Having maintenance carried out Have the vehicle serviced regularly in order to achieve the optimum economy and service life of your vehicle. BMW recommends having the maintenance performed by a BMW center. Also please pay attention to the BMW maintenance system, refer to page 235.

General driving notes

Closing luggage compartment lid/ tailgate

Operate the vehicle only when the lug- gage compartment lid/tailgate is com-

pletely closed. Otherwise, exhaust fumes could enter the interior of the vehicle.<

If it is absolutely necessary to drive with the lug- gage compartment lid open:

1. Close all windows and the glass sunroof or panorama glass sunroof.

2. Increase the air volume of the automatic cli- mate control to a high level, refer to page 116.

Hot exhaust system As in all vehicles, extremely high temper- atures are generated on the exhaust sys-

tem. Do not remove the heat shields installed adjacent to it, and never apply undercoating to them. When driving, standing at idle and while parking take care to avoid possible contact between the hot exhaust system and any highly flammable materials such as hay, leaves, grass, etc. Such contact could lead to a fire, and with it the risk of serious property damage as well as personal injury. Do not touch hot exhaust tail pipes. Otherwise there is a risk of burns.<

Hydroplaning When driving on wet or slushy roads, reduce road speed. If you do not, a wedge

of water can form between tires and road sur- face. This phenomenon is referred to as hydro- planing, and is characterized by a partial or complete loss of contact between the tires and

T h

in g

s to

re m

em b

er w

h en

d ri

vi n

g

136

the road surface, ultimately undermining your ability to steer and brake the vehicle.<

The risk of hydroplaning increases as the tread depth of the tires decreases, refer also to Mini- mum tire tread on page 227.

Driving through water Do not drive through water on the road if it is deeper than 1 ft/30 cm, and then only at

walking speed at the most. Otherwise, the vehi- cle's engine, the electrical systems and the transmission may be damaged.<

Using handbrake on inclines On inclines, do not hold the vehicle in place for a long time by riding the clutch;

use the handbrake. Otherwise greater clutch wear will result.<

Braking safely Your BMW is equipped with ABS as a standard feature. In situations that require it, it is best to brake with full force. Since the vehicle maintains steering responsiveness, you can still avoid possible obstacles with a minimum of steering effort.

Pulsation of the brake pedal, combined with sounds from the hydraulic circuits, indicate that ABS is in its active mode.

Do not drive with your foot resting on the brake pedal. Even light but consistent

pedal pressure can lead to high temperatures, brake wear and possibly even brake failure.<

Driving in wet conditions When roads are wet or there is heavy rain, briefly exert gentle pressure on the brake pedal every few miles. Monitor traffic conditions to ensure that this maneuver does not endanger other road users. The heat generated in this process helps dry the pads and rotors to ensure that full braking efficiency will then be available when you need it.

Hills To prevent overheating and the resulting reduced efficiency of the brake system,

drive long or steep downhill gradients in the gear in which the least braking is required. Even light but consistent pressure on the brake pedal can lead to high temperatures, brake wear and possibly even brake failure.<

The braking effect of the engine can be further increased by downshifting, if necessary all the way down into first gear. This strategy helps you avoid placing excessive loads on the brake system. For information on downshifting in the manual mode of the automatic transmission, refer to page 64.

Do not drive with the clutch depressed, in idle or with the engine switched off, other-

wise there will be no engine braking action or support of the braking force and steering. Never allow floor mats, carpets or any other objects to protrude into the area of movement of the pedals and impair their operation.<

Corrosion on brake rotors When the vehicle is driven only occasionally, during extended periods when the vehicle is not used at all, and in operating conditions where brake applications are less frequent, there is an increased tendency for corrosion to form on rotors, while contaminants accumulate on the brake pads. This occurs because the minimum pressure which must be exerted by the pads during brake applications to clean the rotors is not reached.

Should corrosion form on the brake rotors, the brakes will tend to respond with a pulsating effect that even extended application will fail to cure.

When vehicle is parked Condensation forms in the air conditioner sys- tem during operation, and then exits under the vehicle. Traces of condensed water under the vehicle are therefore normal.

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

137

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Before driving into a car wash Fold in the exterior mirrors, refer to page 53, otherwise they could be damaged due to the width of the vehicle.

General information on the care and mainte- nance of your BMW is contained in the Caring for your vehicle brochure.

528xi, 535xi Avoid car washes with guide rail heights over 4 in/10 cm, otherwise there is danger

of damaging chassis components.<

Rear window wiper* The rear window wiper can be damaged in car washes. Take appropriate protective measures; ask the car wash operator if necessary.

Automatic and sport automatic transmission Follow the instructions on page 62 so that the vehicle can roll.

Cargo loading To avoid loading the tires beyond their approved carrying capacity, never over-

load the vehicle. Overloading can lead to over- heating and increases the rate at which damage develops inside the tires. The ultimate result can assume the form of a sudden blow-out.<

Make sure that no fluids leak in the cargo bay; otherwise the vehicle could be dam-

aged.<

Determining loading limit

1. Locate the following statement on your vehicle's placard*:

The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed

XXX lbs. or YYY kg, as otherwise the vehicle may be damaged and unstable driving con- ditions may result.<

2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.

3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX lbs. or YYY kg.

4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the XXX amount equals 1,400 lbs. and there will be five 150-lb. pas- sengers in your vehicle, the amount of avail- able cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs.: 1,400 lbs. minus 750 lbs. = 650 lbs.

5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4.

6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, part of the load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult the manual for transporting a trailer to determine how this may reduce the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.

T h

in g

s to

re m

em b

er w

h en

d ri

vi n

g

138

Load

The permissible load is the total of the weight of occupants and cargo/luggage. The greater the weight of occupants, the less cargo/luggage can be transported.

Stowing cargo

> Load heavy cargo as far forward and as low as possible, placing it directly behind the rear backrest.

> Cover sharp edges and corners.

> For very heavy cargo when the rear seat is not occupied, secure each safety belt in the opposite buckle.

> Do not pile objects higher than the top edge of the backrest.

> Sports Wagon: Use the partition net to protect the occu-

pants, refer to page 129. Make sure that objects cannot penetrate through the parti- tion net. Wrap sharp-edged or pointed objects which could strike the rear window while driving.

Securing cargo

> Use the luggage net*, luggage straps, or securing straps to hold down small and lightweight luggage and cargo.

> Heavy-duty cargo straps* for securing larger and heavier objects are available at your BMW center. Four lashing eyes mounted in the cargo bay are used to secure these heavy-duty cargo straps, refer to illustration.

> Please observe the special instructions supplied with the heavy-duty cargo straps.

Position and secure the cargo as described above, so that it cannot endan-

ger the vehicle's occupants, for example if sud- den braking or evasive maneuvers are neces- sary. Use only the lashing eyes to secure heavy-duty cargo straps, refer to illustration, otherwise the cargo straps could become detached or the vehicle could be damaged. Never exceed either the approved gross vehicle weight or either of the approved axle loads, refer to page 257, as excessive loads can pose a safety hazard, and may also place you in viola- tion of traffic safety laws. You should never transport unsecured heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment, as they could fly around and pose a safety hazard to the vehicle's occupants during abrupt brak- ing or evasive maneuvers.<

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

139

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Roof-mounted luggage rack* A special rack system is available as an option for your BMW. Please comply with the precau- tions included with the installation instructions.

Mounting points

The mounting points are located in the door openings or on the roof rails*.

Loading roof-mounted luggage rack Because roof racks raise the vehicle's center of gravity when loaded, they have a major effect on its handling and steering response. You should therefore always remember not to exceed the approved roof load capacity, the approved gross vehicle weight or the axle loads when loading the rack.

You can find the specified weights under Weights on page 257.

Distribute the roof load uniformly. The load must not be too large in area. Always stow the heaviest pieces on the bottom. Be sure that adequate clearance is maintained for raising the glass sunroof, and that objects do not project into the opening path of the luggage compart- ment lid/tailgate.

Secure roof-mounted cargo correctly and securely to prevent it from shifting or falling off during the trip.

Drive smoothly. Avoid sudden acceleration and braking maneuvers. Take corners gently.

Navigation This chapter describes how you can

enter destinations and specify your route so that your navigation system guides you

reliably to your destination.

S ta

rt in

g n

av ig

at io

n sy

st em

142

Starting navigation system

Your navigation system can use satellites to ascertain the precise position of your vehicle and guide you reliably to any destination you enter.

Navigation DVD The navigation system requires a special navi- gation DVD. The latest version is available at your BMW center.

Inserting navigation DVD

1. Insert the navigation DVD with the labeled side up. The navigation DVD is automati- cally pulled in.

2. Allow several seconds for the system to scan the data from the DVD.

Removing navigation DVD 1. Press button 1.

The DVD emerges slightly from the drive.

2. Remove the DVD.

If the DVD is not ejected from the drive, it is pos- sible that it is blocked. In this case a message is also shown on the Control Display.

Display in assistance window You can display the route or the current position in the assistance window. This display remains visible even if you change to another applica- tion.

1. Move the controller to the right to enter the assistance window.

2. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

3. Select the desired route view or "Current position".

4. Press the controller.

Displaying arrow view in map view* If the navigation system suggests a change of direction, the arrow view is briefly displayed.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

*

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

143

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

4. Turn the controller until "Language / Units" is selected and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Languages" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Arrow display pop-up instructions" and press the controller.

The arrow view appears in the assistance window.

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

144

Destination entry

In entering your destination you can select from among the following options:

> Entering a destination manually, see below

> Entering destination via voice*, refer to page 147

> Selecting destination using information, refer to page 149

> Selecting destination from a list, refer to Destination list, page 150

> Selecting destination from address book, refer to page 151

> Selecting home address, refer to page 153

After selecting your destination you can pro- ceed to start the destination guidance, refer to page 156.

You can also store a navigation destination on the programmable memory/direct selection buttons, refer to page 21.

Enter data only when the vehicle is sta- tionary, and always give priority to the

applicable traffic regulations in the event of any contradiction between traffic and road condi- tions and the instructions issued by the naviga- tion system. If you do not observe this precau- tion, you can endanger the vehicle occupants and other road users.<

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the right to open "Navigation".

3. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler.

The Control Display shows:

> the arrow view or map view during destina- tion guidance

> the destination list when destination guid- ance is switched off

Entering a destination manually The system's word matching principle makes it easier for you to enter the names of streets or towns, refer to page 155. This allows you to enter different spellings and completes your entry automatically so that stored names can be called up quickly.

1. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Navigation" is selected and press the controller. "New destination" is selected.

2. Press the controller.

3. Select "Enter address" and press the con- troller.

The system also supports you with the follow- ing features:

> If you do not enter a street, the system will guide you to the downtown area of a town/ city.

> You can skip the entry of country and local- ity if the current entries should be retained for your new destination.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

145

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Selecting country 1. Select "State / Province" or the displayed

country and press the controller.

The list of available countries appears on the display.

2. Select the country of destination and press the controller.

In order to be able to start the destination guid- ance, at least the town/city of the destination or its zip code must be entered.

Entering destination via town/city name 1. Select "Town / City" or the displayed town/

city and press the controller.

2. Select the starting letter and press control- ler. A list of all towns/cities starting with this let- ter appears on the Control Display.

3. To delete the letter entered if necessary:

> Delete individual numbers or letters: Move the controller toward the right to select and press the controller.

> Delete all numbers or letters: Move the controller toward the right to select and press and hold the con- troller.

4. If necessary, enter more letters. The list gradually grows smaller each time you enter a new letter.

> Enter blank space if necessary: Select the symbol and press the con- troller.

5. Change to the third field from the top if nec- essary. Turn the controller until the town/ city name is selected from the list and press the controller.

Entering destination by zip code 1. Select "Town / City" and press the control-

ler.

2. Enter the zip code: Select the desired digits and press the con- troller.

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

146

> Enter a blank space: Select the symbol and press the con- troller.

> Delete individual numbers or letters: Move the controller toward the right to select and press the controller.

> Delete all numbers or letters: Move the controller toward the right to select and press and hold the con- troller.

3. Select the zip code and press the controller. The corresponding destination is displayed.

4. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until the destination is selected and press the controller.

Entering street, house number and intersection After the street you can also enter the intersec- tion or the house number.

Entering street and intersection 1. Select "Street" or the displayed street and

press the controller.

2. Enter the street. The street is entered exactly like the desti- nation.

The intersection is entered in the same way as the street.

Entering a street without entering destination You can also enter a street without entering a destination. In this case all streets of the entered country are offered for selection.

The related town/city is displayed after the street name.

If a town/city has already been entered, you can undo this entry. This may be practical if the desired street does not exist in the entered des- tination, because, for example, it belongs to another part of the town/city.

1. Change to upper field. The arrow is selected.

2. Turn the controller to the right until the request for the entry of a street in the coun- try appears and press the controller.

3. Change to the second field from the top and enter the street.

Entering house number All house numbers stored for the street on the navigation DVD can be entered.

1. Select "House number" and press the con- troller.

2. Enter the house number: Select the desired digits and press the con- troller.

3. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until the house number is selected and press the controller.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

147

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Starting destination guidance with manual destination entry

> Select "Start guidance" and press the con- troller. Destination guidance starts immediately.

> If the destination guidance does not need to be started immediately: Select "Add to destination list" and press the controller. The destination is stored in the destination list, refer to page 150.

Entering destination via voice* You can enter a desired destination via the voice command system. When entering the destination, it is possible to change between voice command and iDrive at any time. Reacti- vate the voice command function for this pur- pose if necessary.

With {Options} you can have the possible commands read aloud.<

1. Press the button on the steering wheel.

Selecting country 1. Wait for the system to ask for the country of

destination.

Say the name of the country of destination in the language of the voice command system.

Entering destination The destination can be spelled or entered as an entire word.

Spelling destination To enter the destination, spell it using the orthography of the country of destination. Pronounce the letters smoothly and at normal volume, avoiding excessive emphasis and pauses.

The system can suggest up to 20 destina- tions that match your entries. Up to 6 entries are displayed at once on the Con- trol Display.

2. {Enter address}

2. Say the name of the country of destina- tion.

1. Spell town/city name: Say at least the first three letters of the destination. The more letters you say, the more exactly the system recognizes the town/city.

A destination is suggested by the system.

2. Select town/city:

> Select highlighted town/city: {Yes}

> Select other town/city: {No}

> Select entry, e.g. {Entry 3}

> To show other entries in the list: {Next page}

> To respell the town/city: {Repeat}

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

148

The town/city can also be selected from the list via iDrive: Turn the controller until the destination is selected and press the controller.

Entering the destination as an entire word* Towns/cities and streets located in the region where the language of the voice command sys- tem is spoken can be entered as an entire word.

Example: to enter a US destination as an entire word, the system language must be English.

Speak smoothly and at normal volume, avoiding excessive emphasis and pauses.

1. Wait for the system to request the destina- tion.

The system can suggest up to 6 destina- tions that match your entries.

The town/city can also be selected from the list via iDrive: Turn the controller until the destination is selected and press the controller.

Destinations that sound the same which cannot be differentiated by the system

are summarized in a separate list and shown as a destination followed by three dots.

Select this entry with {Yes} if necessary. Then select the desired town/city from this list.<

Entering street and house number The street is entered in the same way as the destination.

To enter the house number:

Up to 4-digit house numbers can be entered. Say the house number as individual numbers.

Starting destination guidance

Destination guidance starts immediately.

Saving destination The destination is added to the destination list or can be stored in the address book.

Map-guided destination selection If you only know the location of the town/city or street of the destination, then you can enter the destination by using a map. You can use the cursor to select the destination on the map and then adopt it into the destination guidance.

1. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler. "New destination" is selected.

2. Press the controller.

2. Say the name of the destination.

A destination is suggested by the system.

3. Select town/city:

> Select highlighted town/city: {Yes}

> Select other town/city: {No}

> Select entry, e.g. {Entry 3}

> To reenter the town/city: {Repeat}

> To enter the town/city by spelling: {Spell}

1. {House number}

2. Say the house number.

{Start guidance}

{Add to destination list} or {Add to address book}

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

149

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

3. Select "Input map" and press the controller.

A section of a map is displayed on the Con- trol Display:

> During destination guidance, around the current destination

> With the destination guidance deacti- vated, around the last destination entered

4. Select destination with cursor.

> Changing scale: turn the controller.

> Moving map: move the controller in the corresponding direction. The controller can be moved to the left, right, forward and back.

5. To adopt or store the destination in the des- tination guidance system, press the con- troller. The selected destination and other menu items are displayed.

6. Select the desired menu item:

> "Start route guidance" starts destination guidance.

> "Show current position" places the cur- rent position in the center of the map.

> "Show destination position" places the current destination in the center of the map.

> "Return to map" changes back to the "Input map".

> Exit the menu.

7. Press the controller.

The map for the destination entry can also be displayed in the map display: Select the symbol and press the controller.

Selecting destination using information You can obtain a display of selected destina- tions, e.g. hotels, sights or hospitals, and adopt them into the destination guidance.

1. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler.

2. Select "Information" and press the control- ler.

3. Select location:

> "On destination"

> "On location"

> "On a new destination"

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

150

4. Press the controller.

5. Make your selection, e.g. "Hotels and res- taurants", and press the controller.

6. Enter search criteria if necessary, e.g. the maximum distance from the current loca- tion.

7. Select " " and press the con- troller. These destinations are displayed on the Control Display.

8. Select a destination and press the control- ler.

The scope of the information and symbols is dependent on the respec-

tive navigation DVD.<

9. Select the desired menu item:

> To adopt the address in the destination list and start the destination guidance: Select the symbol and press the controller.

> To establish a telephone connection: Select the symbol and press the con- troller.

> To display additional destinations: Select the symbol and press the controller.

> To start a new search: Select the symbol and press the con- troller.

To exit the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Symbols in map view If, for example, you have selected the category Hotels, the hotels are shown on the map as symbols.

To hide the symbols in the map view:

1. Select the symbol and press the controller.

2. Select "Hide map icons" and press the con- troller.

The symbols are hidden.

To display the symbols: Select "Show map icons" and press the con- troller.

To exit the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Destination list The last 20 entered destinations are shown in the destination list. You can display these desti- nations and adopt them in the destination guid- ance system. For example, to plan a longer route, you can store all destinations you want to drive to in advance in the destination list, refer to Entering a destination manually on page 144.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

151

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Select "Navigation" and press the controller.

The last destination entered is the first item in the destination list.

This symbol indicates the current destina- tion during destination guide.

To display additional destinations from the des- tination list: turn the controller.

Applying destination in destination guidance system 1. Select the desired destination and press

the controller.

2. Select "Start guidance" and press the con- troller.

Editing destination list 1. Select the desired destination in the desti-

nation list and press the controller.

2. The selected destination can be edited:

> Store entry: Select "Add to address book".

> Display information on destination: Select "Information on destination".

> Delete entry: Select "Delete entry".

> Delete all entries: Select "Delete list". The destination guidance is switched off.

> Change entry: Select "Edit". For operation, refer to Entering destination via town/city name, page 145.

3. Press the controller.

Address book

Opening address book iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

Select "Address book" and press the controller.

Storing destinations in address book You can store approx. 100 destinations in the address book.

1. Select "Address book" and press the con- troller.

2. Select "New address" and press the con- troller.

3. Select "Enter address" and press the con- troller.

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

152

4. Enter name and address, also refer to Entering a destination manually, page 144.

5. Select "Store in address book" and press the controller. The entry is stored in the address book.

You can also store a destination from the desti- nation list in the address book, refer to page 150.

Storing current position* The current position can be adopted into the address book.

1. Select "Address book" and press the con- troller.

2. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until "New address" is selected and press the controller.

3. Select "Use current location as address" and press the controller. The name given can be changed. For oper- ation, refer to Entering a destination manu- ally, page 144.

4. Select "Store in address book" and press the controller.

You can also enter your current position into the address book if you have left the sector covered by the navigation DVD. In this case, you must enter a name.

Selecting destinations from address book 1. Select "Address book" and press the con-

troller. The stored entries appear on the Control Display.

2. Select the entry and press the controller.

To start the destination guidance: Select "Start guidance" and press the control- ler.

Changing destinations from address book 1. Select "Address book" and press the con-

troller.

2. Select the entry and press the controller.

3. Select "Edit address" and press the con- troller.

4. Change entry. For operation, refer to Entering a destina- tion manually, page 144.

5. Select "Store in address book" and press the controller.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

153

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Deleting individual destinations from address book 1. Select "Address book" and press the con-

troller.

2. Select the entry and press the controller.

3. Select "Delete address" and press the con- troller.

4. Select "Yes" and press the controller.

Deleting all destinations from address book 1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Vehicle / Tires" and press the con- troller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Delete data" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Delete address book" and press the controller.

7. Select "Yes" and press the controller.

Storing home address You can store your current position or the cur- rent destination as the home address in the address book. This entry occupies the second position in the address book.

1. Select "Address book" and press the con- troller.

2. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until "Home address" is selected and press the controller.

3. Select "Use current location as address", or "Save current destination" during the desti- nation guidance, and press the controller.

4. Select "Store in address book" and press the controller.

Adopting home address as destination 1. Select "Home address" and press the con-

troller.

2. Select "Start guidance" and press the con- troller.

Changing home address 1. Select "Home address" and press the con-

troller.

2. Select "Edit address" and press the con- troller. For operation, refer to Entering a destination manually, page 144.

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

154

Selecting route You can influence the calculated route by choosing certain route criteria. You can change the route criteria as often as you like while entering the destination and whenever the des- tination guidance is active.

The route is planned according to fixed rules. The type of road is taken into account, e.g. whether it is a highway or a winding road. The road types are stored on the navigation DVD. As a result, the routes recommended by the navigation system may not always be the same ones that you would choose based on personal experience.

Changing route criteria 1. Select "Navigation" and press the control-

ler.

2. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until "Route preference" is selected and press the controller.

The various criteria are listed on the Control Display.

3. Select a route criterion for the route:

> "With highways" Freeways and major traffic arteries are given priority

> "Avoid highways" Freeways are avoided where possible

> "Fast route" The short traveling time, being a combi- nation of the shortest possible route and the fastest roads

> "Short route" Short route, irrespective of how fast or slow progress will be

4. Press the controller.

The route criterion is selected.

5. If necessary, select an additional route cri- terion and then press the controller:

> "Dynamic route"* Automatic changing of the route in case of traffic obstructions. Depending on road type and the kind and extent of the traffic obstruction, the route can also be calculated so that it passes through the traffic obstruction.

> "Avoid tollroads" Tollroads are avoided where possible.

> "Avoid ferries" Ferries are avoided where possible.

To exit the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

The route criteria can also be changed in the arrow or map view:

1. Select the symbol for the route criterion and press the controller.

2. Select a route criterion and press the con- troller.

If the route criteria "Avoid highways", "Avoid tollroads" or "Avoid ferries" are

selected, the calculation time for the route can increase considerably.<

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

155

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Word matching principle The system supports the word matching princi- ple to make it easier for you to enter the names of streets or towns. The system runs ongoing checks, comparing your destination entries with the data stored on the navigation DVD as the basis for instant response. The user bene- fits include:

> Names of specific locations can also vary from the official versions if you are using a spelling that is customary in another coun- try.

Example:

Instead of "Mnchen", you can also enter the English spelling "Munich" or the Italian spelling "Monaco".

> When you are entering the names of towns and streets the system will complete them automatically as soon as enough letters are available to ensure unambiguous identifica- tion.

> The system only accepts name entries beginning with letters that are stored on the navigation DVD. The system will not accept non existent names and addresses.

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

156

Destination guidance

Starting destination guidance

Via iDrive iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Navigation" is selected and press the controller.

2. Select a destination from the destination list and press the controller or enter a new des- tination, refer to page 144.

3. Select "Start guidance" and press the con- troller.

After the route has been calculated, destination guidance is indicated by arrows or a map dis- play on the Control Display.

The destination guidance can also be started in the arrow or map view: Select the symbol and press the controller.

During destination guidance, you can operate other equipment via iDrive at any time. You will be punctually notified of a change of direction

by spoken instructions and the display of the direction arrow.

With programmable memory/ direct selection buttons Press the ... button on which the desired destination is stored. Also refer to page 22.

Destination guidance, terminating/continuing

In arrow or map display Select the symbol and press the controller.

In destination list This symbol indicates the current destina-

tion.

1. Select the current destination and press the controller.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

157

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

2. Select "Zielfhrung beenden" and press the controller.

When you park the vehicle before reaching the entered destination, the following question is displayed before beginning the next trip: "Continue guidance to destination?".

The destination guidance starts automatically after a short time.

To start the destination guidance: Select "Yes" and press the controller.

Displaying route You have the option of displaying various views of the route during destination guidance.

From another menu, you can change directly to the screen last displayed,

refer to Comfort opening of menu items, page 18.<

Displaying arrow display 1. Select "Navigation" and press the control-

ler.

2. Change into the fourth field from the top. Turn the controller until "Arrow display" is selected and press the controller.

The arrow display is shown.

1 Switching voice instructions on/off

2 Manually displaying traffic information* 3 Selecting route criteria

4 Starting/ending destination guidance

5 Arrow to destination from a bird's eye view

6 Distance to the next change of direction

7 Current position

8 Direction of travel

> Outline arrow: Destination guidance on the calculated route.

> Solid arrow: Arrow shows the route to be calculated from a bird's eye view when the vehicle is not located in an area contained on the navigation DVD, e.g. in a parking struc- ture.

Depending on the equipment, the estimated time of arrival and the distance to the destina- tion are displayed in the top or bottom line of the Control Display.

Before a change in direction, the representation of the arrow changes.

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

158

1 Street name for change of direction

2 Distance up to change of direction

3 Change of direction

To exit the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Displaying map view You can have your current position displayed on a map. After starting the destination guidance, the planned route is shown on the map.

1. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the fourth field from the top. Turn the controller until the desired map view is selected:

> "Map facing north"

> "Map direction of travel"

> "Perspective"

3. Press the controller.

1 Switching voice instructions on/off

2 Starting/ending destination guidance

3 Map-guided destination selection

4 Displaying the menu in which the informa- tion last selected can be displayed/hidden, refer to Selecting destination via informa- tion on page 149

5 Changing map display

> "Map facing north"

> "Map direction of travel"

> "Perspective"

6 Changing route criteria

7 Manually displaying traffic information* 8 Arrow to destination from a bird's eye view

The estimated time of arrival and the distance to the destination are shown in the bottom line of the Control Display.

To exit the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

At scales of less than 250 miles/500 km, you have the option of deciding whether to orient the map to north or toward your current direc- tion of travel. At scales of 250 miles/500 km or greater, the map always points toward north.

Changing map display

Select the corresponding symbol and press the controller. The next map display is displayed.

Changing scale Turn the controller to adjust the scale.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

159

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Displaying streets and towns/cities of route You can have the roads and towns along the route displayed during destination guidance.

The distances remaining to be traveled on each individual road are also displayed.

1. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until "Route list" is selected and press the controller.

To exit the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Destination guidance via voice instructions

Switching voice instructions on/off

During destination guidance, voice instructions can be switched on or off in the arrow or map view: Select the symbol and press the controller.

To switch the voice instructions on and off at any time:

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "Language / Units" is selected and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Languages" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Navigation voice instructions" and press the controller.

The voice instructions are switched on.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use*.

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

160

Repeating and canceling voice instructions With the programmable buttons on the steering wheel you can also make the following settings, refer to page 54:

> Repeat the voice instruction: Press button.

> Switch voice instructions on/off: Press button longer.

Setting volume of voice instructions The volume can only be adjusted while a voice instruction is being output.

1. Repeat the last voice instruction, if neces- sary.

2. Turn the knob during the voice instruction to select the desired volume.

This volume is independent of the volume of the audio sources.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Bypassing route sections During destination guidance, you can revise the navigation system's route recommendations to avoid particular stretches of road. Enter the number of miles/kilometers that you want to travel before returning to the original route.

1. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the third field from the top. Turn the controller until "New route" is selected and press the controller.

3. Turn the controller to enter the desired number and press the controller.

The route is recalculated.

To exit from the menu without changing the route:

Select the arrow and press the controller.

Traffic information* In many congested areas, you can receive traf- fic information transmitted by radio stations. The traffic conditions are monitored by traffic management centers and the traffic information is periodically updated. During destination guidance, the traffic infor- mation relevant to your planned route is auto- matically displayed. Whether destination guid- ance is active or not, you can have the traffic information displayed in the map view or in the traffic info list.

Switching reception of traffic information on/off iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

161

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "Traffic Info set- tings" is selected and press the controller.

5. Select "Traffic Info" and press the control- ler.

The traffic information can be received and displayed.

"AUTO": automatic selection of the Traffic Info station with the strongest reception.

Depending on the station, either the sta- tion name, frequency, local number or

other information is displayed.<

Manually displaying traffic information

During destination guidance During destination guidance, traffic information can be displayed in the arrow or map view.

If the symbol is shown with a red border, traf- fic information is available for the planned route.

Select the symbol and press the controller.

During destination guidance, the traffic infor- mation on the planned route is marked with a yellow diamond.

First the traffic information along the planned route is shown sorted according to the distance to the current vehicle position.

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

162

With destination guidance switched off 1. Open the start menu.

2. Move the controller to the right to open "Navigation".

3. Select "Traffic Info" and press the control- ler.

First the traffic information along the planned route is shown sorted according to the distance to the current vehicle position.

Depiction of traffic information in map view The traffic information symbols are shown in the map view up to a scale of 100 miles/200 km.

The section of the route affected by a traffic report as well as the number for the type of inci- dent are displayed and hidden. This occurs as a function of the scale selected.

Displaying detailed traffic information Select a traffic information item from the list and press the controller.

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

Symbols for traffic information

Traffic event with map scales greater than 5 miles/10 km, arrow points in the direction of travel concerned.

Several traffic events have been received. Select a smaller scale to display these individually.

Traffic light failure

Roadwork

General traffic obstruction Transport of hazardous load Vehicle on wrong carriage way

Danger

Low clearance

No parking

Fog

Heavy rain

Slippery road

Cross winds

Smog

Road close

Slow traffic

Traffic back up

Stopped traffic

Icy roads

Uneven surface

Accident

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

163

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Traffic information during destination guidance System response will vary depending on whether or not "Dynamic route" is selected.

Displaying traffic obstructions If a traffic obstruction is reported to the naviga- tion system and "Dynamic route" is not selected, you will be provided with certain infor- mation from a distance of approx. 25 miles/ 40 km, e.g. the length of the traffic jam. The last possible junction will be displayed shortly before this.

This information is also displayed if you have called up a different application on the Control Display.

Dynamic route planning When "Dynamic route" is selected, the route will be changed automatically in the event of a traffic obstruction. The system does not point out traffic obstructions along the original route. Depending on road type and the kind and extent of the traffic obstruction, the calculated route may lead through the traffic obstruction.

Displaying current position You can have your current position displayed even when the destination guidance is switched off.

1. Select "Navigation" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the fourth field from the top. Turn the controller until "Current position" is selected and press the controller.

The current position of your BMW is displayed.

Lane closure

Delay

Police checkpoint

Slow traffic or other event

Stop-and-go traffic

Stopped traffic

Traffic event in both directions of travel

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

164

If the navigation system is unable to identify a town/city, your current map coordinates will appear.

To exit the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

You can also have the current position dis- played on a map, refer to page 158.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

165

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

What to do if

What to do if

> a navigation DVD is inserted, but an instruc- tion to insert the DVD appears on the Con- trol Display? The navigation DVD may not be the correct DVD for the navigation system. This infor- mation is indicated on the DVD label.

> you request the current position of your vehicle, but do not receive a precise dis- play? The system is unable to receive enough GPS signals at your current position due to obstructions, your position is not yet avail- able on your navigation DVD, or the system is in the process of calculating your posi- tion. Reception is best when you have an unobstructed view to the sky.

> the destination guidance does not accept a destination? The data of the destination is not stored on the navigation DVD that is loaded. Select a destination that is as close as possible to the original.

> the destination guidance does not accept an address without the street name? On the navigation DVD, no downtown area can be determined for the city or town entered. Enter any street, or a destination such as the railway station in the selected town, and then start the destination guid- ance.

> you want to enter a destination for the des- tination guidance, but it is not possible to select the letters for your desired entry? The data of the destination is not stored on the navigation DVD that is loaded. In this case, the system will not offer you any let- ters to choose from. Select a destination that is as close as possible to the original.

> the system stops furnishing directions on which way to turn as you approach intersec- tions? You are driving in an area that has not yet been completely recorded on the naviga- tion DVD. Instead of an arrow indicating a turn, you will see an arrow which indicates the general direction of your planned route. Or you have left the recommended route and the system requires a few seconds to calculate a new recommended route.

> the navigation system does not react to entries? If the battery was disconnected, it takes about 10 minutes before the system is once again operational.

Entertainment Operation of the radio, CD and external audio

devices, as well as their tone settings are described in this chapter.

i

O n

/o ff

a n

d to

n e

168

On/off and tone

The following audio sources have shared controls and setting options:

> Professional* radio or Business radio

> CD player

> CD changer*

Controls The audio sources can be operated using:

> Buttons in the area of the CD player

> iDrive

> Buttons on steering wheel, refer to page 11

> Programmable memory/direct selection buttons, refer to page 21

Buttons in area of CD player The layout of the buttons can vary depending on your vehicle's equipment.

One drive:

Two drives:

1 Entertainment sound output on/off, volume

> Press: switch on/off. When the system is switched on, the most recently selected radio station or CD track is played.

> Turn: adjust volume.

2 Drive for audio CDs

3 Eject CD

4 Station scan/track search

> Change radio station.

> Select track for CD player and CD changer.

5 Drive for navigation DVDs

Operation via iDrive iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

169

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

You have the following choices:

> "FM" and "AM": radio reception

> "WB": Weather Band station

> "SAT": satellite radio

> "CD": CD player or CD changer

> "AUX": AUX-In connection

> USB/audio interface* > "Set": depending on the audio source,

other adjustments can be made, e.g. with the radio: update station with strongest reception, store station, tone control, sam- ple stations.

From another menu, you can change directly to the screen last displayed,

refer to Comfort opening of menu items, page 18.<

From radio readiness, the selected audio source is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Switching on/off To switch the Entertainment sound output on and off: Press knob 1 next to the CD player.

This symbol on the Control Display indi- cates that sound output is switched off.

For a single drive, the sound output is available for approx. 20 minutes with the ignition switched off. Switch on the sound output again for this pur- pose.

Adjusting volume Turn knob 1 next to the CD player until the desired volume is set.

You can also adjust the volume with buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 11.

From radio readiness, the setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Tone control You can alter various tone settings, e.g. treble and bass, or the speed-dependent volume increase. The tone settings are set for all audio sources at once.

From radio readiness, the settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Changing tone settings 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Audio" and press the controller.

The tone settings can also be selected when you have opened "Entertainment" in the start menu: Select "Set" and then "Tone", and press the controller.

Treble and bass 1. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the

controller until "Treble / Bass" is selected and press the controller.

O n

/o ff

a n

d to

n e

170

2. Move the controller to the left or right to select "Treble" or "Bass".

3. Turn the controller until the desired setting is selected.

Balance and fader You can adjust the volume distribution in the same manner as "Treble / Bass".

> "Balance": left/right volume distribution

> "Fader": front/rear volume distribution

Speed-dependent volume control The speed-dependent volume control auto- matically increases the volume with increasing speed. You can set various stages for the increase in volume.

1. Select "Speed volume" and press the con- troller.

2. Turn the controller: The adjustment is applied; the field can be changed.

Individual high-end sound system* You can choose between Stereo and Surround.

1. Select "Surround Settings" and press the controller.

2. Select "Stereo" or "Surround".

3. Press the controller. The spatial sound effect is activated.

Professional LOGIC7 HiFi System* You can select a spatial sound effect that improves the spatial acoustics in all frequency ranges.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

171

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

1. Select "Surround Settings" and press the controller.

2. Select "Concert hall" or "Theater".

3. Press the controller. LOGIC7 spatial sound is switched on.

To cancel the spatial sound effect: Select "Off" and press the controller.

LOGIC7 and the LOGIC7 logo are registered trade marks of Lexicon, Inc., a company of the Harman International Group.

Equalizer* You can set individual sound frequency ranges.

1. Select "Equalizer" and press the controller.

2. Move the controller to the left or right to select the desired frequency range.

3. Turn the controller until the desired setting is selected.

Resetting tone settings You can reset all tone settings to the default settings.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Audio" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Reset" is selected and press the controller.

With two drives: select "Yes".

R ad

io

172

Radio

Your radio provides reception of the FM and AM wavebands.

Listening to radio

Press the knob if the sound output is switched off.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "FM" or "AM" is selected.

4. Press the controller.

Stations are shown on the Control Display on the basis of various selection criteria, e.g. "Pre- sets".

If "Autostore" does not display any stations or if the stations displayed can no longer be received, to update the station with the stron- gest signal, refer to page 174.

Changing stations

Turn the controller.

In addition to the stations currently displayed, you can have stations with another selection criterion displayed.

Professional radio* You can choose from the following selection criteria:

> "All stations": Stations that can currently be received in the "FM" waveband.

> "Autostore": The stations with the strongest received signals in the "AM" waveband.

> "Presets": Stations you have previously stored, refer to page 174.

> "Manual": To set stations that can be received in addi- tion to those displayed, refer to Selecting frequency manually on page 173.

Business radio You can choose from the following selection criteria:

> "Autostore": For the Station with the strongest signal, refer to page 174.

> "Presets": Stations you have previously stored, refer to page 174.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

173

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

> "Manual": To set stations that can be received in addi- tion to those displayed, refer to Selecting frequency manually.

Changing selection criteria In addition to the stations currently displayed, you can have stations with another selection criterion displayed.

You can choose from the following selection criteria:

> "All stations": Stations that can currently be received in the "FM" waveband.

> "Autostore": The stations with the strongest received signals in the "AM" waveband.

> "Presets": Stations you have previously stored, refer to page 174.

> "Manual": To set stations that can be received in addi- tion to those displayed, refer to Selecting frequency manually.

1. Change into the second field from the top.

2. Turn the controller until the desired selec- tion criterion is selected and press the con- troller.

Buttons next to CD player Press the button for the corresponding direction. The system changes to the next displayed sta- tion. You can also change stations with buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 11.

Sampling stations, scan The system automatically plays a brief sample from each of the stations on the current wave- band.

1. Select "FM" or "AM" and press the control- ler. "Set" is selected.

2. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

3. Select "Scan" and press the controller.

The stations are sampled.

To end sampling:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Scan" and press the controller.

This cancels sampling of the stations, and the radio remains on the current station.

Buttons next to CD player To sample the stations, press and hold the

button for the corresponding direction.

To stop scanning, press the button again.

Selecting frequency manually With "Manual" you can select stations that are received in addition to those displayed.

1. Select "FM" or "AM" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the second field from the top.

R ad

io

174

3. Select "Manual" and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller to set a certain fre- quency.

Updating stations with best reception Radio Professional on "AM" and Radio Busi- ness: If you are on a longer journey and leave the transmission range of the stations originally set, you can update the list of stations with the best reception.

1. Select "FM" or "AM" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the second field from the top.

3. Select "Autostore" and press the controller. "Set" is selected.

4. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

5. Select "Autostore" and press the controller.

The display of the stations with the best recep- tion is updated. The frequencies of the stations are displayed.

Storing stations

Via iDrive 1. Select "FM" or "AM" and press the control-

ler.

2. Change into the second field from the top. Turn the controller until the desired selec- tion criterion is selected and press the con- troller.

3. Select the desired frequency or station. "Set" is selected.

4. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

175

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

5. Select "Store" and press the controller.

"Presets" is displayed.

6. Turn the controller until the desired mem- ory position is selected.

7. Press the controller. The station is stored.

The stations of the last selection criterion are displayed once again after a short time.

From radio readiness, the stations are stored for the remote control currently in use.

With programmable memory/ direct selection buttons You can also store a station on the programma- ble memory/direct selection buttons, also refer to page 21.

1. Select a station.

2. ... Press and hold desired but- ton.

Changing a memory position 1. Select "Presets" and press the controller.

2. Select the desired station. "Set" is selected.

3. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

4. Select "Store" and press the controller.

5. Turn the controller until the desired mem- ory position is selected. The number of the memory position appears beside the name or frequency of the station.

6. Press the controller. The station is stored.

RDS Radio Data System In the FM frequency range, additional informa- tion is transmitted via RDS. If the reception con- ditions are good, the station names are shown on the Control Display. If the reception is weak or disrupted, it can take some time before the station names are displayed.

Switching RDS on/off* 1. Select "FM" and press the controller.

"Set" is selected.

2. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

3. Select "RDS" and press the controller.

RDS is activated.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

R ad

io

176

Automatically sorting stations* For the "All stations" selection criterion, you can set whether the most frequently used sta- tions are displayed at the beginning.

1. Select "All stations" and press the control- ler. "Set" is selected.

2. Select "Favorites" and press the controller.

The most frequently used stations are shown at the beginning.

Weather news flashes* Weather Radio is a service of the National Oce- anic and Atmospheric Administration (NOAA) of the US Department of Trade. Weather news flashes are repeated every 4 to 6 minutes and are routinely updated at intervals of 1 to 3 hours, and more often when necessary. Most stations operate 24 hours a day. In case of a storm, the National Weather Service interrupts the routine weather news and transmits special warning messages instead. If you have a ques- tion about NOAA Weather Radio, please con- tact the nearest office of the National Weather Service. Details are also provided on the Inter- net at www.nws.noaa.gov.

Calling up weather news flashes 1. Select "WB" and press the controller.

2. Select a station.

The station for weather news flashes may be unavailable in some regions.

High Definition Radio* Many stations transmit both analog and digital signals. You can receive these stations digitally and with improved sound quality.

A digital radio network must be available in order to receive digital stations

Activating/deactivating digital radio reception iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Audio" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field. Turn the controller until "HD radio" is selected and press the controller.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

177

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

6. Select "Off" and press the controller.

The reception of digital stations is activated.

This symbol is displayed when a station is being received digitally.

With some stations the digital signals are not transmitted simultaneously with the analog sig- nals. If you are in an area in which the selected station is not continuously received digitally, playback changes between analog and digital reception. This can result in repetitions or inter- ruptions. In this case it may be advisable to deactivate digital radio reception.

Selecting programs of a digital station* Some stations transmit several programs. To select one of these programs:

1. Select "FM" or "AM" and press the control- ler.

2. Select "Manual" and press the controller.

3. Select a station that is received digitally. This symbol is displayed when a station

is being received digitally.

4. Switch to the next program of the dig- ital station with the buttons on the radio or the steering wheel.

You can store a station, refer to page 174.

Updating stations offering digital reception If you are on a longer journey and leave the transmission range of the stations originally set, you can update the list of stations with the best reception.

1. Select "FM" or "AM" and press the control- ler.

2. Change into the second field from the top.

3. Select "Autostore" and press the controller.

4. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

5. Select "Autostore " and press the con- troller.

The display of the stations offering digital reception is updated. This can take up to 2 min- utes.

R ad

io

178

Displaying additional information With the digital stations, additional information on the current track is displayed, e.g. the name of the artist.

1. Select a station and press the controller.

2. Select "Details" and press the controller.

The information is displayed.

If a digital station is received again when the station is changed, the additional information will be displayed again following a brief interrup- tion.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

179

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Satellite radio

You can receive over 100 different channels with high sound quality.

The channels are offered to you in predefined packages. To receive the channels of your choice, you must have this package enabled.

With this new technology the signal may fail, causing interruptions in reception.<

Enabling or disabling channels iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Select "SAT".

4. Press the controller.

The channels are displayed. These channels are enabled.

Enabling 1. Select a channel that has not yet been

enabled and press the controller. A telephone number and the electronic serial number, ESN, are displayed.

The electronic serial number is required for enabling or disabling.<

2. To enable the channels: Dial the phone number.

Disabling 1. Select an enabled channel and press the

controller.

2. Select "ESN" and press the controller. The electronic serial number, ESN, is dis- played.

The electronic serial number is required for disabling.<

3. To disable the channels: Dial the phone number.

*

S at

el lit

e ra

d io

180

Selecting and storing channel 1. Select "SAT" and press the controller.

Channels or categories appear in the Con- trol Display.

2. Select a menu item:

> "Presets": Up to twelve channels you have stored previously.

> "All channels": All channels are displayed.

> "Categories": All channels, sorted by categories, e.g. news, jazz.

3. Press the controller.

4. If "Categories" has been selected: Select the desired category and press the controller.

The channels of this category are displayed.

5. Select a channel marked with this sym- bol.

6. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

7. Select "Play" and press the controller.

Additional information The name of the channel and additional infor- mation on the current track are displayed, e.g. the name of the artist.

1 Artist

2 Track

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

181

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Storing channel 1. Select desired channel.

2. Press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

3. Select "Store" and press the controller.

"Presets" is displayed.

4. Turn the controller to select a memory loca- tion and press the controller.

The channel is stored. The channels of the last selection criterion are displayed once again after a short time.

Changing channel with buttons next to CD player Press the button for the corresponding direction. The system changes to the next enabled chan- nel.

Notes If no signal can be received for more than 4 sec- onds, a message is displayed on the Control Display.

Reception may not be possible for certain reasons, e.g. environmental influences or

topographical conditions. The satellite radio has no influence on this. The signal may not be available in tunnels or underground garages, next to tall buildings, near trees, mountains or other sources of radio interference. Reception is usually possible again as soon as the signal is available again.<

C D

p la

ye r a

n d

C D

c h

an g

er

182

CD player and CD changer

Listening to CDs

Compressed audio files* CDs with compressed audio files, i.e. MP3, can be played by the CD player, but not by the CD changer.

CD player: starting CD

With two drives: The upper drive is for audio CDs.

Inserting CD Insert the CD into the drive with the labeled side up. The CD is automatically pulled in. Playback starts automatically if the sound out- put is on. For CDs with compressed audio files, it can take up to approx. 1 minute to read in the data depending on the directory structure.

Via iDrive To start playback when there is already a CD in the drive:

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "CD" is selected and press the controller.

4. With a CD changer, change to the second field from the top and turn the controller until "CD" is selected and press the control- ler. The CD player is started.

Playback starts automatically if the sound out- put is switched on.

With programmable memory/ direct selection buttons You can store the function CD player on the programmable memory/direct selection but- tons to start the CD player, refer to page 21.

Eject CD Press the button next to CD player. The CD emerges slightly from the drive.

*

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

183

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

CD changer: starting CD Fill the CD magazine and insert, refer to page 186.

Via iDrive 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "CD" is selected and press the controller.

4. Change to the second field from the top if necessary. Turn the controller until the desired CD, CD 1 - 6, is selected and press the controller.

At the end of the last track, the next CD will be selected.

If the CD magazine has been newly filled, play- back begins with the lowest CD, e.g. CD 1, track 1.

The CD magazine's load status is indicated on the Control Display.

With programmable memory/ direct selection buttons You can store a CD compartment of the CD changer on the programmable memory/direct selection buttons to start the CD changer, refer to page 21.

Selecting a track

Buttons next to CD player Press the button for the corresponding direction repeatedly until you reach the desired track. The CD will start play at the start of the track. The track is displayed on the Control Display.

You can also change the track with buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 11.

Via iDrive Select a track by turning the controller.

Compressed audio files* 1. Select the directory if necessary and press

the controller.

2. Select the track and press the controller.

C D

p la

ye r a

n d

C D

c h

an g

er

184

To change the directory: Select the directory and press the controller.

To exit from the menu: Select the arrow and press the controller.

You can store a certain track on the program- mable memory/direct selection buttons, refer to page 21.

Displaying information on track* With compressed audio files, you can display any information stored on the current track, e.g. the name of the artist.

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Details" and press the controller.

The information for the current track are dis- played.

From radio readiness, the setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Sampling tracks, scan The system automatically plays a brief sample from each of the tracks on the current CD.

1. Select "Set" and press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

2. Select "Scan" and press the controller.

To end sampling:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Scan" and press the controller.

This cancels sampling of the tracks, and the player remains on the current track.

Compressed audio files* 1. Select the current track and press the con-

troller.

2. Select the desired menu item:

> To sample all tracks of the current direc- tory, select "Scan directory" and press the controller.

> To sample all tracks of the CD, select "Scan all" and press the controller.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

185

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

To end sampling:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Scan directory" or "Scan all" and press the controller.

This cancels sampling, and the player remains on the current track.

Repeating a track 1. Select "Set" and press the controller.

Other menu items are displayed.

2. Select "Repeat" and press the controller.

The current track on the CD is repeated.

To stop repeating:

1. Press the controller again.

2. Select "Repeat" and press the controller.

Compressed audio files* 1. Select the current track and press the con-

troller.

2. Select the desired menu item:

> To repeat the selected track, select "Repeat track" and press the controller.

> To repeat all tracks of the current direc- tory, select "Repeat directory" and press the controller.

To stop repeating:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Repeat track" or "Repeat directory" and press the controller.

Random play sequence In this mode, the tracks on the current CD are played once in a random sequence.

1. Select "Set" and press the controller. Other menu items are displayed.

2. Select "Random" and press the controller.

To stop random function:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Random" and press the controller.

C D

p la

ye r a

n d

C D

c h

an g

er

186

Compressed audio files* 1. Select the current track and press the con-

troller.

2. Select the desired menu item:

> To play all tracks of the current directory in random order, select "Random direc- tory" and press the controller.

> To play all tracks of the CD in random order, select "Random all" and press the controller.

To stop random function:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Random directory" or "Random all" and press the controller.

Fast forward/reverse Buttons next to CD player:

Press and hold the button for the corre- sponding direction.

CD magazine The BMW CD changer for six CDs is installed in the glove compartment.

Removing CD magazine To insert CDs into the CD magazine 1 or remove them from it, you must first remove the magazine from the CD changer:

Press button 2, the CD magazine 1 is ejected.

Wait at least 2 seconds before pushing in the magazine again so that the inserted CDs can be read in again.

Inserting/removing CDs into/from CD magazine When inserting or removing CDs, remember to hold them by their edges, taking care to avoid touching the data side with its reflective CD memory surface.

Inserting CDs: Insert one CD into each compartment of the magazine with the labeled side up.

Removing CDs: Pull out the desired tray and remove the CD.

Inserting CD magazine

Push in the CD magazine as far as possible in the direction of the arrow.

The CD changer automatically reads in the loaded CDs and is then ready for operation.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

187

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Notes BMW CD/DVD players and changers are officially designated Class 1 laser prod-

ucts. Do not operate if the cover is damaged, otherwise severe eye damage can result. Do not use self-recorded CDs/DVDs with labels applied as these can become detached during playback due to heat buildup and can cause irreparable damage to the device. Only use round CDs/DVDs with a standard diameter of 4.7 in/12 cm and do not play CDs/ DVDs with an adapter, e.g. CD singles, as other- wise the CD/DVD or the adapter can jam and may no longer eject properly. Do not use a combined CD/DVD, e.g. DVDPlus, otherwise the CD/DVD can jam and will no longer eject.<

General malfunctions BMW CD/DVD changers and players have been optimized for performance in vehicles. In some instances they may be more sensitive to faulty CDs/DVDs than stationary devices would be.

If a CD/DVD cannot be played, first check whether it has been inserted correctly.

Humidity High levels of humidity can lead to condensa- tion on the CD/DVD or the laser's scan lens and temporarily prevent playback.

Malfunctions with individual CDs/DVDs If malfunctions occur only with particular CDs/ DVDs, this can be due to one of the following causes.

Self-recorded CDs/DVDs Possible reasons for malfunctions with self- recorded CDs/DVDs are, e.g., inconsistent data-creation or recording processes, or poor quality or high age of the CD/DVD blank.

Only label CDs/DVDs on the upper side with a pen intended for this purpose.

Damaged CDs/DVDs Avoid fingerprints, dust, scratches and mois- ture. Store CDs/DVDs in a sleeve. Do not subject CDs/DVDs to temperatures over 1227/506, high levels of humidity or direct sunlight.

CDs/DVDs with copy protection CDs/DVDs are often provided with a copy pro- tection feature by the manufacturer. This can mean that some CDs/DVDs cannot be played or can only be played to a limited extent.

Care If necessary, clean the reflective scanning side of the CDs/DVDs with a commercially available cleaning cloth by wiping in straight lines from the center outward.

A U

X -I

n co

nn ec

ti o

n

188

AUX-In connection

You can connect an external audio device, e.g. an MP3 player, and play the sound via the vehi- cle loudspeakers. The sound can be adjusted via iDrive.

Connecting

1 Connection for audio playback: 1/8 in/3,5 mm jack plug

To play audio tracks through the vehicle's loud- speaker system, connect the headset or line- out port of the external device to connection 1.

Starting audio playback The audio device must be switched on.

Via iDrive iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "AUX" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "AUX IN" and press the controller.

5. Adjust volume and sound if necessary.

With programmable memory/ direct selection buttons You can save the function audio AUX on the programmable memory/direct selection but- tons to start audio playback, refer to page 21.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

189

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

USB/audio interface

You can connect audio devices to the USB/ audio interface, e.g. an iPod or a USB device (MP3 player, USB memory stick). You can then operate these via iDrive.

The system can play back common audio files, e.g. MP3, WMA, WAV (PCM) and ACC, as well as playback lists in the M3U format.

Due to the large number of audio devices avail- able on the market, operation via the vehicle cannot be ensured for every audio device.

Ask your BMW center which audio devices are suitable.

Connecting

1 USB interface

2 Connection for audio playback: 1/8 in/3,5 mm jack plug

iPod To connect the iPod, use the BMW cable adapter for Apple iPods. For more information, please contact a BMW center or consult our website: www.bmw.com

For audio playback via the vehicle loudspeak- ers, connect the iPod to the connections 1 and 2.

The menu structure of the iPod is supported by the USB/audio interface.

USB storage medium Use a flexible adapter cable for connec- tion to protect the USB interface and your

USB device against mechanical damage.<

For audio playback via the vehicle loudspeak- ers, connect the USB device to the connec- tion 1.

After connecting for the first time, the informa- tion of all tracks (e.g. artist, music genre) and the playback lists of the USB device are trans- ferred to the vehicle. This process can take some time. The time required is dependent on the USB device and on the number of tracks.

During the transfer you can select the tracks via the directories and file names.

Following the transfer you can call up the tracks via the information and playback lists.

The information of up to four USB devices can be stored in the vehicle, for a total of approx. 20,000 tracks.

If a fifth USB device is connected, the informa- tion of the tracks of the first USB device stored in the vehicle is deleted.

Music tracks with integrated Digital Rights Management (DRM) cannot be

played.<

Starting audio playback

Via iDrive If the audio device has a device name, this will be displayed if possible.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller backwards to open "Entertainment".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "AUX" is selected and press the controller.

*

U S

B /a

u d

io in

te rf

ac e

190

4. Select "USB" or the name of the audio device and press the controller.

5. The playback starts with the first track.

With programmable memory/ direct selection buttons You can save the function "USB" on the pro- grammable memory/direct selection buttons to start audio playback, refer to page 21.

Selecting a track You can call up the tracks via the playback lists and information. With USB devices you can also call up the tracks via the file directory.

1. Make your selection, e.g. "Playlists" or "Artists", and press the controller.

2. Select the track and press the controller.

Displaying information on track You can display any information stored on the current track, e.g. the name of the artist.

1. Press the controller during playback.

2. Select "Details" and press the controller.

The information for the current track are dis- played.

Repeating a track 1. Select the current track and press the con-

troller.

2. Select "Repeat track" and press the con- troller.

To stop repeating:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Repeat track" and press the con- troller.

N a

vi g

a ti

o n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

191

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Random play sequence You can play back the tracks of the selected list in random order, e.g. all tracks of an artist.

1. Select the current track and press the con- troller.

2. Select "Random" and press the controller.

End random playback:

1. Press the controller.

2. Select "Random" and press the controller.

Fast forward/reverse Buttons next to CD player:

Press and hold the button for the corre- sponding direction.

Notes Do not subject the audio device to extreme environmental conditions, e.g.

extremely high temperatures, refer to the oper- ating instructions of the audio device. Other- wise, the audio device can be damaged and the resulting distraction can reduce road safety while driving.<

Depending on the configuration of the audio files, e.g. bit rates greater than 256 Kbit/s, proper playback cannot always be ensured.

Connecting instructions > The USB/audio interface supplies the con-

nected audio device with power, provided the audio device supports this function. It is therefore unnecessary to connect the audio device to a socket in the vehicle during operation.

> Do not force the plug into the USB interface.

> Do not connect any devices, e.g. fans or lamps, to the USB/audio interface.

> Do not connect USB hard disks.

> Do not use the audio interface to recharge external devices.

Communications This chapter summarizes how to operate your mobile phone using iDrive or voice control and

how to use BMW Assist or TeleService.

T el

ep ho

n in

g

194

Telephoning

The concept Your BMW is equipped with a full mobile phone preparation package. After pairing a suitable mobile phone in the vehicle once, you can oper- ate the mobile phone via iDrive, with the buttons on the steering wheel and by voice.

A mobile phone that has been paired once is automatically detected again with the engine running or the ignition switched on as soon as it is in the vehicle interior. The logon data of up to four mobile phones can be stored simulta- neously. If several mobile phones are detected simultaneously, the respective last mobile phone paired can be operated via the vehicle.

Using a phone in your vehicle

Using snap-in adapter* The so-called snap-in adapter, a mobile phone cradle, enables the battery to be charged and the mobile phone to be connected to the exter- nal antenna of your vehicle. This ensures improved network reception and a consistent voice reproduction quality. Ask your BMW cen- ter which mobile phones snap-in adapters are offered for.

For your safety A car phone makes life more convenient in many ways, and can even save lives in an emer- gency. While you should consult your mobile phone's separate operating instructions for a detailed description of safety precautions and information, we request that you direct your particular attention to the following:

Only make entries when traffic conditions allow you to do so. Do not hold the mobile

phone in your hand while you are driving; use the hands-free system instead. If you do not observe this precaution, your being distracted can endanger vehicle occupants and other road users.<

Suitable mobile phones Ask your BMW center which mobile phones with a Bluetooth interface are supported by the mobile phone preparation package or which mobile phones snap-in adapters are available for. These mobile phones support the functions described in this Owner's Manual with a certain software version. Malfunctions can occur with other mobile phones.

Care instructions You can find what you need to know about car- ing for your mobile phone in the separate Caring for your vehicle brochure and in the mobile phone operating instructions.

Operating options You can operate the mobile phone* using:

> Buttons on steering wheel, refer to page 11

> iDrive, refer to page 16

> Voice commands, refer to page 205

> Programmable memory/direct selection buttons, refer to page 21

Avoid operating a mobile phone detected by the vehicle with the keypad of the mobile phone, otherwise malfunctions can occur.

Placing phone calls with BMW Assist system*: BMW Assist calls You can use the BMW Assist system via the hands-free unit for BMW Assist calls.

When the status information "BMW Assist" or "BMW Service" is displayed in "Communica- tion", only BMW Assist calls are possible.

It may not be possible to establish a telephone connection using the mobile phone while a connection is being established to BMW Assist or while a call to BMW Assist is already in progress. If this happens, you must log off the

*

195

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n M

o b

il it

y

mobile phone from the vehicle if you wish to place a call with the mobile phone.

Commissioning

Pairing mobile phone in vehicle The following prerequisites must be met:

> Suitable mobile phone: the mobile phone is supported by the full mobile phone prepara- tion package. Information on this subject is also provided on the Internet at: www.bmw.com

> The mobile phone is ready to operate.

> The Bluetooth link on the vehicle, refer to page 199, and on the mobile phone is active.

> Depending on the mobile phone, the mobile phone may need presetting: e.g. via the fol- lowing menu items:

> Bluetooth activated

> Connection not with confirmation

> Reconnect

> Depending on the mobile phone model, the setting energy saving mode can, for exam- ple, result in vehicle failing to detect the paired mobile phone.

> For pairing, specify any desired number as the Bluetooth passkey, e.g. 1. This Blue- tooth passkey is no longer required follow- ing successful pairing.

> The ignition is switched on.

Only pair the mobile phone with the vehi- cle stopped, otherwise the passengers

and other road users can be endangered due to a lack of attentiveness on the part of the driver.<

Switching on ignition 1. Insert the remote control as far as possible

into the ignition lock.

2. Switch on the ignition by pressing the Start/ Stop button without depressing the brake or clutch pedal.

Preparation via iDrive iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

3. Press the button to open the start menu.

4. Press the controller to open the menu.

5. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

6. Select "Bluetooth" and press the controller.

T el

ep ho

n in

g

196

7. Change into the second field from the top, select "Phone" and press the controller.

8. Select "Pair new phone" and press the con- troller.

9. Select "Start pairing" and press the control- ler.

The Bluetooth name of the vehicle is dis- played.

Preparation with mobile phone 10. Additional operations must be carried out

on the mobile phone and differ depending on the model, refer to the operating instruc- tions of your mobile phone, e.g. find, con- nect or pair under Bluetooth device. The Bluetooth name of the vehicle is also shown on the mobile phone display.

11. Select the Bluetooth name of the vehicle on the mobile phone display.

Pairing Depending on your mobile phone, you will first be requested consecutively via the display of your mobile phone or iDrive to enter the Blue- tooth passkey you specified.

12. Enter the Bluetooth passkey. Depending on the mobile phone, approx. 30 seconds are available for entering the Bluetooth passkey on the mobile phone and on the Control Display.

13. Change into the third field from the top, select "Confirm passkey" and press the controller.

14. Wait a few seconds until the "Communica- tion" menu appears.

The next time you use the mobile phone in the vehicle interior, it will be detected within a max- imum of 2 minutes with the engine running or the ignition switched on.

With some mobile phone models it may be necessary to make certain settings for

a permanent Bluetooth link, e.g. via the menu item Authorization or Secure connection. Refer to the operating instructions of your mobile phone.<

197

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n M

o b

il it

y

As soon as a mobile phone is detected by the vehicle, the phone book entries stored on the SIM card or on your mobile phone are transmit- ted to your vehicle. This transmission is depen- dent on your mobile phone, refer to the operat- ing instructions of your mobile phone if necessary, and can take several minutes.

If not all phone book entries are displayed:

> Transfer all phone book entries from the SIM card to the mobile phone if necessary.

> It may not be possible to display phone book entries with special characters.

Up to four mobile phones can be paired consec- utively. When you pair a fifth mobile phone, the pairing data of the mobile phone for which the pairing data were stored first in the vehicle will be deleted.

Check if pairing is unsuccessful > Is the mobile phone supported by the

mobile phone preparation package? Infor- mation on this subject is also provided on the Internet at: www.bmw.com.

> Do the Bluetooth passkeys on the mobile phone and the vehicle match? The same Bluetooth passkey must be entered both on the mobile phone display and via iDrive.

> Have you required longer than 30 seconds to enter the Bluetooth passkey?

> Only a limited number of devices can be connected to the mobile phone. Delete the connection to other devices if necessary.

> The mobile phone no longer reacts? Switch the mobile phone off and then on again or disconnect the power supply.

To repeat pairing:

1. Select "Restart pairing" and press the con- troller.

2. Repeat steps 9 to 14.

If pairing was repeatedly unsuccessful, contact BMW Customer Relations.

To call the BMW Customer Relations:

Select "Help" and press the controller.

The phone number of BMW Customer Rela- tions and information required for pairing is shown on the display. With mobile phones already paired, you can select the phone num- ber of BMW Customer Relations to establish the connection.

T el

ep ho

n in

g

198

List of paired mobile phones The mobile phones for which the vehicle has stored the pairing data can be displayed. If sev- eral paired mobile phones are detected by the vehicle simultaneously, you can operate the mobile phone highest up in the list via the vehi- cle.

You can change the order of the mobile phones in the list. As long as a mobile phone is selected in this list, the mobile phones cannot be oper- ated via the vehicle.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button to open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "Bluetooth" and press the controller.

5. Change into the second field from the top, select "Phone" and press the controller.

6. Select the desired mobile phone.

With two drives:

> Move the controller to the rear to change into the bottom field.

> Select the desired mobile phone and press the controller.

With a single drive:

> Select the desired mobile phone and press the controller.

7. Select "Move device up" and press the con- troller.

The selected mobile phone is moved upward by one position.

Unpairing mobile phone from vehicle If you no longer want to operate a mobile phone via the vehicle, you can delete the pairing data of the mobile phone.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Switch off the mobile phone.

2. Press the button to open the start menu.

3. Press the controller to open the menu.

4. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

5. Select "Bluetooth" and press the controller. "Bluetooth" is selected.

6. Change into the second field from the top, select "Phone" and press the controller.

7. Select the desired mobile phone.

With two drives:

> Move the controller to the rear to change into the bottom field.

> Select the desired mobile phone and press the controller.

With a single drive:

> Select the desired mobile phone and press the controller.

199

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n M

o b

il it

y

8. Select "Delete device" and press the con- troller.

The unpaired mobile phone is deleted from the list. The phone book entries and the lists of stored phone numbers are also deleted.

Activating/deactivating Bluetooth link Bluetooth technology is not approved in all countries. Observe the applicable local

regulations. Temporarily deactivate the Blue- tooth link between the vehicle and the mobile phone if necessary. If the Bluetooth link is deactivated, you cannot operate your mobile phone via the vehicle and other devices with a Bluetooth interface can be used via the mobile phone, e.g. a laptop com- puter.<

To temporarily deactivate the Bluetooth link between your vehicle and your mobile phone:

1. Remove the mobile phone from the cradle and switch it off.

2. Press the button to open the start menu.

3. Press the controller to open the menu.

4. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

5. Select "Bluetooth" and press the controller.

6. Change into the second field from the top, select "Settings" and press the controller.

7. Select "Bluetooth communication active" and press the controller to activate or deac- tivate the link.

The Bluetooth link is activated. The Bluetooth link is deactivated.

T el

ep ho

n in

g

200

Adjusting volume

Turn the knob during a call to select the desired volume.

This volume for the hands-free system is main- tained, even if the other audio sources are set to minimum volume.

You can also adjust the volume with buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 11.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Operation via iDrive You can operate the following functions via iDrive:

> Accepting/refusing a call

> Dialing phone numbers

> Dialing phone numbers from the phone book

> Dialing stored phone numbers, e.g. from the list of accepted calls.

> Ending a call

When the ignition and radio readiness are switched off, e.g. after removing the remote control from the ignition lock, you can continue an ongoing call via the hands-free system for no more than 25 minutes.

Speech quality If the person you are talking to cannot under- stand you well, this may be due to excessively loud background noises. The full mobile phone preparation package can compensate for these noises to a certain degree.

To optimize the speech quality during a call, we recommend that you:

> Reduce background noises, e.g. by closing the windows, reducing the air volume of the automatic climate control or pointing the opened front vent outlets downward

> Reduce volume of hands-free system

Requirements > The logon data of the mobile phone are

stored in the vehicle and the mobile phone is ready to operate.

> The engine is running or the ignition is switched on.

> The mobile phone is detected by the vehi- cle.

Opening Communication You operate many of the functions described in the following via the "Communication" menu.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button to open the start menu.

2. Move the controller forward to open "Com- munication".

Receiving calls If you have the phone number of the caller stored in the phone book and the phone num- ber has been transmitted, the name of the entry is displayed.

201

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n M

o b

il it

y

Accepting a call Press the button on the steering wheel.

Alternative:

"Accept" is selected. Press the controller.

Rejecting a call Select "Reject" and press the controller. The caller is diverted to your mailbox if it has been activated.

Calling

Dialing phone numbers 1. Select "Phone" and press the controller.

2. Select "Dial" and press the controller.

3. Enter the desired phone number by dialing the individual digits and pressing the con- troller. Always enter the complete phone number consisting of national dialing code, area code, and phone number. The letters correspond to the digits on the keypad of the mobile phone.

To delete the last digit: Move the controller toward the right to select the arrow and press the control- ler.

4. Select "Dial number" and press the control- ler.

Alternative: Press the button on the steering wheel.

For your phone number to be displayed to the person you are calling, the display of phone numbers must be enabled by your service pro- vider.

With programmable memory/ direct selection buttons You can store phone numbers on and call them up with the programmable memory/direct selection buttons, refer to page 21.

Ending a call Press the button on the steering wheel.

Alternative:

1. Select the phone number and press the controller.

T el

ep ho

n in

g

202

2. "End call" is selected: Press the controller.

Dialing a phone number from phone book or a phone number stored in a list Phone numbers you have called, incoming calls and the entries of the phone book are stored in lists when the mobile phone is connected to the vehicle via Bluetooth. If the caller is entered in the phone book, the name of the entry is dis- played instead of the phone number. You can select the desired subscriber from the list and establish the connection.

Five lists are available:

> "A - Z" The entries of the mobile-phone phone book, consisting of the name and phone number, are sorted alphabetically.

> "Top 8" The eight numbers called most frequently from the phone book "A - Z" are automati- cally stored in the Top 8 list.

> "Redial" The last eight phone numbers you have dialed are automatically stored. The last number dialed is at the top of the list.

> "Missed calls" The phone numbers of the last eight calls which were not accepted are stored. This requires the telephone number of the caller to have been sent.

> "Received calls" The phone numbers of the last eight accepted calls are stored. This requires the telephone number of the caller to have been sent.

Dialing a phone number from phone book The list "A - Z" is available for your phone book entries. The phone book entries appear on the Control Display.

1. Select "Phone" and press the controller.

2. Select "A - Z" and press the controller.

3. To limit the number of displayed entries, select the first letter of the desired entry and press the controller.

4. Select the desired entry and press the con- troller.

5. Select "Call" and press the controller. The system dials the number.

If different phone numbers are stored in the mobile phone under one name, e.g. office and home, the name is shown once for each phone number.

You can change a phone number stored in the phone book, e.g. to call a specific extension:

1. Select "Phone" and press the controller.

2. Select "A - Z" and press the controller.

3. Select the desired entry and press the con- troller.

4. Select "Add digits" and press the controller.

203

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n M

o b

il it

y

5. Change the phone number.

6. Select "Dial number" and press the control- ler.

Dialing a phone number stored in a list To select an entry and establish a connection:

1. Select "Phone" and press the controller.

2. Select list and press the controller:

> "Top 8"

> "Redial"

> "Missed calls"

> "Received calls"

3. Select the desired entry and press the con- troller.

4. Select "Call" and press the controller. The system dials the number.

Deleting individual entries 1. Select the desired entry from the list and

press the controller.

2. Select "Delete" and press the controller.

The entry is deleted.

Deleting entire list 1. Select an entry from the list and press the

controller.

2. Select "Delete all numbers" and press the controller.

3. Select "Yes" and press the controller. The list is deleted.

BMW Contact* If you are not enabled for BMW Assist, you can have several service phone numbers displayed:

> BMW Roadside Assistance* when you require breakdown assistance

> BMW center, e.g. when you want to make an appointment for service

> BMW Customer Relations* for information on all aspects of your vehicle

If BMW Assist is enabled, refer to page 209.

T el

ep ho

n in

g

204

You can dial the displayed service phone num- bers if your mobile phone is paired in the vehi- cle:

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller forward to select "Communication".

3. Select "BMW Contact" and press the con- troller.

4. Select "BMW Contact Numbers" and press the controller.

5. Select one of the following menu items and press the controller:

> "Roadside Assistance"

> "Customer Relations"

> "Service Request"

6. Select "Call" and press the controller.

Contact is established.

Transmitting phone number via tone dialing method The tone dialing method is required for access to network services or for controlling devices, e.g. remote checking of an answering machine.

This function is available when a connection has been established.

1. Establish connection.

2. With a single drive: Press the controller. Select "Keypad" and press the controller. With two drives: Move the controller backwards until the bottom field is selected.

3. Select the desired characterand press the controller. Each character is sent immediately and confirmed by a tone depending on the mobile phone model.

205

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n M

o b

il it

y

Changing between mobile phone and hands-free system

From mobile phone to hands-free system* You can continue calls begun outside the Blue- tooth range of the vehicle via the hands-free system when the motor is running or the igni- tion is switched on. Depending on your mobile phone, the system automatically changes over to the hands-free mode.

For mobile phones that do not automatically change over to the hands-free mode:

> Depending on the mobile phone model used, the conversation can be continued via the hands-free system if necessary. Act according to what is shown on the mobile phone display, refer to the operating instructions of your mobile phone.

> Press the button above the storage compartment. Changing over may take sev- eral seconds.

From hands-free system to mobile phone When you telephone via the hands-free system, you can also continue the call via the mobile phone if necessary, depending on the mobile phone model. Act according to what is shown on the mobile phone display, refer to the oper- ating instructions of your mobile phone.

As an alternative, you can deactivate the Blue- tooth link.

Depending on your mobile phone model, poor reception of the wireless communications net- work can result in the system changing from the hands-free system to the mobile phone.

Operation by voice*

The concept You can operate your mobile phone without having to remove your hands from the steering wheel. When making your entries, you will be supported by announcements or questions in many cases.

The same prerequisites as for operation via iDrive apply, refer to page 200.

Voice commands

Activating system 1. Briefly press the button on the steering

wheel. An acoustic signal indicates that you can say commands.

2. Say the command.

Ending/canceling operation by voice Press the button on the steering wheel or

In dialogs where text is spoken, not a command, e.g. a name, canceling is only possible using the button on the steering wheel.

Having possible commands read aloud The system understands default commands that must be spoken word for word. You can have the possible commands spoken by the system at any point:

Using alternative commands There are often a number of commands to run a function, e.g.:

The system recognizes digits from zero to nine.

You can say each digit individually or group them into a sequence to accelerate the input.

{Cancel}.

{Help}.

{Dial name} or {Name}.

T el

ep ho

n in

g

206

Example: dialing phone numbers To start the dialog:

Press the button on the steering wheel.

Setting volume of instructions You can adjust the volume for the instructions from the system:

Turn the knob during instructions.

This volume for the instructions is maintained, even if the other audio sources are set to mini- mum volume.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Calling

Dialing phone numbers

The connection to the desired subscriber is established.

Correcting phone number After the last spoken sequence of digits has been repeated by the system, you can delete this sequence of digits.

The command {Correct number} can be repeated as often as you like.

Deleting phone number

All digits entered up to this point are deleted.

Voice phone book Operating by voice command requires a per- sonal voice phone book.

> With separate drives for audio CDs and nav- igation DVDs, the entries are automatically adopted from your mobile phone's memory.

> With a single drive, the entries must be input by voice and are independent of your mobile phone's memory. In this case, it is not possible to use voice command either to call phone numbers stored in the mobile phone or to store new numbers. Up to 50 entries can be input. An entry always consists of a name and phone number.

You say The voice control answers

{Dial number} {{Please say the number}}

e.g. {123 456 7890} Depending on equipment: {{123 456 7890. Continue?}} or {{123 456 7890. And next?}}

{Dial} {{Dialing number}}

1. {Dial number}.

2. Say the phone number. For telephone calls abroad, say {Plus} and then the country code.

3. {Dial}.

{Correct number}. The digits are deleted.

{Delete}

207

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n M

o b

il it

y

Creating and editing voice phone book* Store entry:

An entry always consists of a name and phone number.

Delete entry:

You can delete any entry from the voice phone book.

Delete all entries:

{Delete phone book} deletes all entries in the phone book.

Have entries read aloud and select:

You can have all the entries of your voice phone book read aloud in the order of input and select a certain entry to establish a connection:

Selecting an entry The connection to the phone number of the selected entry is established.

Redialing The {Redial} command calls "Redial".

Notes

Important for voice commands For voice commands, keep the following in mind:

> Issue the commands smoothly and at nor- mal volume, avoiding excessive emphasis and pauses.

> Keep the doors, windows and glass sunroof closed to prevent interference from ambi- ent noise.

> Avoid making other noise in the vehicle while speaking.

Mounting/removing snap-in adapter 1. Press the area 1 around the button and

remove the cover.

1. {Save name}.

2. Speak the name. The spoken length of the names in the phone book must not exceed approx. 2 seconds.

3. Speak the phone number after being requested to do so by the system.

4. To store the phone number: {Save}.

1. {Delete name}. The dialog for deleting an entry is opened.

2. Say the name when prompted.

3. Confirm the prompt with {Yes}.

1. {Delete phone book}. The dialog for deleting phone book is opened.

2. Confirm the prompt with {Yes}.

3. Confirm the repeated prompt with {Yes}.

1. {Read phone book}. The dialog for reading phone book is opened.

2. {Dial number} when the desired entry is read aloud.

1. {Dial name}. The dialog for selecting an entry is opened.

2. Say the name when prompted.

3. Confirm the prompt with {Yes}.

T el

ep ho

n in

g

208

2. Insert the snap-in adapter at the front and press down until it engages.

To remove the snap-in adapter: Press the area 1 around the button.

Inserting mobile phone 1. Remove the protective cap from the mobile

phone's antenna connector if necessary, so that the mobile phone can engage in the snap-in adapter.

2. Push the mobile phone with the buttons facing upward toward the electrical connec- tions and press down until it engages.

The mobile phone's battery is charged from radio readiness or with the steering unlocked.

To protect the vehicle's batteries, avoid using the phone when the ignition is

switched off.<

Removing mobile phone

Press button.

209

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n M

o b

il it

y

BMW Assist

BMW Assist provides you with various services. For example, the position data of your vehicle can be transmitted to the BMW Assist Response Center if an emergency request* has been initiated.

Many BMW Assist services depend on the indi- vidually agreed contract.

After your contract has expired, the BMW Assist system will be deactivated by the BMW Assist Response Center without you having to visit a BMW center. After the BMW Assist sys- tem has been deactivated, no BMW Assist ser- vice will be available. The BMW Assist system can be reactivated by a BMW center after sign- ing a new contract.

Requirements You can use BMW Assist when the following requirements are met:

> The installed BMW Assist system is logged on to a mobile phone network. This network must be capable of transmitting the ser- vices.

> To transmit position data, the vehicle must be able to determine the current position.

> In order to activate and update BMW Assist, a GPS signal must be available.

> You have subscribed to BMW Assist with your BMW center or with the BMW Assist Response Center. Activation must be com- pleted.

> BMW Assist is activated, refer to page 214.

Offered services The following services are available via BMW Assist:

> Emergency request, refer to page 247: When you press the SOS button, a connec- tion is established to the BMW Assist Response Center. The BMW Assist Response Center contacts you and takes further steps to help you.

> Automatic collision notification: Under certain conditions, a connection is established to the BMW Assist Response Center immediately after a serious acci- dent. If possible, the BMW Assist Response Center contacts you and takes further steps to help you.

> Enhanced roadside assistance: You can call Roadside Assistance* of the BMW Group should you require help in the event of a breakdown. If possible, the vehi- cle data and position data are transmitted during this time.

> BMW Customer Relations: For information related to your vehicle, call BMW Customer Relations.

> TeleService: The data on the service status of your vehi- cle or on required inspections are transmit- ted to your BMW center either automati- cally prior to the due date or when you request a BMW service appointment.

> Remote door unlock: Inform the BMW Assist Response Center, e.g. if your remote control is not available and you want to have the vehicle unlocked.

> Stolen vehicle recovery: After your vehicle has been reported to the police as stolen, the BMW Assist Response Center can locate its position. To do this, the vehicle electronics must be ready for operation.

*

B M

W A

ss is

t

210

In addition, you can be provided with other ser- vices, e.g. the concierge service or information on route planning, traffic conditions, and the weather. With Critical Calling, you can make a limited number of calls via the BMW Assist Response Center, e.g. if you do not have your mobile phone with you. Press the SOS button to contact the BMW Assist Response Center, see below.

You also have access to the BMW Assist con- cierge service via the Internet.

Characteristics of the offered services The following characteristics apply to the ser- vices:

> The offered services are country-specific.

> Voice contact is established or data are transmitted, depending on the equipment and the country. In some countries, it is possible to do both.

> The data transmitted can, for example, be the vehicle data, your current position or the CBS Condition Based Service data.

Using services

Contacting BMW Assist Response Center You can contact the BMW Assist Response Center via the SOS button.

1. Briefly press protective cover to open. Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the arrangement of the switches and indicator lamps may differ somewhat.

2. Press the button for at least 2 seconds.

The BMW Assist Response Center is con- tacted.

Roadside assistance iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller forward to select "Communication".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "BMW Assist" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Roadside Assistance" and press the controller.

If the location can be determined, the cur- rent vehicle position is displayed.

211

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n M

o b

il it

y

5. Select "Start service" and press the con- troller.

The BMW Assist Response Center will connect you to the Roadside Assistance of the BMW Group.

TeleService

Automatic service notification* The data on the service status of your vehicle or on required inspections are transmitted auto- matically prior to the due date. You can check when the BMW center was notified.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Info sources" and press the control- ler.

4. Select "Service Info" and press the control- ler.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Service requirements" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Auto Request" and press the con- troller.

Manual service notification You can transmit data regarding your vehicle's service status to your BMW center when you wish to arrange a service appointment.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller forward to select "Communication".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "BMW Assist" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Service Request".

5. Press the controller.

6. Select "Start service" and press the con- troller.

B M

W A

ss is

t

212

The data relevant for service are transmitted. Your BMW center will contact you to set up an appointment for service.

Contacting BMW Customer Relations For information on all aspects of your vehicle, you can contact BMW Customer Relations.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller forward to select "Communication".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "BMW Assist" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Customer Relations".

5. Press the controller.

6. Select "Start service" and press the con- troller.

You will be connected to BMW Customer Rela- tions by the BMW Assist Response Center.

Concierge service* When you call the concierge service of BMW Assist, you can, for example, obtain infor- mation on current events, filling stations or hotels and have their phone numbers and addresses transmitted. Many hotels can be booked directly through the BMW Assist con- cierge service.

The concierge service must be enabled sepa- rately by the BMW Assist Response Center.

Calling up information 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Move the controller forward to select "Communication".

3. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "BMW Assist" is selected and press the controller.

4. Select "Concierge" and press the control- ler.

5. Select "Start Service" and press the con- troller.

The BMW Assist Response Center will connect you with a BMW Assist concierge.

213

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n M

o b

il it

y

Displaying transmitted data Select the received message if necessary and press the controller.

Dialing a phone number or transferring an address for destination guidance 1. Select "Options" and press the controller.

2. Select a menu item:

> With "Call" you can establish a telephone connection. A prerequisite for this is that your Bluetooth mobile phone has been paired with the vehicle.

> Press "Select as destination" to transfer the address to the navigation system for desti- nation guidance.

Updating BMW Assist

Displaying and updating services You will be notified of any changes in the ser- vices offered by BMW Assist. In this case you should update the service functions.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "BMW Service set- tings" is selected and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Enabled services" is selected and press the controller. The currently available BMW Assist ser- vices are displayed.

6. Select "Options" and press the controller.

7. Select "Update services" and press the controller.

B M

W A

ss is

t

214

Blocking services* If you block the services, the connection to BMW Assist is deactivated.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "BMW Service set- tings" is selected and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Enabled services" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Options" and press the controller.

7. Select "Terminate services" and press the controller.

The use of BMW Assist is blocked, and the cur- rent vehicle position will not be transmitted dur- ing an emergency request*. To cancel blocking and reactivate BMW Assist, see below. This does not affect the contractual agreements.

Reactivate BMW Assist if necessary to log on again.

Activating BMW Assist BMW Assist must be activated to use the ser- vices.

Requirements > Make sure that the vehicle can determine its

current position. Reception is best when you have an unobstructed view to the sky.

> Leave radio readiness switched on during the activation process.

Activating 1. Press the button.

This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Settings" is selected and press the controller.

215

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n M

o b

il it

y

4. Turn the controller until "BMW Service set- tings" is selected and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Enabled services" is selected and press the controller.

6. Select "Enable services" and press the con- troller. BMW Assist is enabled and the data exchange with the BMW Assist Response Center begins.

Activation takes a few minutes. The status is displayed on the Control Display. If you open another menu, the activation process continues to run in the background.

Displaying vehicle data When BMW Assist is activated, the license plate and the vehicle identification number of your vehicle may be displayed.

1. Open the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Select "Settings" and press the controller.

4. Select "BMW Service settings" and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Profile" is selected and press the controller.

Mobility This section helps you maintain your

mobility by supplying important information on vital topics including fuels and lubricants,

wheels and tires, service, maintenance and roadside assistance.

R ef

u el

in g

218

Refueling

Switch off the engine before refueling, otherwise no fuel can be filled into the

tank and a message is displayed.<

When handling fuel, always observe all applicable precautionary measures and

regulations. Never transport reserve fuel con- tainers in the vehicle. These could become leaky and cause an explosion or a fire in an acci- dent.<

Fuel filler door

To open and close: press the rear edge of the fuel filler door.

Manual release If an electrical malfunction should occur, you can unlock the fuel filler door manually.

Sedan 1. In the cargo bay, raise the floor mat and the

cover located beneath it.

2. Open the snap fasteners of the right side panel and take off the side panel.

3. Pull the knob with the gas pump symbol.

Sports Wagon 1. Unhook the retaining strap*, refer to

page 130.

2. Open the right-hand side panel in the cargo bay.

3. Pull the knob with the gas pump symbol.

Observe the following when refueling When handling fuels, follow the safety precautions posted at the filling station.

Otherwise, there is a danger of personal injury or property damage.<

Place the fuel filler cap in the bracket attached to the fuel filler door.

M o

b il

it y

219

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

When refueling, insert the filler nozzle com- pletely into the filler pipe. Avoid raising the filler nozzle during refueling, otherwise this leads to

> premature pump shutoff

> a reduced efficiency of the fuel-vapor recovery system.

The fuel tank is full when the filler nozzle clicks off the first time.

Fuel tank capacity Approx. 18.5 US gal/70 liters, including the reserve capacity of approx. 2.1 US gal/8 liters. 550i: approx. 2.6 US gal/10 liters reserve capacity.

Refuel as soon as possible once your cruising range falls below 30 miles/

50 km, otherwise engine functions are not ensured and damage can occur.<

Fuel filler cap

Closing Fit the cap and turn it clockwise until you clearly hear a click.

Do not crush the band attached to the cap; otherwise, the cap may not properly

seal and fuel vapors can escape.<

A message* is displayed if the cap is loose or missing.

Fuel specifications Do not use leaded gasoline, otherwise permanent damage to the catalytic con-

verter will result. Do not use E85, i.e. fuel that consists of 85% ethanol, or Flex Fuel. Otherwise permanent damage to the engine and the fuel supply sys- tem will result.<

Required fuel

Super Premium Gasoline/AKI 91 This gasoline is highly recommended.

However, you may also use gasoline with less AKI. The minimum AKI Rating is 87.

If you use gasoline with this minimum AKI Rat- ing, the engine may produce knocking sounds when starting at high outside temperatures. This has no affect on the engine life.

Do not use gasoline below the specified minimum quality, otherwise engine dam-

age can result.<

Use high-quality brands Field experience has indicated significant dif- ferences in fuel quality: volatility, composition, additives, etc., among gasolines offered for sale in the United States and Canada. Fuels contain- ing up to and including 10% ethanol or other oxygenates with up to 2.8% oxygen by weight, that is, 15% MTBE or 3% methanol plus an equivalent amount of co-solvent, will not void the applicable warranties with respect to defects in materials or workmanship.

The use of poor-quality fuels may result in drivability, starting and stalling problems

especially under certain environmental condi- tions such as high ambient temperature and high altitude. Should you encounter drivability problems which you suspect could be related to the fuel you are using, we recommend that you respond by switching to a recognized high-quality brand such as gasoline that is advertised as Top Tier Detergent Gasoline. Failure to comply with these recommendations may also result in unscheduled maintenance.<

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

220

Wheels and tires

Tire inflation pressure

Information for your safety The condition of the tires and the maintenance of the specified tire pressure are crucial not only to the tire's service life, but also to driving com- fort and most importantly, driving safety.

Checking pressure Only check tire inflation pressure when the tires are cold. This means after a maximum of 1.25 miles/2 km driving or when the vehicle has been parked for at least 2 hours. When tires are warm, the tire inflation pressure increases.

Check the tire inflation pressure regularly and correct it as needed, even on the

compact tire*: at least twice a month and before starting long trips. Otherwise driving instability or tire damage, and therefore accidents, can result from incorrect tire inflation pressures. Do not drive with depressurized, i.e. flat tires, except run-flat tires. A flat tire will seriously impair your vehicle's handling and braking response. Attempts to drive on a flat tire can lead to a loss of control over the vehicle.<

After correcting the tire inflation pressure, reinitialize the Flat Tire Monitor, refer to

page 95, or reset the Tire Pressure Monitor, refer to page 97.<

Pressure specifications The tables below provide all the correct inflation pressures for the specified tire sizes at ambient temperature.

The inflation pressures apply to the tire sizes and tire brands respectively

approved and recommended by BMW; a list of these is available from your BMW center.<

For correct identification of the right tire infla- tion pressure for your tires, observe the follow- ing:

> Tire sizes of your vehicle

> Load conditions

> Maximum allowable driving speed

Tire inflation pressures for speeds up to 100 mph/160 km/h For normal driving up to 100 mph/160 km/h, adjust pressures to the respective tire inflation pressures listed on the following pages in the column Traveling speeds up to max. 100 mph/ 160 km/h to achieve optimum driving comfort.

These pressure specifications can be found on the door post when you open the driver's door.

The permissible top speed for these tire inflation pressures is 100 mph/160 km/h.

Do not exceed this speed, otherwise tire dam- age and accidents may result.<

Tire inflation pressures for speeds above 100 mph/160 km/h

In order to drive at maximum speeds in excess of 100 mph/160 km/h, please

observe, and, if necessary, adjust tire pressures for speeds exceeding 100 mph/160 km/h from the relevant table on the following pages. Otherwise tire damage and accidents could occur.<

Observe all national and local maximum speed limits, otherwise violations of the law could occur.

M o

b il

it y

221

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

528i

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Compact wheel*: T 135/80 R 17 102 M

61/420

Traveling speeds up to max. of

100 mph/160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those exceeding

100 mph/160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

245/45 R 17 95 W 245/45 R 17 99 V M+S XL

32/220 33/230 32/220 33/230 35/240 42/290

225/50 R 17 94 V M+S 225/50 R 17 94 W 245/40 R 18 93 W 225/50 R 17 94 H M+S

32/220 36/250 32/220 35/240 36/250 44/300

245/40 R 18 97 V M+S XL 32/220 38/260 32/220 38/260 38/260 45/310

Front: 245/40 R 18 93 W Rear: 275/35 R 18 95 W

32/220 33/230 32/220 33/230 36/250 42/290

Front: 245/35 R 19 93 Y XL Rear: 275/30 R 19 96 Y XL

32/220 38/260 32/220 33/230 35/240 42/290

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 257.

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

222

535i

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Compact wheel*: T 135/80 R 17 102 M

61/420

Traveling speeds up to max. of

100 mph/160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those exceeding

100 mph/160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

245/45 R 17 95 W 225/55 R 16 95 H M+S 245/45 R 17 99 V M+S XL

32/220 35/240 32/220 33/230 35/240 42/290

225/50 R 17 94 M+S W 225/50 R 17 94 W 225/50 R 17 94 H M+S

32/220 36/250 32/220 35/240 38/260 45/310

245/40 R 18 93 W 32/220 38/260 32/220 35/240 38/260 45/310

245/40 R 18 97 V M+S XL 32/220 38/260 32/220 38/260 39/270 46/320

Front: 245/40 R 18 93 W Rear: 275/35 R 18 95 W

32/220 35/240 32/220 33/230 38/260 42/290

Front: 245/35 R 19 93 Y XL Rear: 275/30 R 19 96 Y XL

33/230 39/270 32/220 33/230 35/240 42/290

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 257.

M o

b il

it y

223

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

528xi

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Compact wheel*: T 135/80 R 17 102 M

61/420

Traveling speeds up to max. of

100 mph/160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those exceeding

100 mph/160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

245/45 R 17 95 W 245/45 R 17 99 V M+S XL

32/220 35/240 32/220 33/230 35/240 42/290

225/50 R 17 94 V M+S 225/50 R 17 94 W 225/50 R 17 94 H M+S 245/40 R 18 93 W 245/40 R 18 97 V M+S XL

32/220 36/250 32/220 36/250 38/260 45/310

Front: 245/40 R 18 93 W Rear: 275/35 R 18 95 W

32/220 35/240 32/220 33/230 38/260 42/290

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 257.

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

224

535xi

535xi Sports Wagon

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Compact wheel*: T 135/80 R 17 102 M

61/420

Traveling speeds up to max. of

100 mph/160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those exceeding

100 mph/160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

245/45 R 17 95 W 245/45 R 17 99 V M+S XL

32/220 35/240 32/220 33/230 35/240 42/290

225/50 R 17 94 W M+S 225/50 R 17 94 W 225/50 R 17 94 H M+S

32/220 36/250 32/220 36/250 38/260 45/310

245/40 R 18 93 W 33/230 36/250 33/230 36/250 38/260 45/310

245/40 R 18 97 V M+S XL 35/240 38/260 35/240 38/260 38/260 45/310

Front: 245/40 R 18 93 W Rear: 275/35 R 18 95 W

32/230 35/240 33/230 33/230 38/260 42/290

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 257.

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Compact wheel*: T 135/80 R 17 102 M

61/420

Traveling speeds up to max. of

100 mph/160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those exceeding

100 mph/160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

225/50 R 17 94 W M+S 225/50 R 17 94 W 245/45 R 17 95 W 225/50 R 17 94 H M+S 245/45 R 17 99 V M+S XL

33/230 41/280 33/230 41/280 38/260 45/310

245/40 R 18 93 Y 32/220 39/270 32/220 38/260 35/240 42/290

245/40 R 18 97 V M+S XL 36/250 44/300 36/250 44/300 41/280 48/330

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 258.

M o

b il

it y

225

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

550i

Tire identification marks Knowledge of the labeling on the side of the tire makes it easier to identify and choose the right tires.

Tire size

Speed letter Q= up to 100 mph/160 km/h

T = up to 118 mph/190 km/h

H = up to 131 mph/210 km/h

V = up to 150 mph/240 km/h

W = up to 167 mph/270 km/h

Y = up to 186 mph/300 km/h

Tire Identification Number Tires with DOT codes meet the guidelines of the U.S. Department of Transportation.

DOT code:

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Compact wheel*: T 135/80 R 17 102 M

61/420

Traveling speeds up to max. of

100 mph/160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those exceeding

100 mph/160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

245/40 R 18 93 Y 32/220 38/260 32/220 35/240 33/230 41/280

245/45 R 17 95 W 245/45 R 17 99 V M+S XL 225/50 R 17 94 H M+S 225/50 R 17 94 W

32/220 38/260 32/220 38/260 38/260 45/310

245/40 R 18 97 V M+S XL 33/230 39/270 33/230 39/270 39/270 46/320

Front: 245/40 R 18 93 Y Rear: 275/35 R 18 95 Y

32/220 35/240 32/220 32/220 33/230 38/260

Front: 245/35 R 19 93 Y XL Rear: 275/30 R 19 96 Y XL

35/240 39/270 33/230 38/260 38/260 45/310

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 257.

e.g.

Nominal width in mm Aspect ratio in Belted construction radial Rim diameter in inches Carrying capacity ID-code (not in ZR tires) Speed code letter (in ZR tires before the R)

225/50 R 17 94 W

e.g.

Manufacturer code for tire make Tire size and tire design Tire age

DOT xxxx xxx 3307

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

226

Tire age The manufacturing date of tires is contained in the tire coding: DOT ... 3307 indicates that the tire was manufactured in week 33 of 2007.

BMW recommends that you replace all tires after 6 years at most, even if some tires may last for 10 years.

Uniform Tire Quality Grading Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width. For example:

Tread wear 200 Traction AA Temperature A

DOT Quality Grades Tread wear Traction AA A B C Temperature A B C

All passenger car tires must conform to Federal Safety Requirements in addition

to these grades.<

Tread wear The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified gov- ernment test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half (1) times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, how- ever, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteris- tics and climate.

Traction The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. These grades represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement, as measured under con- trolled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.

The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction

tests, and does not include acceleration, cor- nering, hydroplaning, or peak traction charac- teristics.<

Temperature The temperature grades are A, the highest, B, and C, representing the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehi- cle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.

The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly

inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either sep- arately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.<

RSC run-flat tires You will recognize run-flat tires by a circular symbol containing the letters RSC on the side of the tire, refer to page 227.

M+S Winter and all-season tires. These have better winter properties than sum- mer tires.

XL Indicates specially reinforced tires.

M o

b il

it y

227

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Tire condition Inspect your tires frequently for tread wear, signs of damage and for foreign objects lodged in the tread. Check the tread depth.

Minimum tread depth The tread depth should not drop below 0.12 in/ 3 mm, although, for example, European legisla- tion only specifies a minimum tread depth of 0.063 in/1.6 mm. At tread depths below 0.12 in/ 3 mm there is an increased risk of high-speed hydroplaning, even when only small amounts of water are present on the road surface. When winter tires wear down past a tread depth of 0.16 in/4 mm, they become perceptibly less suitable for winter conditions. For the sake of safety, new tires should be installed.

Wear indicators at the tread-groove base, refer to arrow, are distributed over the tire's circum- ference and are marked on the side of the tire with TWI Tread Wear Indicator. If the tire tread has been driven down to the wear indicators, a tread depth of 0.063 in/1.6 mm has been reached.

Wheel/tire damage Please note that low-profile tires cause wheels, tires and suspension parts to be more suscep- tible to road hazards and consequential dam- ages. Unusual vibrations encountered during normal vehicle operation can indicate tire failure or some other vehicle defect. This can, for exam- ple, be caused by driving over curbs. These kinds of problems may also be signaled by other changes in vehicle response, such as a strong tendency to pull to the left or right.

In these cases, reduce speed immedi- ately and have wheels and tires thor-

oughly checked. To do so, drive carefully to the nearest BMW center or tire shop that works according to BMW repair procedures with cor- respondingly trained personnel. If necessary, have the vehicle towed there. Otherwise, tire damage can be extremely dangerous to vehicle occupants and other road users.<

Run-flat tires*

You will recognize run-flat tires by the circular symbol containing the letters RSC on the side of the tire. Run-flat tires consist of partially self-contained tires and special rims. The sidewall reinforce- ment ensures that the tire retains some residual safety in the event of pressure drop and driving remains possible to a restricted degree.

To continue driving with a damaged tire:

> With Flat Tire Monitor, refer to Indication of a flat tire, page 96

> With Tire Pressure Monitor, refer to Mes- sage with low tire inflation pressure, page 98

New wheels and tires Have new wheels and tires installed only by your BMW center or tire shop that

works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel. If this work is not carried out properly, there is a dan- ger of subsequent damage and related safety hazards. Make sure that the new wheels are bal- anced.<

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

228

Retreaded tires BMW does not recommend that you use retreaded tires, as driving safety may be

impaired. The causes for this include the possi- bly different tire casing structures and the often wide variations in their age, which can result in a limited service life.<

The right wheels and tires BMW recommends that you use only wheel and tire combinations that BMW

has tested and approved for your particular vehicle. Variations in factors such as manufac- turing tolerances mean that even wheels and tires with identical official size ratings could actually have different dimensions than the approved units these differences could lead to body contact, and with it the risk of severe acci- dents. If non-approved wheels and tires are used, BMW cannot evaluate their suitability, and therefore cannot be held liable for driving safety.<

You can inquire about the right wheel/tire com- bination at your BMW center.

The correct wheel/tire combination also affects various systems whose function would other- wise be impaired, e.g. ABS, DSC or xDrive.

To maintain good handling and vehicle response, use only tires of a single tread config- uration from a single manufacturer. Following tire damage, have the original wheel and tire combination remounted on the vehicle as soon as possible.

Wheels with electronics for TPM Tire Pressure Monitor When mounting new tires or converting from summer to winter tires or vice versa, only use wheels with TPM electronics, otherwise the Tire Pressure Monitor cannot detect a flat tire, refer to page 97. Your BMW center will be happy to advise you on this subject.

Recommended tire brands

Certain tire makes are recommended by BMW depending on the tire size. You can recognize these from the clearly visible BMW marking on the tire sidewall.

When used properly, these tires comply with the most demanding standards for safety and vehicle response.

Run-flat tires When mounting new tires, or changing from summer to winter tires or vice versa, use run-flat tires for your own safety. In addition, no spare tire is available in case of a flat tire. Your BMW center will be glad to advise you.

For safety reasons, BMW recommends that you do not have damaged run-flat

tires repaired; they should be replaced. Other- wise it is not possible to rule out occurrences of consequential damage.<

Special characteristics of winter tires BMW recommends winter tires for use in cold winter driving conditions. Although all-season M+S tires provide better winter traction than summer tires, they generally fail to provide the same levels of cold-weather performance as winter tires.

Paying attention to speed Always observe the maximum permissi- ble speed for the winter tires, otherwise

tire damage may occur, which can result in acci- dents.<

M o

b il

it y

229

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Storage Store wheels and tires in a cool, dry place with as little exposure to light as possible. Always protect tires against all contact with oil, grease and fuels. Do not exceed the maximum tire inflation pressure indicated on the side wall of the tire.

Rotating wheels between axles BMW does not recommend moving the front wheels to the rear or vice versa, as otherwise the handling characteristics may be impaired. With tires of different makes and types* such a change is not permissible.

Snow chains* BMW only tests certain fine-link snow chains, classifies them as road-safe and recommends them. Consult your BMW center for more infor- mation.

Use is only permissible in pairs on the rear wheels.

Observe the manufacturer's instructions when mounting snow chains. Do not exceed a speed of 30 mph/50 km/h with the chains mounted.

After mounting snow chains, do not ini- tialize the Flat Tire Monitor, otherwise

incorrect displays can occur. When driving with snow chains, it may be prac- tical to briefly activate DTC, refer to page 92.<

U n

d er

th e

h o

o d

230

Under the hood

Never attempt to perform any service or repair operations on your vehicle without

the required professional technical training. If you do not know what repair procedures to follow, have work on your vehicle done only by your BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with cor- respondingly trained personnel. If this work is not carried out properly, there is a danger of subsequent damage and related safety haz- ards.<

Hood

Releasing

Pull lever.

Opening

Press the release handle and open the hood.

Closing

Close the hood from a height of approx. 16 in/ 40 cm with momentum. It must be clearly heard to engage.

Make sure that the closing path of the hood is clear, otherwise injuries may

result. If you see any signs that the hood is not com- pletely closed while driving your vehicle, you should stop at once and close it securely.<

M o

b il

it y

231

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Engine compartment

1 Filler spout for engine oil, refer to Adding engine oil

2 Starting-aid terminal, refer to page 248

3 Filler neck for washer fluid of the headlamp and windshield cleaning systems, refer to page 69

4 Expansion tank for coolant, refer to page 233

U n

d er

th e

h o

o d

232

Engine oil The engine oil consumption is dependent on driving style and driving conditions.

Checking engine oil level Your vehicle is equipped with an electronic oil level check.

The condition for the most accurate indication of the oil level possible is measurement with the engine at operating temperature, i.e. following an uninterrupted drive of at least 6 miles/10 km. You can display the oil level on the Control Dis- play while driving or when stopped on a level surface with the engine running.

iDrive, for operating principle refer to page 16.

1. Press the button. This opens the start menu.

2. Press the controller to open the menu.

3. Turn the controller until "Info sources" is selected and press the controller.

4. Turn the controller until "Service Info" is selected and press the controller.

5. Change to upper field if necessary. Turn the controller until "Service requirements" is selected and press the controller.

6. Change to the second field from the top if necessary. Turn the controller until "Engine oil level" is selected and press the control- ler. The oil level is displayed.

Possible messages > "Engine oil level O.K."

> "No measurement available: Updating engine oil level measurement...": Engine oil level is being measured. This process can take approx. 1 minute when stopped on a level surface with the engine running and approx. 5 minutes while driv- ing. If the engine oil has been topped off, the measurement of the oil level can take up to 30 minutes.

> "Oil level at the minimum! Refill with 1 quart of engine oil.": Add a maximum of 1 US quart/1 liter of engine oil at the next opportunity, refer to Adding engine oil below. Add at least 0.5 US quart/0.5 liter. Otherwise the oil level control may not display the new value correctly. If the oil level displayed is below minimum, add engine oil immediately. Failure to do so may lead to engine damage.

> "Engine oil level too high"*:

Have the vehicle checked immedi- ately, otherwise engine damage may

result if too much oil has been added.<

> "Please observe recalculated service inter- val for engine oil": Do not add engine oil. Before continuing to drive, note the recalculated remaining mile- age until the next oil change service, refer to Service requirements on page 81. Have the system checked as soon as possible.

M o

b il

it y

233

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Adding engine oil

Do not add 1 US quart/1 liter of oil until a corre- sponding message is shown on the Control Dis- play.

Add oil within the next 125 miles/200 km, otherwise the engine could be dam-

aged.<

Continuous exposure to used oil has caused cancer in laboratory testing.

For this reason, any skin areas that come into contact with oil should be thoroughly washed with soap and water. Keep oil, grease etc. out of reach of children and observe the warnings on the containers to pre- vent health risks.<

Oil change Have oil changed only at your BMW center or at a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel.

Approved engine oils The quality of the engine oil selected has critical significance for the operation and service life of an engine. BMW continuously approves spe- cific oils after confirming their suitability for use in its vehicles with extensive testing.

Do not use oil additives, as these may result in engine damage.<

Only use approved BMW High Performance Synthetic Oil.

If BMW High Performance Synthetic Oil is unavailable, you can add small quantities of other synthetic oils between oil changes. Only use oils of the specification API SM or higher.

Your BMW center will be happy to answer detailed questions on BMW High Perfor-

mance Synthetic Oil or approved synthetic oils.<

You can also call BMW of North America at 1-800-831-1117 or visit the website at www.bmwusa.com to obtain this information.

Viscosity grades Viscosity is a measure of an oil's flow rating and is specified in SAE grades.

The choice of the right SAE grade is based on the climatic conditions in the region in which you normally drive your BMW.

Approved oils belong to the SAE grades 5W-40 and 5W-30.<

These oils can be used for driving at all outside temperatures.

Coolant Do not add coolant to the cooling system when the engine is hot. Escaping coolant

can cause burns.<

Coolant is composed of equal parts water and a coolant additive. Not all commercially available additives are suitable for your BMW. Ask your BMW center for suitable additives.

Only use suitable additives, otherwise engine damage may result. The additives

present a health hazard; observe the instruc- tions on the containers.<

Comply with the appropriate environ- mental protection regulations when dis-

posing of coolant additives.<

Checking coolant level 1. Do not open the hood until the engine has

cooled down.

2. Turn the cap of the expansion tank counter- clockwise to allow any accumulated pres- sure to escape, then continue turning to open.

U n

d er

th e

h o

o d

234

3. The coolant level is correct when the cool- ant level is between the MIN and MAX marks, refer to the diagram adjacent to the filler neck.

4. If the coolant is low, slowly add coolant up to the specified level do not overfill.

5. Turn the cap until there is an audible click.

6. Have the reason for the coolant loss elimi- nated as soon as possible.

M o

b il

it y

235

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Maintenance

BMW maintenance system

The BMW maintenance system supports the preservation of the traffic and operating safety of your BMW. The ultimate objective is to ensure economical maintenance by providing the ideal service for your vehicle.

Should the day come when you decide to sell your BMW, a complete dealer service history will prove to be an asset of inestimable value.

CBS Condition Based Service Sensors and special algorithms take the differ- ent driving conditions of your BMW into account. Condition Based Service uses this to determine the current and future service requirements. By letting you define a service and maintenance regimen that reflects your own individual requirements, the system builds the basis for trouble-free driving.

You can set the Control Display to show remaining distances and times of selected maintenance intervals and legally mandated deadlines, refer to page 81:

> Engine oil

> Brake pads, front and rear separately

> Brake fluid

> Vehicle check

> Legally mandated inspections depending on local regulations

Service data in remote control Your vehicle stores the information required maintenance continuously in the remote con- trol during driving. After accessing the data stored in the remote control, your BMW Service Advisor can suggest precisely the right array of service procedures for your own individual vehi- cle. You should therefore hand over the remote control you last used to drive to the BMW Ser- vice Advisor when you take your vehicle in for service.

Make sure the date is set correctly, refer to page 87, otherwise the effectiveness

of CBS Condition Based Service is not ensured.<

Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models Please consult your Service and Warranty Infor- mation Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models for additional information on service require- ments.

BMW recommends that you have service and repair operations performed at your

BMW center. Take the time to ensure that these service pro- cedures are confirmed by entries in your vehi- cle's Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models. These entries verify that your vehicle has received the speci- fied regular maintenance.<

M ai

n te

n an

ce

236

Socket for OBD Onboard Diagnostics interface

Components which are decisive for the exhaust-gas composition can be checked via the OBD socket with a device.

This socket is located to the left on the driver's side, on the underside of the instrument panel under a cover.

Exhaust-gas values The warning lamp lights up. The exhaust-gas values worsen. Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible.

Display of the previously described malfunction in Canadian models.

The lamp flashes under certain conditions. This is a sign of excessive misfiring of the engine. In this case you should reduce speed and drive to the nearest BMW center as soon as possible. Heavy engine misfiring causes serious damage to the emission-relevant components, espe- cially the catalytic converter, within a short time.

If the fuel filler cap is not properly tight- ened, the OBD system will assume that

fuel vapor escapes. Then a display lights up. If the cap is then tightened, the display will go out within a few days.<

Event Data Recorders Your vehicle may be equipped with one or sev- eral measuring and diagnosis modules, or with a device for recording or transmitting certain vehicle data or information. If you have also sub- scribed to BMW Assist, certain vehicle data can be transmitted or recorded to enable corre- sponding services.

Care Important information on the care and mainte- nance of your BMW is contained in the Caring for your vehicle brochure.

M o

b il

it y

237

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Replacing components

Onboard toolkit

Sedan

The onboard toolkit is located in the luggage compartment lid.

Loosen the wing nut to open.

Sports Wagon

The onboard toolkit is located in the left side panel of the cargo bay.

Wiper blade replacement

Front

1. Fold the wiper arm out and grasp firmly.

2. Press the safety tabs together while sliding the wiper blade toward the front to disen- gage it.

3. Mount the new wiper blade and slide in until it is heard to engage.

Rear*

1. Lift off the wiper arm completely and pull off the wiper blade, refer to arrow.

2. Mount the new wiper blade and press on until it is heard to engage.

R ep

la ci

n g

c o

m p

o n

en ts

238

Lamps and bulbs Lamps and bulbs make an essential contribu- tion to vehicle safety. You must be duly diligent in replacing them. BMW recommends having your BMW center perform any work that you do not feel competent to perform yourself or that is not described here.

Never touch the glass of new bulbs with your bare fingers, as even minute

amounts of contamination will burn into the bulb's surface and reduce its service life. Use a clean cloth, napkin, etc., or hold the bulb by its metal socket.<

A selection of replacement bulbs is available at your BMW center.

Only replace bulbs when cool, as other- wise you may be burned.<

Whenever you perform any work on the electrical system, turn off the systems/

consumers involved to prevent short circuits from occurring. To avoid possible injury or equipment damage when replacing bulbs, observe any instructions provided by the bulb manufacturer.<

For care and maintenance of the headlamps, please follow the instructions in the separate Caring for your vehicle brochure.

For bulbs for which changing is not described, and for checking and adjusting

headlamp aim, please contact your BMW cen- ter.<

Light-emitting diodes LEDs Light-emitting diodes installed behind translu- cent lenses serve as the light source for many of the controls and displays in your vehicle. These light-emitting diodes, which operate using a concept similar to that applied in conventional lasers, are officially designated as Class 1 light- emitting diodes.

Do not remove the covers, and never stare into the unfiltered light for several

hours, as irritation of the retina could result.<

Halogen headlamps The illustration shows the left-hand side of the engine compartment.

1 Cover cap for low beams

2 Cover cap for high beams

To remove the cover caps:

> Low beams: press the detent, arrow, and remove the cover from the guide.

> High beams: turn the cover cap to the left and remove.

Always wear gloves and eye protection the atmosphere within the H7 bulb is

pressurized. Otherwise there is a danger of inju- ries if the bulb is accidentally damaged during replacement.<

M o

b il

it y

239

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Low beams H7 bulb, 55 watts

1. Turn the bulb holder to the left and remove.

2. Remove and replace the bulb.

High beams H7 bulb, 55 watts

1. Turn the bulb holder to the left and remove.

2. Remove and replace the bulb.

Parking and roadside parking lamps In the event of a malfunction, please go to your BMW center or a workshop that works accord- ing to BMW repair procedures with correspond- ingly trained personnel.

Xenon lamps* The service life of these bulbs is very long and the probability of a failure is very low, provided that they are not switched on and off an unusual number of times. If one of these bulbs should nevertheless fail, it is possible to continue driv- ing with great caution using the fog lamps, pro- vided traffic laws in your area do not prohibit this.

Have work on the xenon lighting system performed only by your BMW center or a

workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained per- sonnel. Due to the high voltage present in the system, there is a danger of fatal injuries when work is carried out improperly.<

Access to lamps The illustration shows the left-hand side of the engine compartment.

1 Cover cap for parking and roadside parking lamps, daytime running lamps

2 Sealing cap for turning lamps* To remove the covers:

> Parking lamps and roadside parking lamps, daytime running lamps: turn the cover cap to the left and remove.

> Turning lamps: turn the sealing cap to the left and remove.

Parking lamps and roadside parking lamps, daytime running lamps H8 bulb, 35 watts

1. Turn the bulb in the direction of the arrow, in the opposite direction on the other side, and remove.

R ep

la ci

n g

c o

m p

o n

en ts

240

2. Remove the connector and replace the bulb.

Turning lamps* H3 bulb, 55 watts

1. Remove the sealing cap, refer to Access to lamps.

2. Push the locking bar to the side out of the anchor and fold upward.

3. Remove the connector and take out the bulb.

4. Replace the bulb and reinstall.

5. Fold down the locking bar and engage it.

6. Reconnect the connector.

7. Mount the sealing cap. Watch the markings on the bulb when doing so.

Turn signals, front 21-watt bulb, PY21W

1. Turn the bulb holder to the left and remove.

2. Apply gentle pressure to the bulb while turning it to the left for removal and replace- ment.

Side-mounted turn signals 5-watt bulb, W5W

1. Press back against the front edge of the lamp with the tip of your finger, then pivot it out.

2. Turn the bulb holder to the left and remove.

3. Remove the bulb for replacement.

Side marker lamps, front and rear To replace, please go to your BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained per- sonnel.

Tail lamps

Sedan > Turn signals 1, tail lamps 6 and side marker

lamps 7 are designed using LED technol- ogy. In the event of a malfunction, please go to your BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel.

> Backup lamps: 16-watt bulb, W16W

> Other lamps: 21-watt bulb, P21W

M o

b il

it y

241

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

1 Turn signal

2 Tail lamp and brake lamp

3 Backup lamp

4 Brake lamp

5 Reflector

6 Tail lamp

7 Side marker lamp

Sports Wagon > Turn signals 1, tail lamps 3 and side marker

lamps 7 are designed using LED technol- ogy. In the event of a malfunction, please go to your BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel.

> Backup lamps: 16-watt bulb, W16W

> Brake lamps: 21-watt bulb, P21W

1 Turn signal

2 Brake lamp

3 Tail lamp

4 Backup lamp

5 Brake lamp

6 Reflector

7 Side marker lamp

Center brake lamp This lamp uses LED technology for operation. In the event of a malfunction, please go to your BMW center or a workshop that works accord- ing to BMW repair procedures with correspond- ingly trained personnel.

Fender-mounted lamps

Sedan The illustration shows the left-hand side of the cargo bay.

All the bulbs are integrated into a central bulb fitting.

1. Lift up floor mat.

2. Undo the quick-release fasteners of the side panel and pull out the panel.

3. Turn the lock to the left and remove the bulb holder.

4. Backup lamps: Remove and replace the bulb. Other lamps: Apply gentle pressure to the bulb while turning it to the left for removal and replace- ment.

Sports Wagon 1. Right side: unhook the retaining strap*,

refer to page 130.

2. Open the side panel.

3. Turn the bulb socket to the left and remove.

4. Apply gentle pressure to the bulb while turning it to the left for removal and replace- ment.

R ep

la ci

n g

c o

m p

o n

en ts

242

Lamps in luggage compartment lid

License plate lamp 5-watt bulb, C5W

1. Insert screwdriver into the slot and press to the right, refer to arrows. This releases the lamp.

2. Remove the lamp and replace the bulb.

Sports Wagon: Brake lamp and backup lamp 1. Turn the locks to the left and fold down the

trim.

2. Fold down the foam insulation.

3. Pull out the bulb holder for the backup lamp 1 or brake lamp 2 downward.

4. Backup lamp: remove the bulb for replace- ment. Brake lamp: apply gentle pressure to the bulb while turning it to the left for removal and replacement.

Changing wheels Safety precautions in the event of a flat tire or wheel change: park the vehicle as

far as possible from passing traffic and on solid ground. Switch on the hazard warning flashers. Have all vehicle occupants get out of the vehicle and ensure that they remain outside the imme- diate area in a safe place, such as behind a guardrail. If a warning triangle* or portable hazard warning lamp* is required, set it up on the roadside at an appropriate distance from the rear of the vehi- cle. Comply with all safety guidelines and regu- lations. Change the wheel only on a level, firm surface which is not slippery. The vehicle or the jack could slip to the side if you attempt to raise the vehicle on a soft or slippery surface such as snow, ice, tiles, etc. Position the jack on a firm support surface. Do not use a wooden block or similar object as a support base for the jack, as this would prevent it from extending to its full support height and reduce its load-carrying capacity. To avoid serious or fatal injury: never lie under the vehicle, and never start the engine while it is supported by the jack.<

M o

b il

it y

243

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

What you will need To avoid rattling noises later on, note the posi- tions of the tools before removing them, then return them to their initial positions after com- pleting work.

1 Chock* 2 Vehicle jack* 3 Lug wrench* The tools are located in the mount under the floor mat or floor panel flap.

1. Lift up floor mat or floor panel flap and cover located beneath it.

2. Take out the required tools.

3. After using the tools, return them to the storage space.

With run-flat tires, no tools are provided for wheel changes. They can be pur-

chased as accessories at your BMW center.<

Sports Wagon: removing and installing floor panel flap of storage area package 1. Unhook the roll-up cover at the rear.

2. Raise the floor panel flap.

3. Unhook the two catch straps at the top.

4. Unlock the gas spring strut, refer to arrow, and remove.

5. Fold over the floor panel flap toward the front to release it and remove.

6. Open the front floor panel flap.

7. Swing up the spare tire cover and hook the hooks into the upper frame of the tailgate opening.

8. Take out the cross support upward.

When installing the floor panel flap, proceed in the reverse order and press down the hinge covers.

R ep

la ci

n g

c o

m p

o n

en ts

244

Compact wheel*

1. Unscrew the wing nut 1.

2. Remove the washer 2 laterally.

3. Take out the tool mounts 3.

4. Remove the compact wheel.

Preparing wheel change 1. Observe the safety precautions above.

2. Prevent the vehicle from rolling: Place the chock behind the front wheel on the other side of the vehicle, or on inclines, in front of this wheel. On steeply inclined roads, always secure the vehicle against rolling.

3. Loosen the lug bolts a half turn.

Jacking up vehicle 1. Position the vehicle jack at the jacking point

closest to the wheel so that the entire sur- face of the jack base rests on the ground perpendicularly beneath the jacking point.

The vehicle jack is designed for changing wheels only. Do not attempt

to raise another vehicle model with it or to raise any load of any kind. To do so could cause accidents and personal injury.<

2. Guide the jack head into the rectangular recess of the jacking point when cranking up, refer to illustration detail.

3. Jack the vehicle up until the wheel you are changing is raised from the ground.

Mounting a wheel 1. Unscrew the lug bolts and remove the

wheel.

2. Remove accumulations of mud or dirt from the mounting surfaces of the wheel and hub. Also clean the lug bolts.

3. Position the new wheel or compact wheel. Secure the wheel by screwing at least two lug bolts into opposite bolt holes. When you mount wheels other than Genu- ine BMW light-alloy wheels, different lug bolts may also be required.

4. Screw in the remaining lug bolts. Tighten all the bolts securely in a diagonal pattern.

5. Lower the vehicle and remove the jack from beneath the vehicle.

After mounting 1. Tighten the lug bolts in a diagonal pattern.

To ensure safety, always have the lug bolts checked with a calibrated

torque wrench as soon as possible to ensure that they are tightened to the speci- fied torque. Otherwise, incorrectly tight- ened lug bolts are a hidden safety risk. The tightening torque is 88.5 lb ft/120 Nm.<

2. When stowing the wheel and tools in the vehicle, execute these steps in the reverse order.

3. Check and correct the tire inflation pressure at the earliest opportunity.

M o

b il

it y

245

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Protect valve stems with valve stem seal caps against dirt and contamina-

tion. Dirt in valve stems is a frequent source of gradual air loss.<

4. Initialize the Flat Tire Monitor, refer to page 95, or reset the Tire Pressure Monitor, refer to page 97.

5. Replace the damaged tire as soon as possi- ble and have the new wheel/tire balanced.

Driving with compact wheel Drive reservedly and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.

The driving characteristics change, for example reduced track stability on braking, extended braking distance, and altered self-steering characteristics in the limit range. In conjunction with winter tires, these characteristics are more pronounced.

Only one compact wheel may be mounted. Restore the wheels and tires to

their original size as quickly as possible. Failure to do so is a safety risk.<

Vehicle battery

Battery care The battery is 100% maintenance-free, i.e., the electrolyte will last for the life of the battery when the vehicle is operated in a temperate cli- mate. Your BMW center will be glad to advise in all matters concerning the battery.

Charging battery Only charge the battery in the vehicle via the terminals in the engine compartment with the engine switched off. Connections, refer to Jump starting on page 248.

Disposal Have old batteries disposed of by your BMW center or hand them in to a recy-

cling center. Maintain the battery in an upright position for transport and storage. Always restrain the battery to prevent it from tipping over during transport.<

Power failure After a temporary power supply interruption, some settings are lost. Take the following steps:

> Seat, mirror and steering wheel memory Store the positions again, refer to page 48.

> Time and date Reset, refer to text starting on page 86.

> Radio Store stations again, refer to page 174.

> Navigation system Wait until the system starts, refer to page 142.

Fuses Never attempt to repair a blown fuse and do not replace a defective fuse with a sub-

stitute of another color or amperage rating, as this could lead to a circuit overload, ultimately resulting in a fire in the vehicle.<

Sedan Spare fuses, plastic tweezers and fuse alloca- tion diagram are located in the compartment for the onboard tool kit, refer to page 237.

Sports Wagon Spare fuses and a pair of plastic tweezers are contained in the onboard tool kit, refer to page 237. A fuse allocation diagram is located in the cargo bay behind the right-hand side panel.

R ep

la ci

n g

c o

m p

o n

en ts

246

In glove compartment 1. Release both quick-release fasteners.

2. Fold the cover forward or remove.

Sedan: in cargo bay 1. Lift up floor mat.

2. Release the quick-release fastener of the right side panel and pull out the panel.

Sports Wagon: in cargo bay

1. Unhook the retaining strap*, refer to page 130.

2. Open the right-hand side panel.

M o

b il

it y

247

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Giving and receiving assistance

Emergency request Conditions for an emergency request:

> Full preparation package mobile phone. With this equipment, an emergency request is still possible when no mobile phone is paired in the vehicle.

> BMW Assist is activated. Activating BMW Assist, refer to page 214.

> Radio readiness is activated.

> The BMW Assist system is logged on to a mobile phone network.

> The emergency request system is opera- ble.

Once your BMW Assist subscription expires, the BMW Assist system can be deactivated by a BMW center without you having to visit a workshop. Once the BMW Assist system has been deactivated, emergency requests are not possible. The BMW Assist system can be reac- tivated by a BMW center after signing a new contract.

Initiating an emergency request 1. Briefly press protective cover to open.

Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the arrangement of the switches and indicator lamps may differ somewhat.

2. Press the SOS button for at least 2 seconds.

The LED in the button lights up. As soon as the voice connection to the BMW Assist Response Center has been established, the LED flashes.

Even if you are unable to answer, the BMW Assist Response Center can take further steps to help you under certain conditions.

If conditions allow, remain in the vehicle until the connection has been established. You will then be able to provide a detailed description of the situation.

If the current position of your vehicle can be determined, it will be transmitted to the BMW Assist Response Center.

If the LED is flashing but the BMW Assist Response Center cannot be heard over the hands-free system, it is possible that the hands-free system is malfunctioning. You may still be heard by the BMW Assist Response Center, however.

Under certain conditions, an emergency request is automatically initiated immediately after a severe accident. The automatic collision notification is not affected by the button being pressed.

For technical reasons, the emergency request cannot be guaranteed under unfavorable condi- tions.

You can also use other services of BMW Assist with this button, refer to

page 209.<

Warning triangle* The warning triangle is located in the luggage compartment lid/tailgate.

G iv

in g

a n

d re

ce iv

in g

a ss

is ta

n ce

248

Sedan

Loosen the wing nut to open.

Sports Wagon

Release the two quick-release fasteners and fold down the trim piece.

First-aid kit* Some of the articles contained in the first-aid kit have a limited service life. Therefore, check the expiration dates of the contents regularly and replace the contents concerned in good time if necessary.

Sedan

The first-aid kit is located in the luggage com- partment lid.

Loosen the wing nut to open.

Sports Wagon

The first-aid kit is located in the right side panel of the cargo bay. Before opening the side panel, pull the retaining strap* toward the rear by its rear end and unhook it.

Roadside Assistance* The Roadside Assistance of the BMW Group offers you assistance in the event of a break- down around the clock, including on weekends and public holidays.

The phone numbers of the Roadside Assis- tance in your home country can be found in the Contact brochure.

With BMW Assist you can contact the Roadside Assistance of the BMW Group for assistance in the event of a breakdown directly via iDrive, refer to page 210.

Jump starting When your battery is discharged, you can use two jumper cables to start your BMW with power from the battery in a second vehicle. You can also use the same method to help start another vehicle. Use only jumper cables with fully-insulated clamp handles.

To avoid the risk of potentially fatal injury, always avoid all contact with electrical

components while the engine is running. Care- fully adhere to the following sequence, both to prevent damage to one or both vehicles, and to guard against possible personal injuries.<

M o

b il

it y

249

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Preparation 1. Check whether the battery of the other

vehicle has a voltage of 12 Volts and approximately the same capacitance in Ah. This information can be found on the bat- tery.

2. Switch off the engine of the assisting vehi- cle.

3. Switch off any electrical systems and com- ponents in both vehicles.

There must not be any contact between the bodies of the two vehicles, otherwise

there is a danger of shorting.<

Connecting jumper cables To avoid personal injury from sparks, follow this sequence when connecting

jumper cables.<

In your BMW, the so-called jump-starting termi- nal in the engine compartment serves as a pos- itive terminal for the battery, also refer to engine compartment overview on page 231. The cover cap is marked with a +.

1. Fold open the cover of the BMW jump- starting terminal. To do so, pull the tab.

2. Attach one end of the jumper cable plus/+ to the positive terminal of the battery or a jump-starting terminal of the vehicle provid- ing assistance.

3. Attach the second end of the cable to the positive terminal of the battery or to a start- ing-aid terminal of the vehicle to be started.

4. Attach one end of the jumper cable minus/ to the negative terminal of the battery or to an engine or body ground of the assisting vehicle.

Your BMW has a special nut as body ground or negative terminal.

5. Attach the second end of the cable to the negative terminal of the battery or to the engine or body ground of the vehicle to be started.

Starting engine 1. Start the engine on the assisting vehicle

and allow it to run at idle for several minutes at slightly increased speed.

2. Start the engine on the other vehicle in the usual way. If the first starting attempt is not successful, wait a few minutes before another attempt in order to allow the discharged battery to recharge.

3. Let the engines run for a few minutes.

4. Disconnect the jumper cables by reversing the connection sequence.

Check the battery and recharge if necessary.

Never use spray fluids to start the engine.<

Tow-starting and towing Observe applicable laws and regulations for tow-starting and towing.<

Do not transport any passengers other than the driver in a vehicle that is being

towed.<

Using tow fitting Always keep the screw-in tow fitting with the vehicle. It can be screwed in at the front or rear of the BMW.

G iv

in g

a n

d re

ce iv

in g

a ss

is ta

n ce

250

Sedan: It is located in the toolkit in the luggage com- partment lid, refer to page 237.

Sports Wagon: It is located in the toolkit behind the left side panel in the cargo bay, refer to page 237.

Use only the tow fitting provided with the vehicle and screw it all the way in. Use the

tow fitting for towing only on roads. Avoid lateral loading of the tow fitting, e.g. do not lift the vehi- cle by the tow fitting. Otherwise damage to the tow fitting and the vehicle can occur.<

Access to screw thread Press the arrow symbol on the cover in the bumper.

Front

Rear

Being towed Make sure that the ignition is switched on, refer to page 61, otherwise the low

beams, tail lamps, turn signals and windshield wipers would not be available. Do not tow the vehicle with the rear axle raised, as otherwise the steering can turn to the left or right. When the engine is stopped, there is no power assist.

This then requires increased effort for braking and steering. Active steering is deactivated and larger steering wheel movements are required.<

Switch on the hazard warning flashers depend- ing on the local regulations. If the electrical sys- tem fails, mark the vehicle to be towed, e.g. with a sign or warning triangle in the rear window.

Manual transmission Gearshift lever in neutral position.

Automatic and sport automatic transmission

Before towing, manually release the transmission lock, even if there is no mal-

function in the transmission. Otherwise there is a risk that the transmission lock will automati- cally be engaged during towing.<

Manually unlocking and locking transmission lock, refer to page 65.

Do not exceed a towing speed of 45 mph/ 70 km/h and a towing distance of

90 miles/150 km, otherwise the automatic transmission may be damaged.<

Towing methods Do not lift vehicle by tow fitting or body and chassis parts, otherwise damage may

result.<

In some countries, towing with tow bars or ropes in public traffic is not permitted. Familiar- ize yourself with the regulations on towing in the respective country.

With tow bar The towing vehicle may not be lighter than the vehicle to be towed, otherwise it

will not be possible to reliably control vehicle response.<

The tow fittings used should be on the same side on both vehicles. Should it prove impossi- ble to avoid mounting the tow bar at an offset angle, please observe the following:

> Clearance and maneuvering capability will be sharply limited during cornering.

M o

b il

it y

251

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

> When mounted at an angle, the tow bar will exert lateral forces, tending to push the vehicle sideways.

Only attach the tow bar to the tow fittings, as attachment to other vehicle parts can

lead to damage.<

With tow rope When starting off in the towing vehicle, make sure that the tow rope is taut.

To avoid jerking and the associated stresses on vehicle components when

towing, always use nylon ropes or nylon straps. Only attach tow ropes to the tow fittings, as attachment to other vehicle parts can lead to damage.<

With tow truck

Have the BMW transported with a tow truck with a so-called lift bar or on a flat bed.

With tow truck for 528xi, 535xi Do not tow a BMW with xDrive with just the front or rear axle raised, otherwise the

wheels could lock up and the transfer case could be damaged.<

Have the vehicle transported on a flatbed sur- face only.

Tow-starting Do not tow-start the vehicle if possible, but instead start the engine by means of jump start- ing, refer to page 248. With a catalytic con- verter, tow-starting should only be carried out with the engine cold, and with automatic trans- missions, the engine cannot be started by tow- starting.

1. Switch on the hazard warning flashers, comply with country-specific regulations.

2. Switch on the ignition, refer to page 61.

3. Shift into 3rd gear.

4. Tow-start with the clutch completely depressed and slowly release the clutch. After the engine starts, immediately depress the clutch again completely.

5. Stop at a suitable location, remove the tow bar or rope and switch off the hazard warn- ing flashers.

6. Have the vehicle checked.

Reference This chapter contains the technical data,

the short commands of the voice command system, and the index that will direct you as quickly as possible to the information

you are looking for.

f r

T ec

h n

ic al

d at

a

254

Technical data

Engine data

528i/xi 535i/xi 550i

Displacement cu in/cm 182.8/2,996 181.8/2,979 292.8/4,799

No. of cylinders 6 6 8

Maximum output hp 230 300 360

at engine speed rpm 6,500 5,800 6,300

Maximum torque lb ft/Nm 200/270 300/407 360/488

at engine speed rpm 2,750 1,400-5,000 3,400

R e

fe re

n ce

255

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Dimensions

All dimensions are given in inches/mm. Vehicle height with xDrive: 58.3 in/1,482 mm Smallest turning circle diam.: 37.5 ft/11.4 m, with xDrive 39 ft/11.9 m

T ec

h n

ic al

d at

a

256

All dimensions given in inches/mm. Smallest turning circle diam.: 39 ft/11.9 m

R e

fe re

n ce

257

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Weights

Never exceed either the approved axle loads or the gross vehicle weight.

Never exceed either the approved axle loads or the gross vehicle weight.

Sedan 528i 535i 550i

Curb weight

> Manual transmission lbs./kg 3,505/1,590 3,660/1,660 3,946/1,790

> Automatic transmission lbs./kg 3,571/1,620 3,703/1,680 3,968/1,800

Approved gross vehicle weight

> Manual transmission lbs./kg 4,607/2,090 4,872/2,210 5,048/2,290

> Automatic transmission lbs./kg 4,673/2,120 4,872/2,210 5,070/2,300

Load lbs./kg 1,102/500 1,102/500 1,102/500

Approved front axle load lbs./kg 2,227/1,010 2,359/1,070 2,469/1,120

Approved rear axle load lbs./kg 2,601/1,180 2,711/1,230 2,733/1,240

Approved roof load capacity lbs./kg 220/100 220/100 220/100

Cargo bay capacity cu ft/l 18.4/520 18.4/520 18.4/520

Sedan 528xi 535xi

Curb weight

> Manual transmission lbs./kg 3,670/1,710 3,902/1,770

> Automatic transmission lbs./kg 3,704/1,730 3,946/1,790

Approved gross vehicle weight

> Manual transmission lbs./kg 4,839/2,195 5,004/2,270

> Automatic transmission lbs./kg 4,883/2,215 5,048/2,290

Load lbs./kg 1,102/500 1,102/500

Approved front axle load lbs./kg 2,315/1,050 2,315/1,050

Approved rear axle load lbs./kg 2,64891,220 2,689/1,220

Approved roof load capacity lbs./kg 220/100 220/100

Cargo bay capacity cu ft/l 18.4/520 18.4/520

T ec

h n

ic al

d at

a

258

Never exceed either the approved axle loads or the gross vehicle weight.

Capacities

Sports Wagon 535xi

Curb weight

> Manual transmission lbs./kg 4,100/1,860

> Automatic transmission lbs./kg 4,144/1,880

Approved gross vehicle weight

> Manual transmission lbs./kg 5,291/2,400

> Automatic transmission lbs./kg 5,335/2,420

Load lbs./kg 1,190/540

Approved front axle load lbs./kg 2,381/1,080

Approved rear axle load lbs./kg 2,866/1,300

Approved roof load capacity lbs./kg 220/100

Cargo bay capacity cu ft/l 17.7-58.3/500-1,650

Notes

Fuel tank US gal/liters approx. 18.5/70 Fuel grade: page 219

of that reserve US gal/liters approx. 2.1/8

550i US gal/liters approx. 2.6/10

Window cleaning system For more details: page 69

> Sedan US quarts/liters approx. 3.2/3

> with headlamp cleaning system US quarts/liters approx. 5.3/5

> Sports Wagon US quarts/liters approx. 5.3/5

R e

fe re

n ce

259

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Short commands of voice command system

With short commands you can run certain func- tions directly, regardless of which menu item is selected.

Here are the important short commands for the voice command system.

Assistance window

Communication

*

Function Command

To open the assistance window 20 {Assistance window}

To select the display in the assistance window 20 {Assistance window map facing north}, {Assistance window map direction of travel}, {Assistance window arrow display}, {Assistance window perspective}, {Assistance window current position}, {Assistance window trip computer} or {Assistance window onboard info}

To change scale in assistance window 142 {Assistance window scale ... feet} or {Assistance window scale ... miles}

Function Command

To open phone 195 {Phone}

To dial phone number 201 {Dial number}

To display phone book 202 {A to Z}

To select from the phone book 202 {Call ...} or {Dial name}

To display "Top 8" 203 {Top 8}

To redial 202 {Redial}

To display "Received calls" 203 {Received calls}

To display "Missed calls" 203 {Missed calls}

To display "Bluetooth" 198 {Bluetooth}

To open BMW Assist 210 {BMW Assist}

To open BMW Service, Services 209 {BMW service}

To open "BMW Contact" 203 {BMW Contact}

To open "BMW Contact Numbers" 203 {BMW Contact numbers}

To open "Roadside Assistance" 210 {Roadside Assistance}

S h

o rt

c o

m m

an d

s o

f v o

ic e

co m

m an

d s

ys te

m

260

Navigation

Onboard info

Function Command

To open navigation system 142 {Navigation}

To open "Enter address" {Enter address}

To open "New destination" {New destination}

To display "Input map" {Input map}

To display destination list {Destination list}

To display address book {Address book}

To display route criteria {Route preference}

To start destination guidance {Start guidance}

To end destination guidance {Stop guidance}

To display arrow display {Arrow display}

To display map display {Map}, {Map facing north}, {Map direction of travel} or {Perspective}

To change scale {Scale ... miles} or {Scale ... feet}

To display roads or towns/cities along route {Route list}

To switch on voice instructions {Navigation info on}

To switch off voice instructions {Navigation info off}

To repeat voice instructions {Repeat navigation info}

To open route {Route menu}

To open "New route" {New route}

To display current position {Current position}

Function Command

To open "Car Data" 80 {Car data}

To display computer 80 {Onboard info}

To display trip computer 80 {Trip computer}

To open stopwatch 86 {Stopwatch}

To open speed limit 85 {Limit}

To activate speed limit 85 {Limit on}

To deactivate speed limit 85 {Limit off}

R e

fe re

n ce

261

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Entertainment

Function Command

Tone control 169 {Audio}

To switch on radio 172 {Radio on}, {FM} or {AM}

To open "FM" 172 {FM menu}

To open "AM" 172 {AM menu}

To open "All stations" 172 {FM all stations}

To select radio station 172 {Station ...}, e.g. {Station WNYC}, or {Choose station}

To open "Presets" 172 {FM presets} or {AM presets}

To select preset radio station 172 {Preset ...}, e.g. {Preset 1}

To open "Manual" 173 {FM manual}, {AM manual} or {Choose frequency}, {Frequency ... Megahertz}

To open strongest radio stations 174 {AM Autostore}

To open "WB" 176 {Weatherband menu}

To switch on weatherband 176 {Weatherband on}

To select a weatherband station 176 {Choose weatherband station}

To open "SAT" 180 {SAT radio menu}

To switch on satellite radio 180 {SAT radio}

To open "Presets" of satellite radio 181 {SAT radio presets}

To open "All channels" of satellite radio 180 {SAT radio all channels}

To open "Categories" of satellite radio 180 {SAT radio categories}

To open CD player 182 {CD menu}

To switch on CD player 182 {CD}

To open CD changer 183 {CD changer menu}

To switch on CD changer 183 {CD changer}

To select a CD in the CD changer 183 {CD 1...6}

To select music track 183 {CD track ...}

To select a CD and music track in the CD changer 183

{CD 1...6 track ...}

To switch on audio playback with external audio device 188

{Audio Aux}

S h

o rt

c o

m m

an d

s o

f v o

ic e

co m

m an

d s

ys te

m

262

Climate

menu

Function Command

To adjust temperature distribution for front seat heating 51

{Seat heater distribution}

To open "Vent settings" 116 {Vent settings}

To open "Automatic programs" 115 {Automatic programs}

To open "Parked car ventilation" 119 {Parked car operation}

To open "Automatic ventilation" 119 {Automatic ventilation}

To display activation times 119 {Activation time}

Function Command

To open the menu {Settings menu}

"Display off" 21 {Display off}

To open "Info sources" {Info sources}

To open "Settings" {Settings}

To open "Door locks" 30, 32 {Door locks}

To open "Steering wheel buttons" 54 {Steering wheel buttons}

To open "Lighting" 67 {Lighting}

To open "Service requirements" 81, 211 {Service requirements}

To open "Service" 81, 211 {Service}

To open "BMW Service settings" settings 213 {BMW service settings}

To display "Check Control messages" 84 {Check Control messages}

To open "Head-Up Display" 102 {Head-up display}

To set brightness of Control Display 88 {Brightness}

To open "Units" 88 {Units}

To open "Language" 88, 142 {Language}

To open "Time" 86 {Time}

To open "Date" 87 {Date}

To open "PDC" 90 {PDC}

To open "FTM" 95 {FTM}

To open "TPM" 97 {TPM}

To display "Bluetooth" 198 {Bluetooth}

To open "HDC" 93 {HDC}

To activate BMW Night Vision 105 {Night Vision on}

To deactivate BMW Night Vision 105 {Night Vision off}

To display settings for BMW Night Vision 105 {Night Vision settings}

R e

fe re

n ce

263

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

264

Everything from A to Z

Index

"..." Identifies Control Display texts used to select individual functions, and indicates where to find them in the text.

A ABS Antilock Brake

System 91 indicator lamp 94 ACC, refer to Active cruise

control 70 Accepted calls 202 Accessories 6 Accident, refer to Emergency

request 247 Acoustic signal, refer to Check

Control 83 Activated-charcoal filter for

automatic climate control 118

"Activation time" for parked- car ventilation 119

Active cruise control 70 indicator lamp 74 radar sensors 74 selecting distance 72 warning lamps 74 Active front head restraints 49 Active seat 52 Active seat ventilation 52 Active steering 99 warning lamp 100 Adapter for spare key 28 Adaptive brake assistant 92 Adaptive brake lamps, refer to

Brake force display 100 Adaptive Head Light 110 "Add digits" for mobile

phone 202

Additives coolant 233 engine oil, refer to Approved

engine oils 233 "Address book" for navigation

system 151 Address for navigation deleting 153 entering 144, 147 selecting 152 storing 151 storing current position 152 "Add to address book" 151 "Add to destination

list" 147, 148 Adjusting active backrest

width 47 Adjusting interior

temperature 115 Adjusting the tone during

audio operation, refer to Tone control 169

Adjusting thigh support 46 "After door opened" 48 "After unlocking" 48 Airbags 100 indicator/warning lamp 102 indicator lamp for front

passenger airbags 101 sitting safely 45 Air distribution automatic 115 manual 116 Airing, refer to Ventilation 118 Air recirculation AUC Automatic

recirculated-air control 117 recirculated-air mode 117 "Air recirculation on / off" 55 Air supply, automatic climate

control 114 Air volume 116

AKI, refer to Fuel quality 219 Alarm system 37 avoiding unintentional

alarms 38 interior motion sensor 38 switching off alarm 37 switching off tilt alarm

sensor and interior motion sensor 38

tilt alarm sensor 38 "All channels" 180 "All doors" 30 All-season tires, refer to

Winter tires 228 "All stations", calling up with

radio 172, 176 All-wheel drive, refer to

xDrive 93 Alterations, technical, refer to

For your own safety 5 Altering stretch of road 160 "AM", reception

range 169, 172 Antenna, refer to Caring for

your vehicle brochure Antenna for mobile phone 194 Antifreeze coolant 233 washer fluid 69 Antilock Brake System

ABS 91 Anti-theft alarm system, refer

to Alarm system 37 Anti-theft system, refer to

Central locking system 29 Approved axle loads, refer to

Weights 257 Approved engine oils 233 Approved gross vehicle

weight, refer to Weights 257 Armrest, refer to Center

armrest, rear 127

R e

fe re

n ce

265

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Around the center console 14 Around the steering wheel 10 Arrival time refer to Computer 80 refer to Starting destination

guidance 156 "Arrow display" for navigation

system 157 "Arrow display pop-up

instructions" 143 Ashtray front 125 rear 126 Assist, refer to

BMW Assist 209 Assistance systems, refer to

Driving stability control systems 91

Assistance window 20 "Assist. window off" 21 AUC Automatic recirculated-

air control 117 "Audio" 169, 171, 176 Audio 168 controls 168 switching on/off 168 tone control 169 volume 169 Audio device, external 124 Automatic air distribution 115 air volume 115 cruise control 70 garage door opener 121 headlamp control 108 service notification 211 steering wheel

adjustment 47 storing stations 174 tailgate operation 36 Automatic car washes 137 also refer to Caring for your

vehicle brochure

Automatic climate control 114 automatic air

distribution 115 parked car ventilation 118 switching on and off 118 ventilation in rear 118 Automatic closing of doors,

refer to Automatic soft closing 33

Automatic curb monitor 53 Automatic lighting refer to Automatic headlamp

control 108 refer to Daytime running

lamps 109 refer to High-beam

assistant 110 refer to Interior lamps 112 refer to Pathway lighting 109 refer to Welcome lamps 108 Automatic low beams, refer to

High-beam assistant 110 "Automatic programs" 115 Automatic roll-up cover,

Sports Wagon 128 Automatic soft closing 33 Automatic speed reduction for

descents, refer to HDC Hill Descent Control 93

Automatic station search 173 Automatic transmission with

Steptronic 63 interlock 64 kick-down 64 manually unlocking and

locking transmission lock 65 shiftlock 64 towing 250 tow-starting 251 with comfort access 39 "Automatic ventilation" 119 AUTO program for automatic

climate control 115 "Auto Request" 211 "Autostore" on the

radio 172, 174 "AUX" 169, 188, 189

AUX-In connection 188 "AUX IN" in audio mode 188 Average fuel consumption 80 setting units 88 Average speed, refer to

Computer 79 "Avoid ferries" for navigation

system 154 "Avoid highways" for

navigation system 154 Avoiding freeways for

navigation 154 Avoiding unintentional

alarms 38 "Avoid tollroads" for

navigation system 154 Axle loads, refer to

Weights 257 "A - Z" 202

B Backrest contour, refer to

Lumbar support 47 Backrests, refer to Seats 46 Backrest width adjustment 46 Back seats, refer to Rear seats Backup lamps, replacing

bulbs 240 "Balance", refer to Tone

control 170 Band-aids, refer to First-aid

kit 248 Bass, refer to Tone

control 169 "Bass", tone control 170 Battery, refer to Vehicle

battery 245 jump starting 248 Battery replacement, remote

control for comfort access 40

BC button, refer to Computer 79

Being towed 250 Belts, refer to Safety belts 50 Beverage holder, refer to Cup

holders 125

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

266

Blower, refer to Air volume 116

"Bluetooth" 195 "BMW Assist" 210 BMW Assist 209 activating 214 concierge service 212 contacting BMW Customer

Relations 212 displaying vehicle data 215 offered services 209 roadside assistance 210 TeleService 211 updating 213 "BMW Contact" 204 "BMW Contact

Numbers" 204 BMW homepage 4 BMW maintenance

system 235 BMW Night Vision 104 activating 105 cleaning camera 106 cleaning camera, refer to

Wiper system 68 deactivating 105 making settings 105 "BMW Service settings" 213 BMW website 4 Bottle holder, refer to Cup

holders 125 Bracket for telephone or

mobile phone refer to Snap-in adapter 207 Brake assistant 91 adaptive 92 Brake force display 100 Brake lamps replacing bulbs 240 two-stage 100 Brake rotors breaking-in 134 refer to Braking safely 136

Brakes ABS Antilock Brake

System 91 brake assistant 91 brake force display 100 breaking-in 134 CBC Cornering Brake

Control 91 electronic brake-force

distribution 91 handbrake 63 refer to Braking safely 136 warning lamps 13 Brake system 134 brake pads 134 breaking-in 134 disk brakes 136 warning lamp 94 Braking safely 136 Breakdown services, refer to

Roadside Assistance 248 Breaking-in brake pads 134 Breaking-in the clutch 134 Breaking-in the differential,

refer to Engine and differential 134

Break-in period 134 "Brightness" 88, 103 with BMW Night Vision 106 Brightness of Control

Display 88 Button for starting engine,

refer to Start/Stop button 61 Buttons on steering wheel 11

C California Proposition 65

Warning 6 "Call" 202, 213 Call accepting 200 displaying accepted 203 ending 201 in absence 203 rejecting 201 starting 201

Calling by entering phone

number 201 from phone book 202 from Top 8 list 203 redialing 203 refer to telephone operating

instructions Can holder, refer to Cup

holders 125 Capacities 258 Car battery, refer to Vehicle

battery 245 Car care, refer to Caring for

your vehicle brochure Car-care products, refer to

Caring for your vehicle brochure

"Car Data" 80 Care 236 refer to Caring for your

vehicle brochure Cargo refer to Cargo loading 137 securing 138 securing with ski bag 131 Cargo bay capacity 257 emergency operation, refer

to Opening manually, Sports Wagon 35

emergency release 34 expanding, Sports

Wagon 128 floor panel flap, refer to

Compartment in floor, Sports Wagon 129

locking separately 34 opening/closing, refer to

Luggage compartment lid/ tailgate 33

opening from inside 33 opening from inside, Sports

Wagon 35 opening from outside 33 opening from outside,

Sports Wagon 35 opening with remote

control 31

R e

fe re

n ce

267

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Cargo bay cover, refer to Roll- up cover 128

Caring for artificial leather, refer to Caring for your vehicle brochure

Caring for leather, refer to Caring for your vehicle brochure

Caring for light-alloy wheels, refer to Caring for your vehicle brochure

Caring for plastic, refer to the Caring for your vehicle brochure

Caring for the carpet, refer to Caring for your vehicle brochure

Caring for the vehicle finish, refer to Caring for your vehicle brochure

Car key, refer to Keys/remote control 28

Car phone 194 installation location, refer to

Center armrest 123 refer to Mobile phone 194 refer to separate operating

instructions Car radio, refer to Radio 172 Car wash 62, 137 also refer to Caring for your

vehicle brochure with comfort access 39 Catalytic converter, refer to

Hot exhaust system 135 "Categories" 180 CBC Cornering Brake

Control 91 CBS Condition Based

Service 235 "CD" 169, 182

CD changer 182 controls 168 fast forward/reverse 186 installation location 186 random sequence 185 repeating a track 185 sampling tracks 184 selecting a CD 183 selecting a track 183 switching on/off 168 tone control 169 volume 169 CD player 182 controls 168 fast forward/reverse 186 random sequence 185 repeating a track 185 sampling a track 184 selecting a track 183 switching on/off 168 tone control 169 volume 169 Center armrest front 123 rear 127 Center brake lamp 241 Center console 14 "Central locking" 30 Central locking from inside 32 from outside 30 Central locking system 29 comfort access 38 Changes, technical refer to For your own

safety 5 refer to Parts and

accessories 6 Changing language on

Control Display 88 Changing scale for

navigation 158 Changing units of measure on

Control Display 88 Changing wheels 227, 242 CHECK button 84 Check Control 83 "Check Control

messages" 84

Check Gas Cap 219 Checking the air pressure,

refer to Tire inflation pressure 220

Child restraint fixing system LATCH 57

Child restraints 56 Child restraint systems 56 Child-safety lock 59 Child seats, refer to

Transporting children safely 56

Chime, refer to Check Control 83

Chock 243 Chrome parts, refer to Caring

for your vehicle brochure Cigarette lighter 125 Cigarette lighter socket, refer

to Connecting electrical devices 126

Cleaning, refer to Caring for your vehicle brochure

"Climate" 51, 115 Clock 78 12h/24h format 87 hour signal 87 setting time and date 86 Closing from inside 32 from outside 30 Closing fuel filler cap 219 Clothes hooks 124 Cockpit 10 Cold start, refer to Starting

engine 62 Comfort access 38 observe in car wash 39 replacing battery, remote

control 40 Comfort area, refer to Around

the center console 14 Comfort seat 46 "Communication" 200, 210 Compact Disc refer to CD changer 182 refer to CD player 182

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

268

Compact wheel inflation pressure 221, 222 wheel change 244 Compartment for remote

control, refer to Ignition lock 61

Compartments in cargo bay, Sports

Wagon 129 refer to Storage area

package, Sports Wagon 130 refer to Storage

compartments 124 Compressed audio files 182 Computer 79 displays on Control

Display 80 hour signal 87 "Concert hall", refer to Tone

control 171 "Concierge" 212 Concierge service 212 Condensation, refer to When

vehicle is parked 136 Condition Based Service

CBS 235 "Confirmation" 31 Confirmation signals for

locking and unlocking 31 Connecting car vacuum

cleaner, refer to Connecting electrical devices 126

Consumption, refer to Average fuel consumption 80

Consumption indicator, Energy Control 79

Consumption statistics, refer to Average fuel consumption 80

"Continue guidance to destination?" 157

"Contrast" with BMW Night Vision 106

Control Center, refer to iDrive 16

Control Display, refer to iDrive 16

setting brightness 88 switching off/on 21 Controller, refer to iDrive 16 Controls, refer to Cockpit 10 Convenient operation glass sunroof 30 windows 30 windows and glass sunroof

with comfort access 39 Coolant 233 checking level 233 temperature 78 Cooling, maximum 117 Cooling fluid, refer to

Coolant 233 Cooling function, automatic

climate control 117 Cooling system, refer to

Coolant 233 Copyright 2 Cornering Brake Control

CBC 91 Country of destination for

navigation 145 Courtesy lamps 112 Cradle for telephone or mobile

phone 123 Cruise control 69 active cruise control 70 Cruising range 79 Cup holders 125 Curb weight, refer to

Weights 257 Current consumption, refer to

Energy Control 79 "Current position" 163 Current position displaying 163 entering 152 storing 152 "Curve mode" with

BMW Night Vision 106 "Customer

Relations" 204, 212 Cylinders, refer to Engine

data 254

D Dashboard, refer to

Cockpit 10 Data, technical 254 dimensions 255 engine 254 weights 257 "Date" 87 Date 78 date format 87 retrieval 78 setting 87 "Date format" 87 "Daytime running lamps" 109 Daytime running lamps 109 DBC Dynamic Brake Control,

warning lamp 94 "Deactivated" 49 Decommissioning the vehicle,

refer to Caring for your vehicle brochure

Defect door lock 32 fuel filler door 218 glass sunroof 42 luggage compartment lid 34 panorama glass sunroof 44 tailgate 35 Defrosting windows 116 Defrosting windows and

removing condensation 116 Defrosting windshield, refer to

Defrosting windows 116 Defrost position, refer to

Defrosting windows 116 "Delete address book" for

navigation system 153 "Delete all numbers" for

mobile phone 203 "Delete data" for navigation

system 153 "Delete" for mobile

phone 203 Destination address deleting 153 entering 144, 147

R e

fe re

n ce

269

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Destination for navigation destination list 150 entering via voice 147 entry 144 selecting from address

book 152 selecting using

information 149 storing 151 Destination guidance 156 bypassing route

sections 160 canceling voice

instructions 55 changing specified

route 154 displaying route 157 distance and arrival 156 interrupting 156 starting 156 terminating/continuing 156 voice instructions 159 volume of voice

instructions 160 Destination list for

navigation 150 Destinations recently driven

to 150 "Details" in audio

mode 184, 190 "Dial" for mobile phone 201 "Dial number" 201 "Diamond button" 55 Diamond button 54 Digital clock 78 Digital radio, refer to High

Definition Radio 176 Dimensions 255 Directional indicators, refer to

Turn signals 67 Direction instructions, refer to

Voice instructions 159 Directory, refer to Phone

book 202 Directory for navigation, refer

to Address book 151 Direct selection buttons 21 Displacement, refer to Engine

data 254

"Display" 88 Display, refer to iDrive

controls 16 Display elements, refer to

Instrument cluster 12 Displaying vehicle data 215 Display lighting, refer to

Instrument lighting 112 "Display off" 21 Displays on Control Display, refer to

iDrive 16 refer to Instrument

cluster 12 "Display settings" 88, 103 Displays on the windshield,

refer to Head-Up Display 102

Disposal battery of remote control

with comfort access 40 coolant 233 vehicle battery 245 Distance, refer to

Computer 80 Distance control, refer to

Active cruise control 70 "Distance to dest." 80 Distance to destination, refer

to Computer 80 Distance warning, refer to

PDC Park Distance Control 90

Divided rear backrest, refer to Through-loading system 127

Door entry lighting 112 Door key, refer to Keys/

remote control 28 Door lock 32 Door locking, confirmation

signals 31 "Door locks" 30 Doors manual operation 32 remote control 30 DOT Quality Grades 226 Draft-free ventilation 118

Drinks holder, refer to Cup holders 125

"Driver's door only" 30 Driving lamps, refer to Parking

lamps/low beams 108 Driving route, refer to

Displaying route 157 Driving stability control

systems 91 Driving through water 136 Driving tips, refer to General

driving notes 134 Dry air, refer to Cooling

function 117 Drying the air, refer to Cooling

function 117 DSC Dynamic Stability

Control 92 indicator lamp 13, 92 malfunction 94 DTC Dynamic Traction

Control 92 activating 92 indicator lamp 13, 93 DVD for navigation 142 Dynamic Drive 94 Dynamic Driving Control 66 "Dynamic route" for

navigation 154 Dynamic Stability Control

DSC 92 Dynamic Traction Control

DTC 92

E Easy entry/exit 54 backrest width 47 Eject button, refer to Buttons

in area of CD player 168 Electrical malfunction door lock 32 driver's door 32 fuel filler door 218 glass sunroof, electric 42 luggage compartment lid 34 panorama glass sunroof 44 tailgate 35

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

270

Electric steering wheel adjustment 54

Electronic brake-force distribution 91

Electronic oil level check 232 Emergency operation, refer to

Manual operation door lock 32 driver's door 32 fuel filler door 218 luggage compartment lid 34 tailgate 35 transmission lock, automatic

transmission 65 Emergency operation, refer to

Moving manually glass sunroof 42 panorama glass sunroof 44 Emergency release for

luggage compartment lid in cargo bay 34

Emergency request 247 Emergency services, refer to

Roadside Assistance 248 "Enabled services" 215 "Enable services" 215 "End call" 202 Energy-conscious driving,

refer to Energy Control 79 Energy Control 79 Engine breaking-in 134 data 254 overheated, refer to Coolant

temperature 78 speed 254 starting 62 starting, with comfort

access 38 switching off 62 Engine compartment 231 Engine coolant 233

Engine oil adding 233 additives, refer to Approved

engine oils 233 approved engine oil 233 checking oil level 232 electronic oil level check 232 interval between changes,

refer to Service requirements 81

oil change 233 oil grades, refer to Approved

engine oils 233 "Engine oil level" 232 Engine output, refer to Engine

data 254 Engine overheating, refer to

Coolant temperature 78 Engine speed, refer to Engine

data 254 Engine starting, refer to

Starting engine 62 "Enter address" 144, 151 Entering destination via town/

city name 145 Entering intersection,

navigation 146 Entering the

address 144, 147 Entering town/city for

navigation 145 Entering zip code for

navigation 145 "Entertainment" 168 Entertainment sound output

on/off 169 Entry map for destination 148 Environmentally friendly

driving, refer to Energy Control 79

"Equalizer", refer to Tone control 171

Equalizer, refer to Tone control 171

"ESN" 179

ESP Electronic Stability Program, refer to DSC Dynamic Stability Control 92

Event Data Recorders 236 Exhaust system, refer to Hot

exhaust system 135 Exterior mirrors 53 adjusting 53 automatic dimming

feature 54 automatic heating 53 folding in and out 53 tilting down passenger-side

exterior mirror 53 External audio device 124 Eye for tow-starting and

towing, refer to Tow fitting 249

F "Fader", refer to Tone

control 170 Fader, refer to Tone

control 170 Failure messages, refer to

Check Control 83 False alarm refer to Avoiding

unintentional alarms 38 refer to Switching off

alarm 37 Fastening safety belts, refer to

Safety belts 50 warning lamp 50 Fastest route for

navigation 154 "Fast route" for

navigation 154 "Favorites", calling up with

radio 176 Filler neck for washer fluid 69 Filter, refer to Microfilter/

activated-charcoal filter 118 Fine wood, refer to Caring for

your vehicle brochure

R e

fe re

n ce

271

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

First aid, refer to First-aid kit 248

First-aid kit 248 Flashing during locking/unlocking,

refer to Setting confirmation signals 31

triple turn signal activation 67

Flashlight, refer to Rechargeable flashlight 123

Flat tire changing wheels 242 compact wheel 244 Flat Tire Monitor 95, 96 refer to Tire condition 227 run-flat tires 96, 98, 227 TPM Tire Pressure

Monitor 97 warning lamp 96, 98 Flat Tire Monitor 95 false alarms 95 initializing system 95 snow chains 229 system limits 95 warning lamp 96 Floor mat, refer to Caring for

your vehicle brochure Floor mats/carpets, refer to

Caring for your vehicle brochure

Fluid reservoir, refer to Filler neck for washer fluid 69

"FM", reception range 169, 172

FM, waveband 172 Fog lamps 112 indicator lamp 13, 112 Folding rear backrest 127 Sports Wagon 128 Fold-over rear backrest 127 Footbrake, refer to Braking

safely 136 Footwell lamps, refer to

Interior lamps 112 Forward, fast CD changer 186 CD player 186

For your own safety 5 4-wheel drive system, refer to

xDrive 93 Freeway, refer to Route

criteria 154 Front airbags 100 Front armrest, refer to Center

armrest, front 123 Front passenger airbags,

deactivating 101 Front seat adjustment 46 "FTM" 96 FTM, refer to Flat Tire

Monitor 95 Fuel 219 average consumption 80 display 79 high-quality brands 219 quality 219 specifications 219 tank contents, refer to

Capacities 258 Fuel clock, refer to Fuel

gauge 79 Fuel consumption display,

computer, average fuel consumption 80

Fuel display, refer to Fuel gauge 79

Fuel-efficient driving 134 refer to Energy Control 79 Fuel filler door 218 releasing in the event of

electrical malfunction 218 Full mobile phone preparation

package 194 Full screen display, refer to

Switching assistance window off 21

"Full screen" with BMW Night Vision 106

Fuses 245

G Garage door opener, refer to

Integrated universal remote control 121

Gasoline, refer to Required fuel 219

Gasoline display, refer to Fuel gauge 79

Gearshift lever, manual transmission 63

General driving notes 134, 135

Glass sunroof, electric 41 convenient operation from

outside 32 convenient operation with

comfort access 39 moving manually 42 remote control 30 Glove compartment 123 lighting 123 rechargeable flashlight 123 GPS navigation, refer to

Navigation system 142 Grills, refer to Ventilation 118 Gross vehicle weight, refer to

Weights 257

H Halogen lamps 239 Handbrake 63 indicator lamp 13, 63 Hand lamp, refer to

Rechargeable flashlight 123 Hands-free system, refer to

Microphone 14 Hazard warning flashers 15 "HDC" 93 HDC Hill Descent Control 93 "HDC on" 93 "HDC on / off" 55 "HD radio" 176 HD radio, refer to High

Definition Radio 176 Head airbags 100

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

272

Headlamp control, automatic 108

Headlamp flasher 67 Headlamps 108 care, refer to Caring for your

vehicle brochure cleaning, refer to Wiper

system 68 cleaning tank, refer to

Capacities 258 filler neck for washer

fluid 231 replacing bulbs 239 Head Light, refer to Adaptive

Head Light 110 Head restraints 49 active front head

restraints 49 removing 50 sitting safely 45 "Head-Up Display" 103 Head-Up Display 102 Heated mirrors 53 rear window 116 seats 51 steering wheel 54 Heating 114 exterior mirrors 53 interior 114 rear window 116 residual heat 117 seats 51 steering wheel 54 Heating with engine switched

off, refer to Residual heat 117

Heavy cargo, refer to Securing cargo 138

Height, refer to Dimensions 255

Height adjustment seats 46 steering wheel 54 "High-beam assistant" 112 High-beam assistant 110

High beams 110 headlamp flasher 110 indicator lamp 13 replacing bulbs 239 High Definition Radio 176 High water, refer to Driving

through water 136 Hill Descent Control HDC 93 Hills 136 Holder for cups 125 "Home address" for

navigation system 153 Homepage of BMW 4 Hood 230 Hooks for shopping bags,

Sports Wagon 130 Horn 10 Hotel function, refer to

Locking separately 34 Hot exhaust system 135 "Hour memo" 87 "House number" for

destination entry 146 Hydraulic brake assistant,

refer to Brake assistant 91 Hydroplaning 135

I IBOC, refer to High Definition

Radio 176 Ice, refer to Outside

temperature warning 78 ID3 tag, refer to Information on

track 184 Identification mark recommended tire

brands 228 run-flat tires 227 tire coding 225

iDrive 16 assistance window 20 automatic climate control

with expanded scope 115 changing date and time 86 changing language 88 changing menu page 19 changing settings 86 changing units of measure

and display type 88 confirming selection or

entry 19 controller 16 controls 16 displays, menus 17 operating principle 17 selecting menu item 19 setting brightness 88 start menu 17 status information 20 symbols 18 Ignition 61 switched off 62 switched on 61 Ignition key, refer to Keys/

remote control 28 Ignition key position 1, refer to

Radio readiness 61 Ignition key position 2, refer to

Ignition on 61 Ignition lock 61 starting engine with comfort

access 39 i menu 17 Imprint 2 Indicator/warning lamps ABS Antilock Brake

System 94 active steering 100 airbags 102 brake system 94 DSC 13, 92 DTC 13, 93 Flat Tire Monitor 96 fog lamps 13 safety belt warning 50 TPM Tire Pressure

Monitor 98

R e

fe re

n ce

273

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Indicator and warning lamps, overview 13

Inflation pressure, refer to Tire inflation pressure 220

Inflation pressure monitoring refer to Flat Tire Monitor 95 refer to TPM Tire Pressure

Monitor 97 Info menu 17 Information on another location 149 on current position 149 on destination location 149 "Information" for navigation

system 149 Information menu, refer to

i menu 17 "Information on

destination" 151 "Info sources" 81 Initializing Flat Tire Monitor 95 radio, refer to Storing

stations 174 refer to Power failure 245 refer to Setting time and

date 86 seat, mirror and steering

wheel memory 47 "Input map" 149 Installation location CD changer 186 drive for navigation DVD 142 mobile phone 123 Instructions for navigation

system, refer to Voice instructions 159

Instrument cluster 12 Instrument illumination, refer

to Instrument lighting 112 Instrument lighting 112 Instrument panel refer to Cockpit 10 refer to Instrument

cluster 12 Integrated key 28 Integrated universal remote

control 121

Interesting destination for navigation 149

"Interim time" 86 Interior lamps 112 switching on with remote

control 31 Interior motion sensor 38 switching off 38 Interior rearview mirror 53 automatic dimming

feature 54 Intermittent mode of the

wipers 68

J Jacking points 244 Joystick, refer to iDrive 16 Jumpering, refer to Jump

starting 248 Jump starting 248

K Keyless-Go, refer to Comfort

access 38 Keyless opening and closing,

refer to Comfort access 38 Key Memory, refer to Personal

Profile 29 "Keypad" 204 Keys 28 key-related settings, refer to

Personal Profile 29 spare key 28 Kick-down, Automatic

transmission with Steptronic 64

Knock control 219

L Lamps refer to High-beam

assistant 110 refer to Parking lamps/low

beams 108 Lamps and bulbs 238

Lane limit lines, refer to Leaving lane warning 106

"Language / Units" 88 for navigation

system 143, 159 "Languages" 88 for navigation

system 143, 159 Lashing eyes, refer to

Securing cargo 138 Last destinations, refer to

Destination list 150 "Last seat pos." 48 LATCH child restraint fixing

system 57 Leaving lane warning 106 LEDs light-emitting

diodes 238 Length, refer to

Dimensions 255 License plate lamp, replacing

bulbs 242 Light-emitting diodes

LEDs 238 Lighter 125 "Lighting" 67 Lighting instruments 112 lamps and bulbs 238 of the vehicle, refer to

Lamps 108 Light switch 108 "Limit" 85 Loading securing cargo 138 stowing cargo 138 vehicle 137 Load securing equipment,

refer to Securing cargo 138 "Lock after driving" 33 Lock buttons in the doors,

refer to Locking 33 Locking 30 confirmation signals 31 from inside 33 from outside 30 without key, refer to Comfort

access 38

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

274

Locking and unlocking doors confirmation signals 31 from inside 32 from outside 30 Low beams 108 automatic 108 replacing bulbs 239 Lower back support, refer to

Lumbar support 47 Lug bolts 244 tightening torque, refer to

After mounting 244 wrench 243 Luggage compartment, refer

to Cargo bay Luggage compartment lid 33 emergency operation, refer

to Manual operation 34 emergency release 34 locking separately 34 opening from inside 33 opening from outside 33 unlocking and locking from

inside 32 unlocking manually 34 Luggage compartment lid/

tailgate, comfort access 39 Luggage net, refer to Partition

net 129 Luggage rack, refer to Roof-

mounted luggage rack 139 Lumbar support 47 LW, waveband 172

M M+S tires, refer to Winter

tires 228 Maintenance 235 refer to Service and

Warranty Information Booklet for US models 235

refer to Service requirements 81

refer to Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models 235

Maintenance system 235 Malfunction warnings, refer to

Check Control 83 Manual air distribution 116 "Manual" on the radio 173 Manual operation door lock 32 driver's door 32 fuel filler door 218 glass sunroof 42 luggage compartment lid 34 panorama glass sunroof 44 transmission lock, automatic

transmission 65 Manual transmission 63 "Map direction of travel" 158 Map display 158 "Map facing north" 158 Map for navigation changing scale 158 destination entry 148 Map view facing north 158 Master key, refer to Keys/

remote control 28 Maximum cooling 117 Maximum speed with compact wheel 245 with winter tires 228 Measurements, refer to

Dimensions 255 Memory, refer to Seat, mirror

and steering wheel memory 47

MENU, button refer to Start menu 17

Menus, refer to iDrive 16 Message list for traffic

information 161 Microfilter 118 Microphone for mobile phone 14 for voice command

system 14 Mirror dimming feature 54

Mirrors 53 automatic curb monitor 53 folding in and out 53 heating 53 memory, refer to Seat, mirror

and steering wheel memory 47

"Missed calls" 202 Missed calls 203 Mobile phone accepted calls 203 adjusting volume 200 calling 201 ending call 201 installation location, refer to

Center armrest 123 missed calls 203 operation by voice 205 operation via iDrive 200 redialing 203 refer to separate operating

instructions Top 8 203 touch tone dialing, refer to

Tone dialing method 204 Mobile phone battery 208 Monitor, refer to iDrive 16 Monitoring pressure of tires,

refer to Flat Tire Monitor 95 "Monitor on / off" 55 Most recent mobile phone

numbers 203 MP3 compressed audio files 182 USB/audio interface 189 Multi-function steering wheel,

refer to Buttons on steering wheel 11

Multifunction switch refer to Turn signals/

headlamp flasher 67 refer to Wiper system 68 Music tracks finding 184 random play sequence 185 sampling, scan 184 "Mute on / off" 55 "M View" 103 MW, waveband 172

R e

fe re

n ce

275

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

N "Navigation" 80, 144 Navigation destination entering manually 144 home address 153 selecting via map 148 Navigation drive, installation

location 142 Navigation DVD 142 Navigation instructions, refer

to Switching voice instructions on/off 159

Navigation system 142 address book 151 bypassing route

sections 160 destination entry 144 destination guidance in

assistance window 142 destination list 150 displaying current

position 163 displaying route 157 entering a destination

manually 144 entering destination via

voice 147 last destinations 150 navigation DVD 142 route list 159 searching for a special

destination 149 selecting destination using

information 149 selecting destination via

map 148 selecting route criteria 154 starting destination

guidance 156 switching off, refer to

Terminating/continuing destination guidance 156

terminating/continuing destination guidance 156

voice instructions 159 volume adjustment 160

"Navigation voice instructions" 55, 159

Neck support, refer to Head restraints 49

"New address" for navigation system 151

"New destination" 144, 148 New remote control 28 "New route" 160 New wheels and tires 227 "Next entertainment

source" 55 Night Vision, refer to

BMW Night Vision 104 Night vision device, refer to

BMW Night Vision 104 "Night Vision off" 106 "Night Vision on / off" 55 Nozzles, refer to Windshield

washer nozzles 69 Nylon rope, refer to Tow-

starting and towing 249

O OBD socket, refer to Socket

for Onboard Diagnostics interface 236

Octane ratings, refer to Fuel specifications 219

Odometer 78 Oil, refer to Engine oil 232 Oil change intervals, refer to

Service requirements 81 "On a new destination" for

navigation system 149 Onboard computer, refer to

iDrive 16 "Onboard info" 80 Onboard toolkit 237 "On destination" 149 "On location" 149

Opening and closing comfort access 38 from inside 32 from outside 30 panorama glass sunroof 43 using remote control 30 using the door lock 32 Operating principle, iDrive 17 Operation by voice for mobile

phone 205 adjusting volume 206 canceling 205 commands 205 correcting phone

number 206 dialing phone number 206 placing a call 206 redialing 207 voice phone book 206 "Options" 213 Orientation menu, refer to

Start menu 17 Output, refer to Engine

data 254 Outside air, refer to AUC

Automatic recirculated-air control 117

Outside temperature display 78

changing unit of measure 88 in computer 88 Overview operating principle 17 radio control 168 screen display 20

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

276

P Panic mode 31 Panorama glass sunroof 43 moving manually 44 Park Distance Control PDC 90 "Parked car operation" 119 "Parked car ventilation" 119 Parked car ventilation 118 activating activation

time 119 LED 114 preselecting activation

times 119 switching on and off

directly 119 Parking, vehicle 62 Parking aid, refer to PDC Park

Distance Control 90 Parking assistant, refer to

PDC Park Distance Control 90

Parking brake, refer to Handbrake 63

Parking lamps 108 replacing bulbs 239 Partition net, Sports

Wagon 129 Parts and accessories 6 Passenger-side exterior

mirror, tilting down 53 "Pathway lighting" 109 Pathway lighting 109 "PDC" 91 "PDC display on" 91 PDC Park Distance Control 90 Personal Profile 29 "Perspective" 158 "Phone" 196, 198, 201 Phone book 200 changing entry 202 creating and editing voice

phone book 206 deleting all entries 203 deleting entry 203 dialing phone number 202

Phone numbers deleting from phone

book 203 dialing 201 most recent numbers 203 selecting in phone book 203 Top 8 203 Pinch protection system glass sunroof, electric 42 panorama glass sunroof 43 power windows 41 Plasters, refer to First-aid

kit 248 "Play" on the radio 180 Plug-in unit for remote

control, refer to Ignition lock 61

Pollen, refer to Microfilter/ activated charcoal filter 118

Position refer to Displaying current

position 163 refer to Storing current

position 152 Power failure 245 Power windows, refer to

Windows 40 Preselecting activation times

of the parked car ventilation 119

"Presets" on the radio 172, 180

Pressure, tires 220 Pressure monitoring of tires,

refer to TPM Tire Pressure Monitor 97

"Profile" 215 Programmable buttons on

steering wheel 54 Programmable memory

buttons 21 Protective function, refer to

Pinch protection system glass sunroof, electric 42 panorama glass sunroof 43 windows 41

R Radio autostore 174 controls 168 High Definition Radio 176 sampling stations 173 satellite radio 179 selecting frequency

manually 173 selecting

waveband 168, 172 station search 173 station selection 172 station with the best

reception 174 storing stations 174 switching on/off 168 tone control 169 volume 169 Weather Band, refer to

Weather news flashes 176 Radio key, refer to Keys/

remote control 28 Radio readiness 61 switched off 62 switched on 61 with comfort access 39 Radio stations, storing 174 Rain sensor 68 "Random", random play

sequence 185 "Random all" in audio

mode 186 "Random directory" in audio

mode 186 "RDS" 175 Reading lamps 113 Rear armrest, refer to Center

armrest, rear 127 Rear lamps, refer to Tail

lamps 240 replacing bulbs 240 Rear seats adjusting head restraints 50 folding over backrest 127 heating 52 removing head restraints 50

R e

fe re

n ce

277

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Rear socket 127 Rear ventilation 118 Rearview mirror 53 Rear window changing wiper blade 237 heating 116 opening and closing on

Sports Wagon 34 roller sun blind, refer to Sun

blinds 122 window wiper on Sports

Wagon 69, 137 Rear window safety switch 41 "Received calls" 202 Reception quality 175 radio stations 175 regional station 174 Reception level of mobile

phone, refer to Status information 20

Rechargeable flashlight 123 Recirculated-air mode 117 air recirculation 117 AUC Automatic

recirculated-air control 117 Reclining seat, refer to

Seats 46 Recording times, refer to

Stopwatch 86 "Redial" for mobile phone 202 Redialing with mobile

phone 207 Reflectors, refer to Tail

lamps 240 Refueling 218 Releasing hood 230 locks, refer to Unlocking 38 "Relock door if not

opened" 33 Remaining distance, refer to

Cruising range 79 Remaining distance to

destination, refer to Computer 80

Remote control 28 comfort access 38 garage door opener 121 luggage compartment lid 31 malfunction 31, 40 replacing battery 40 tailgate 31 Removing condensation on

the windows 116 "Repeat directory" in audio

mode 185 "Repeat" in audio mode 185 "Repeat track" in audio

mode 185 Replacement fuses 245 Replacement of tires, refer to

Changing wheels 242 Replacement remote control,

refer to New remote controls 28

Replacing bulbs, refer to Lamps and bulbs 238

Replacing tires 228 Replacing wheels/tires, refer

to New wheels and tires 227 Reporting safety defects 7 Reserve warning, refer to Fuel

gauge 79 "Reset" 96, 98 stopwatch 86 tone settings 171 Reset, refer to Resetting tone

settings 171 "resetting FTM " 96 Residual heat 117 Restraint systems for children 56 refer to Safety belts 50 Retaining straps, refer to

Storage area package, Sports Wagon 130

Retreaded tires 228 Reverse, fast CD changer 186 CD player 186

Reverse gear automatic transmission with

Steptronic 64 manual transmission 63 Road map 158 "Roadside

Assistance" 204, 210 Roadside Assistance 248 Roadside assistance 210 Roadside parking lamps 110 replacing bulbs 239 Roller blind, refer to Sun

blinds 122 Roll-up cover, Sports

Wagon 128 Roof load capacity 257 Roof-mounted luggage

rack 139 Rope, refer to Tow-starting

and towing 249 Rotary/pushbutton, refer to

iDrive 16 Route 154 bypassing sections 160 changing 160 changing criteria 154 displaying 157 displaying arrow display 157 displaying map view 158 displaying streets or towns/

cities 159 selecting 154 Route information, refer to

Destination guidance with voice instructions 159

Route map, refer to Displaying map view 158

"Route preference", changing 154

Route selection 154 RSC Runflat System

Component, refer to Run- flat tires 227

Rubber parts, refer to Caring for your vehicle brochure

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

278

Run-flat tires 227 continuing driving with a

damaged tire 96, 98 flat tire 96, 98 Flat Tire Monitor 95 new wheels and tires 227 tire inflation

pressure 96, 98, 220 Tire Pressure Monitor 97 tire replacement 227, 228 winter tires 228

S Safety 5 Safety belts 50 damage 51 refer to Caring for your

vehicle brochure sitting safely 45 warning lamp 50 Safety belt tensioners refer to Airbags 100 refer to Safety belts 50 Safety systems ABS Antilock Brake

System 91 airbags 100 driving stability control

systems 91 safety belts 50 Safety tires, refer to Run-flat

tires 227 Satellite radio 179 enabling channel 179 selecting channel 180 storing channel 180 "SAT" with radio 169, 179 "Save current

destination" 153 "Scan" music tracks on CD 184 stations with radio 173 Scan CD changer 184 CD player 184 radio 173

"Scan all" in audio mode 184 "Scan directory" in audio

mode 184 Screen, refer to iDrive 16 Screw thread for tow

fitting 250 SDARS, refer to Satellite

radio 179 "Seat heater distribution" 51 Seats 46 active backrest width

adjustment 47 adjusting the seats 46 comfort seat 46 easy entry/exit 47 heating 51 lumbar support 47 memory, refer to Seat, mirror

and steering wheel memory 47

shoulder support 46 sitting safely 45 storing the setting 47 thigh support 46 ventilation, refer to Active

seat ventilation 52 Securing load refer to Securing cargo 138 with ski bag, refer to

Securing cargo 131 "Select as

destination" 150, 213 "Select current speed" 85 Selecting audio sources, refer

to Operation via iDrive 168 Selecting distance with active

cruise control 72 Selecting frequency

manually 173 Selecting menu items 19 Selecting route 154 Selection options with

navigation system 154 Selector lever, automatic

transmission with Steptronic 64

Selector lever lock, refer to Selecting transmission positions 64

Self-leveling suspension 95 Service, refer to Roadside

Assistance 248 Service and Warranty

Information Booklet for US models 235

"Service Info" 81, 211, 232 Service Interval Display refer to CBS Condition

Based Service 235 refer to Service

requirements 81 "Service Request" 204, 211 "Service

requirements" 82, 211, 232 Service requirements 81 refer to CBS Condition

Based Service 235 "Set" in audio mode 169 on trip computer 81 "Set date" 87 "Set service date" 82 "Set time" 87 Setting button, refer to

Controls, controller 16 "Settings" 215 for BMW Assist 213 for unlocking 30 Settings BMW Night Vision 105 changing on Control

Display 86 clock, 12h/24h mode 87 configuring, refer to

Personal Profile 29 date 87 language 88 units of measure 88 Settings menu, refer to

i menu 17 Setting time, refer to

Preselecting activation times 119

R e

fe re

n ce

279

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Shifting gears, Automatic transmission with Steptronic 64

Shift paddles on steering wheel 66

Short commands of voice command system 259

"Short route" for navigation 154

Short route in navigation, refer to Selecting route 154

Shoulder support 46 "Show current position" 149 "Show destination

position" 149 Shuffled, refer to Random CD changer 185 CD player 185 Side airbags 100 Side marker lamps, replacing

bulbs 240 Side-mounted turn signals,

replacing bulbs 240 Side window blinds, refer to

Sun blinds 122 Signal horn, refer to Horn 10 Sitting safely 45 with airbags 45 with head restraint 45 with safety belts 45 Ski bag 131 Sliding/tilt sunroof refer to Glass sunroof,

electric 41 refer to Panorama glass

sunroof 43 Slope assistant, refer to

Starting assistant 94 Snap-in adapter mounting/removing 207 using 194 Snow chains 229 Socket for Onboard

Diagnostics interface 236 Socket for remote control,

refer to Ignition lock 61

Sockets, refer to Connecting electrical devices 126

Soft closure aid, refer to Automatic soft closing 33

Song search on CD, refer to Sampling tracks 184

SOS, refer to Initiating an emergency request 247

Sound distribution in audio mode

front/rear fader 170 right/left balance 170 Spare adapter for spare key 28 fuses 245 key 28 Spare wheel refer to Changing

wheels 242 refer to Compact wheel 244 Special oils, refer to Approved

engine oils 233 Specified oil grades, refer to

Approved engine oils 233 Speed limit 85 with compact wheel 245 Speed-dependent

volume 170 Speed limit warning, refer to

Speed limit 85 Speedometer 12 "Speed volume", tone

control 170 Speed with winter tires 228 Sport automatic

transmission 66 Dynamic Driving Control 66 kick-down 64 towing 250 with comfort access 39 Sport program, Automatic

transmission with Steptronic 64

Sports Wagon automatic roll-up cover 128 automatic tailgate

operation 36 compartments in cargo

bay 129 expanding cargo bay 128 opening rear window 34 opening tailgate 35 panorama glass sunroof 43 partition net 129 rear window wiper 69 rear window wiper, changing

wiper blade 237 releasing fuel filler door in

event of electrical malfunction 218

roll-up cover 128 roll-up cover for cargo

bay 128 self-leveling suspension 95 socket in cargo bay 126 storage area package 130 tail lamps, replacing

bulbs 241 Stability control, refer to

Driving stability control systems 91

"Star button" 55 Star button 54 Start/Stop button 61 starting the engine 62 switching off the engine 62 "Start" for stopwatch 86 "Start guidance" 147, 156 Starting, refer to Starting

engine 62 Starting assistance, refer to

Jump starting 248 Starting assistant 94 Starting difficulties, refer to

Jump starting 248 Starting off on slopes, refer to

Starting assistant 94 Start menu, iDrive 17 "Start route guidance" 149 "Start service" 211

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

280

"Start Service" for BMW Assist 212

"State / Province" for destination entry 145

"State inspection" 82 Station, refer to Radio 172 "Status" 82 Status information on Control

Display 20 Status of this Owner's Manual

at time of printing 5 Steering wheel adjustment 54 automatic adjustment, refer

to Steering wheel memory 47

buttons on steering wheel 11

easy entry/exit 54 heating 54 lock, refer to Ignition lock 61 memory 47 programmable buttons 54 shift paddles 66 Steering-wheel shift buttons,

refer to Shift paddles 66 Steering with variable ratio,

refer to Active steering 99 Steptronic refer to Automatic

transmission with Steptronic 63

refer to Sport automatic transmission 66

refer to Sport program and manual mode 64

"Stop" for stopwatch 86 "Stopwatch" 86 Stopwatch 86 Storage area package, Sports

Wagon 130 Storage compartments 124 "Store in address book" for

navigation system 152 "Store" on the radio 175, 181 Storing current position 152 Storing radio stations 174

Storing sitting position, refer to Seat, mirror and steering wheel memory 47

Storing tires 229 "Street" for destination

entry 146 Summer tires, refer to Wheels

and tires 220 Sun blinds 122 "Surround Settings", refer to

Tone control 170, 171 SW, waveband 172 Swinging up floor panel,

Sports Wagon 129 Switches, refer to Cockpit 10 Switching automatically

between high beams and low beams, refer to High- beam assistant 110

Switching off engine 62 Switching on audio 168 CD changer 168 CD player 168 radio 168 Switching on hour signal 87 Swiveling headlamps, refer to

Adaptive Head Light 110 Symbols 4 indicator/warning lamps 13 navigation system 162 status information 20 traffic information with

navigation system 160

T Tachometer 78 "Tailgate" 36 Tailgate 33 automatic operation 36 emergency operation, refer

to Opening manually 35 locking and unlocking from

inside 32 opening from inside 35 Tail lamps 240 replacing bulbs 240

Tank contents, refer to Capacities 258

Target cursor for navigation 149

Technical alterations, refer to For your own safety 5

Technical data 254 capacities 258 dimensions 255 Telematics, refer to

BMW Assist 209 Telephone installation location, refer to

Center armrest 123 refer to Mobile phone 194 "Telephone list" 55 TeleService 211 Temperature adjusting in upper body

region 115 adjusting with automatic

climate control 115 changing units of

measure 88 refer to Coolant

temperature 78 Temperature display changing units of

measure 88 outside temperature 78 outside temperature

warning 78 Tempomat, refer to Cruise

control 69 "Terminate services" 214 "Text language" 88 "Theater", refer to Tone

control 171 The individual vehicle 5 Third brake lamp, refer to

Center brake lamp 241 Through-loading system 127 Tightening torque of the lug

bolts, refer to After mounting 244

Tilt alarm sensor 38 switching off 38

R e

fe re

n ce

281

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Tilting down passenger-side exterior mirror 53

"Time" 87 "Time format" 87 Timer, refer to Preselecting

activation times 119 "Timer 1" for parked-car

ventilation 119 "Timer 2" for parked-car

ventilation 119 Tire inflation pressures 220 Tire pressure loss 96, 97 Tire Pressure Monitor

TPM 97 Tire Quality Grading 226 Tire replacement, new wheels

and tires 227 Tires age 226 air loss 96, 98 breaking-in 134 changing 227 condition 227 damage 227 flat tire, refer to Changing

wheels 242 inflation pressure 220 new wheels and tires 227 pressure monitoring, refer to

Flat Tire Monitor 95 pressure monitoring, refer to

TPM Tire Pressure Monitor 97

replacing 242 retreaded tires 228 run-flat tires 227 size 225 tread 227 wear indicators 227 wheel/tire combination 227 winter tires 228 Tire trouble changing wheels 242 compact wheel 244 TMC station, refer to Traffic

information 160

"Tone" 169 Tone dialing method 204 Tone in audio mode adjusting 169 middle setting 171 Tone on locking/unlocking 31 Tools, refer to Onboard

toolkit 237 "Top 8" for mobile phone 202 Torque lug bolts, refer to After

mounting 244 refer to Engine data 254 Touch tone dialing, refer to

Tone dialing method 204 Tow bar 250 Tow fitting 249 Towing 249 methods 250 tow fittings 249 with automatic and sport

automatic transmission 250 with manual

transmission 250 "Town / City" for destination

entry 145 Tow rope 251 Tow-starting 249 "TPM" 97 TPM Tire Pressure

Monitor 97 resetting system 97 system limits 97 warning lamp 98 Tracks random sequence 185 sampling on CD 184 selecting with CD 183 Track width, refer to

Dimensions 255 Traction-assist feature, refer

to DSC Dynamic Stability Control 92

Traction control, refer to DSC Dynamic Stability Control 92

Traffic information for navigation 160

depiction in route map 162 displaying 161 during destination

guidance 163 symbols 162 "Traffic Info settings" 161 Traffic jam displaying traffic

information 160 refer to Bypassing route

sections 160 Transmission automatic transmission with

Steptronic 63 manually unlocking and

locking transmission lock 65 manual transmission 63 sport automatic

transmission 66 starting assistant 94 towing 250 Transporting children

safely 56 Transport securing device,

refer to Securing cargo 138 Tread depth, refer to Minimum

tire tread 227 Treble, refer to Tone

control 169 "Treble", tone control 170 "Trip computer" 81 Trip computer 80 Trip-distance counter refer to Trip computer 80 refer to Trip meter 78 "Triple turn signal" 67 Trip meter 78 also refer to Trip

computer 80 Trunk, refer to Cargo bay Trunk lid, refer to Tailgate 35 Turning circle, refer to

Dimensions 255

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

282

Turning lamps 110 replacing bulbs 240 Turn signals 67 indicator lamp 12 replacing bulbs 240

U Underbody protection, refer to

Caring for your vehicle brochure

Uniform Tire Quality Grading/ UTQR 226

"Units" 88 Units average fuel

consumption 88 temperature 88 Universal garage-door

opener, refer to Integrated universal remote control 121

Universal remote control 121 "Unlock button" 30 Unlocking from inside 33 from outside 30 without key, refer to Comfort

access 38 "Update services" 213 USB/audio interface 189 "USB" in audio mode 190 "Use current location as

address" 152, 153 Used batteries refer to Disposal 245 refer to Replacing battery 40 Using turn signals 67

V Valve screw caps, refer to

After mounting 244 Vehicle battery 245 breaking-in 134 care 236 care, refer to Caring for your

vehicle brochure loading 137 measurements, refer to

Dimensions 255 parking 62 washing, refer to Caring for

your vehicle brochure weights 257 "Vehicle / Tires" for

unlocking 30 Vehicle jack 243 jacking points 244 Vehicle position, refer to

Displaying current position 163

Ventilation 118 draft-free 118 in rear 118 while stationary 118 Vent outlets 114 refer to Ventilation 118 Vent outlets of automatic

climate control 114 "Vent settings" 116 Viscosity 233 Voice, refer to Destination

guidance with voice instructions 159

Voice command system overview 23 short commands 259 Voice instructions for

navigation system 159 muting 55 repeating 55, 160 switching on/off 55, 159 volume 160 Voice phone book 206

Volume 168 audio sources 168 cargo bay 257 fuel tank, refer to

Capacities 258 mobile phone 200 setting speed-

dependent 170 voice instructions 160 windshield cleaning system,

refer to Capacities 258

W Warning lamps, refer to

Indicator and warning lamps 13

Warning messages, refer to Check Control 83

Warning on leaving lane, refer to Leaving lane warning 106

Warning triangle 247 Warranty and Service Guide

Booklet for Canadian models 235

Washer fluid 69 capacity of the reservoir 69 Washing the vehicle, also refer

to Caring for your vehicle brochure

Waste container, refer to Ashtray 125

Water on roads, refer to Driving through water 136

Waveband for radio 172 "WB" 169, 176 Wear indicators in tires, refer

to Minimum tread depth 227 Weather news flashes 176 Website BMW 4 Weights 257 Welcome lamps 108 "Welcome light" 109 Wheel/tire combination, refer

to New wheels and tires 227 Wheel/tire damage 227 Wheelbase, refer to

Dimensions 255 Wheels and tires 220

R e

fe re

n ce

283

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

a vi

g a

ti o

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Width, refer to Dimensions 255

Windows 40 convenient operation 30 convenient operation from

outside 32 convenient operation with

comfort access 39 rear window, Sports

Wagon 34 safety switch 41 Windshield cleaning, refer to Wiper

system 68 defrosting, refer to

Defrosting windows 116 displays, refer to Head-Up

Display 102 Windshield wash automatic, refer to Rain

sensor 68 capacities, reservoir 258 filler neck for washer

fluid 231 rear window 69 washer fluid 69 windshield washer

nozzles 69 wiper system 68 Windshield wipers, refer to

Wiper system 68 care, refer to Caring for your

vehicle brochure wiper blade

replacement 237 Winter tires 228 setting speed limit 85 storage 229 Wiper blades care, refer to Caring for your

vehicle brochure replacement 237 Wiper system 68 rain sensor 68 washer fluid 69 windshield washer

nozzles 69

"With highways" for navigation system 154

Wood decoration, refer to Caring for your vehicle brochure

Word matching principle for navigation 155

Working in the engine compartment 230

Wrenches/screwdrivers, refer to Onboard toolkit 237

X xDrive 93 Xenon lamps 239 replacing bulbs 239

Y Your individual vehicle programmable buttons on

steering wheel 54 settings, refer to Personal

Profile 29

Z "Zoom" with B

Manualsnet FAQs

If you want to find out how the 5 Series BMW works, you can view and download the BMW 525xi Sedan 5 Series 2008 Owner's Manual on the Manualsnet website.

Yes, we have the Owner's Manual for BMW 5 Series as well as other BMW manuals. All you need to do is to use our search bar and find the user manual that you are looking for.

The Owner's Manual should include all the details that are needed to use a BMW 5 Series. Full manuals and user guide PDFs can be downloaded from Manualsnet.com.

The best way to navigate the BMW 525xi Sedan 5 Series 2008 Owner's Manual is by checking the Table of Contents at the top of the page where available. This allows you to navigate a manual by jumping to the section you are looking for.

This BMW 525xi Sedan 5 Series 2008 Owner's Manual consists of sections like Table of Contents, to name a few. For easier navigation, use the Table of Contents in the upper left corner.

You can download BMW 525xi Sedan 5 Series 2008 Owner's Manual free of charge simply by clicking the “download” button in the upper right corner of any manuals page. This feature allows you to download any manual in a couple of seconds and is generally in PDF format. You can also save a manual for later by adding it to your saved documents in the user profile.

To be able to print BMW 525xi Sedan 5 Series 2008 Owner's Manual, simply download the document to your computer. Once downloaded, open the PDF file and print the BMW 525xi Sedan 5 Series 2008 Owner's Manual as you would any other document. This can usually be achieved by clicking on “File” and then “Print” from the menu bar.